Institutes
Refine
Year of publication
Document Type
- Doctoral Thesis (246) (remove)
Has Fulltext
- yes (246) (remove)
Is part of the Bibliography
- no (246)
Keywords
- Metabolic Engineering (4)
- Saccharomyces cerevisiae (3)
- zebrafish (3)
- Biomarker (2)
- Mikroplastik (2)
- Schülerlabor (2)
- Xenorhabdus (2)
- ADAM15 (1)
- ALE (1)
- Acetogenic bacteria (1)
- Adaptation (1)
- Aedes albopictus (1)
- Antikörperdetektion (1)
- Aphanomyces astaci (1)
- Apoptosis (1)
- Asian Tiger Mosquito (1)
- Asiatische Tigermücke (1)
- Autism Spectrum Disorder (1)
- Baleen whales (1)
- Bartonella henselae (1)
- Biotic interactions (1)
- Bovidae (1)
- Bremsen (1)
- Bungarus (1)
- Bungarus niger (1)
- Bungarus walli (1)
- CLPXP-Protease (1)
- CNV 16p11.2 (1)
- Calmodulin (1)
- Carbon capture (1)
- Cardiac regeneration (1)
- Carnivora (1)
- Carotinoide (1)
- Chagas (1)
- Chlorophyll Fluorescence (1)
- Climate (1)
- Climate Change (1)
- Climate change (1)
- Colorectal Cancer (1)
- Conservation (1)
- Coronaries (1)
- Cortisol im Speichel (1)
- Culicidae (1)
- Cytomegalievirus (1)
- DEPDC5 (1)
- DIRAS2 (1)
- Daboia russelii (1)
- Development (1)
- Didaktik Neurowissenschaften (1)
- Digitalisierung (1)
- EMCP (1)
- Ecotoxicogenomics (1)
- Ecotoxicology (1)
- Efferentes System (1)
- Emerging insect model organisms (1)
- Entomologie (1)
- Entomology (1)
- EphrinB2 (1)
- Epigenetik (1)
- Evolution (1)
- Evolutionary developmental biology (1)
- Extracellular matrix (1)
- Extremhabitat (1)
- FVIII (1)
- Fabclavine (1)
- Flavoproteins (1)
- Freshwater (1)
- Freshwater Ecosystems (1)
- Functional Ecology (1)
- Functional traits (1)
- Gal2 (1)
- Galakturonsäure (1)
- Genetics (1)
- Genome (1)
- HWC database (1)
- Haloferax volcanii (1)
- Heart (1)
- Hippocampal development (1)
- Honigbiene (1)
- Hydrogen storage (1)
- Hydrogen-dependent CO2 reductase (1)
- Höhle (1)
- Immunrekonstitution (1)
- Influenza (1)
- Inthraszentin (1)
- Isoprenoide (1)
- Java (1)
- Konkurrenz (1)
- Light sheet-based fluorescence microscopy (1)
- Light-sheet microscopy (1)
- Limonene-3-hydroxylase (1)
- Lineage Through Time (1)
- MEK inhibition (1)
- Macroevolution (1)
- Macrotermes (1)
- Magnetrezeption (1)
- Maternal Immune Activation (1)
- Mediale olivo-cochleäre Efferenz (1)
- Metabolon (1)
- Methanol (1)
- Methylobacterium (1)
- Methyltransferase (1)
- Microbiology (1)
- Migration (1)
- Mikrobiom (1)
- Mikroplastik, Boden, Reifenabrieb, Analytik (1)
- Mikroskopie (1)
- Mitochondrien (1)
- Monoterpenoid (1)
- Monoterpenoid tolerance (1)
- Morphogenesis (1)
- Morphology (1)
- Motivation (1)
- Multivariate Modellierung (1)
- Naja (1)
- Natural Products (1)
- Natural products (1)
- Naturstoffe (1)
- Neurodevelopmental Psychiatric Disorders (1)
- Neuronal Differentiation (1)
- Neurosimulation (1)
- Niche (1)
- Non-canonical terpenes (1)
- Novel Object Test (1)
- Nucleus reuniens (1)
- Organic micropollutants (1)
- Organoids (1)
- Parkinson (1)
- Persönlichkeit (1)
- Photorhabdus (1)
- Phylogeny (1)
- Phytoen (1)
- Pink1 (1)
- Pinnotheres (1)
- Plant regeneration (1)
- Plant regeneration; community assembly; diversity (1)
- Plant stress (1)
- Pleistozän (1)
- Podospora anserina (1)
- Poecilia (1)
- Positive reinforcement training (1)
- Prenyl pyrophosphates (1)
- Proteomics (1)
- Pseudomonas (1)
- Pseudomonas putida (1)
- Quercus (1)
- Quercus frainetto Ten. (Ungarische Eiche) (1)
- Quercus ilex L. (Steineiche) (1)
- Quercus pubescens Willd. (Flaumeiche) (1)
- Quercus robur L. (Stieleiche) (1)
- Quercus rubra L. (Roteiche) (1)
- Quinolinate Phosphoribosyltransferase (1)
- RBFOX1 (1)
- RNA sequencing (1)
- Regeneration (1)
- Regulation (1)
- Reproduction (1)
- Rheumatoid Arthritis (1)
- Rheumatoide Arthritis (1)
- Rhodnius prolixus (1)
- Ribosomen, rRNA Prozessierung, snoRNA, Ribosomenbiogenesefaktoren (1)
- Risk assessment (1)
- Russell´s Viper (1)
- SPAD (1)
- SR proteins (1)
- Schistosomiaisis (1)
- Schwefelwasserstoff (1)
- Soziobiologie (1)
- Spatial navigation (1)
- Stammzelltransplantation (1)
- Stat3 Gliom Curcumin (1)
- Stechmücken (1)
- Structured Illumination Microscopy (1)
- Super resolution (1)
- Super resolution fluorescence microscopy (1)
- Svetamycin (1)
- Symbiont evolution (1)
- Symbiosis (1)
- Synovial Fibroblast (1)
- Systematics (1)
- T-Zellen (1)
- Tabanidae (1)
- Taxonomy (1)
- Technologieakzeptanz (1)
- Terpenes (1)
- Terpenoid (1)
- Thermus thermophilus (1)
- Tocochromanol (1)
- Transcriptomics (1)
- Transformation (1)
- Translational Psychiatry (1)
- Transport (1)
- Triatominae (1)
- Trichoptera (1)
- Tropical montane forest (1)
- Truffle (1)
- Trypanosoma cruzi (1)
- Typ 4 Pilus (1)
- Ustilaginomycotina (1)
- V1 (1)
- VEGF (1)
- Verbreitung (1)
- Verhalten (1)
- Verhaltensbiologie (1)
- Vitality monitoring (1)
- Western Kenya (1)
- X-ray crystallography (1)
- Xylose (1)
- Zeaxanthin (1)
- Zebrafish (1)
- Zoologie (1)
- aktuelles Interesse (1)
- alternative splicing (1)
- angiogenesis (1)
- antimicrobial resistance (1)
- arabinose (1)
- aroma (1)
- bacillary angiomatosis (1)
- bacteria-host interaction (1)
- bacterial infection (1)
- biodiversity (1)
- birds (1)
- brain waves (1)
- cobra (1)
- coevolution (1)
- color (1)
- conservation (1)
- consortia (1)
- control theory (1)
- cooperation (1)
- cophylogeny (1)
- cospeciation (1)
- crosslinking-mass spectrometry (1)
- cryo-EM (1)
- development (1)
- ecosystem services (1)
- elapid snake (1)
- elephant (1)
- endothelium (1)
- envenoming (1)
- environmental DNA (1)
- environmental attitudes (1)
- environmental behavior (1)
- environmental education (1)
- environmental knowledge (1)
- extracellular matrix (1)
- failure to diverge (1)
- fitness (1)
- freshwater crayfish (1)
- fungal phylogeny (1)
- fungi (1)
- gamma oscillations (1)
- genotype (1)
- geoecology (1)
- habitat heterogeneity (1)
- heat stress (1)
- hematopoietic stem cell (1)
- herbivores (1)
- hippo (1)
- host-switch (1)
- human-wildlife conflict (1)
- humorale Autoimmunantwort (1)
- infra-slow oscillation (1)
- krait (1)
- lateral line (1)
- livelihood (1)
- mPFC (1)
- mTOR (1)
- macrohabitat (1)
- mathematical modeling (1)
- mechanics (1)
- medically relevant (1)
- microRNA (1)
- microbiome (1)
- mitochondrial dysfunction (1)
- mounting (1)
- myeloid angiogenic cells (1)
- neuromodulation (1)
- non-timber forest products (NTFPs) (1)
- outdoor education (1)
- parathyroid hormone 2 (1)
- propagating waves (1)
- reptiles (1)
- ribosomes, Arabiodpsis thaliana, pre-rRNA processing, snoRNA, (1)
- sRNA (1)
- sage downy mildew (1)
- serine/arginine-rich proteins (1)
- shroom (1)
- siderophore-dependent iron uptake (1)
- sleep (1)
- smut fungi (1)
- snake bite (1)
- social isolation (1)
- socio-economics (1)
- species delimitation (1)
- splicing (1)
- stimulus repetition (1)
- sub-Saharan Africa (1)
- sugar uptake (1)
- surround suppression (1)
- symbiont association patterns (1)
- transglutaminase 2 (1)
- trimeric autotransporter adhesin (1)
- vegetation (1)
- venomous snakes (1)
- virtuelles Mikroskop (1)
- wwtr1 (1)
- xylose (1)
- yap1 (1)
- yeast (1)
- Ökotoxikologie (1)
Institute
- Biowissenschaften (246) (remove)
In recent years, several neuronal differentiation protocols were published that circumvent the requirement of embryoid body (EB) formation under serum-deprivation and simplified medium conditions. But a neuronal default model to establish an approach that works efficiently for all pluripotent cells and neuronal precursors is still lacking. Whether such a default neural mechanism exist and how this is implemented across a broad spectrum of cell source, is addressed in several studies and still controversially discussed. It was proposed that the default neuronal fate is initiated in the absence of extrinsic signals and is achieved by eliminating extracellular inhibitors of neuroectodermal fate and suppressing cell-cell signalling through limited cell density. Previous studies reported that ESC and ECC grown at low density and in absence of exogenous factors or feeder layers die within 24 h but acquire a neural identity as indicated by expression of the neural marker Nestin. Thus, this application is not suitable for generating neural cultures. Furthermore, it was reported that P19 cells survive and express neuroectodermal marker genes in serum-free DMEM/F12 medium containing transferrin, insulin, and selenite, although no neurites were identified.
Based on this background, in this study, a novel approach to induce neuronal differentiation in vitro was developed that implements a nutrient-poor environment, which, in contrast to previous studies, ensures the survival of neuronally differentiated cells over a long period of time and allows normal formation of neurites. Neither the formation of free-floating aggregates nor supplementation of growth factors or known inducers was required to establish a reliable neuronal differentiation protocol. A simple medium, consisting of DMEM/F12+N2 that was highly diluted in salt solution, was sufficient to drive a fast neuronal differentiation in monolayer cultures. Serum deprivation and strong dilution of DMEM/F12+N2 medium cause a nutrient-poor environment in which the influence of growth factors and inducers is minimized. This medium creates a metabolically defined environment that is presumably free of extrinsic signals that prevent the decision of neuronal fate. Analysis of the medium components discovered no actual inducer. Hence, it was suggested that the metabolic composition of the medium exclusively covers specific cell requirements of neurons, therefore ensures their survival, and drives the switch from pluripotent cells to neurons. The self-developed method was established by usage of the murine embryonal carcinoma cell line P19 and could be transferred to murine ESC. Consequently, the method could provide a feasible protocol for a generally valid neuronal default model.
The established protocol provides several advantages such as the possibility to generate stable pure neuronal cultures by a fast, simple, and highly reproducible one-step induction under defined medium conditions with a minimum of exogen effectors. The method is characterised by clear and steady medium conditions that makes the investigation of specific cell requirements during differentiation accessible. It is therefore expected to be a useful tool to investigate the molecular basis of neuronal differentiation as well as for high throughput screenings. The phenotype of mature postmitotic neurons was arising within one week and cultures were shown to stay stable at least for three weeks. The neuronal identity was confirmed by expression of neuronal markers through immunofluorescence staining and mass spectrometry analysis. Furthermore, increased levels of axon markers were detected in early neuronal differentiation and functionality of the synapses of the P19-derived neurons was ascertained by detection of calcium activity. Axonal laser ablation, immediately followed by fast regrowth of connections in the neuronal network, revealed a strong regeneration potential under the given conditions. Furthermore, the generated neurons showed a morphologically distinct phenotype and the formation of neural rosettes. Immunofluorescence staining demonstrated the generation of pure and homogeneous neuronal cultures, free of glial cells.
Retinoic acid (RA) plays an essential role in cell signalling during embryogenesis and efficiently induces neuronal differentiation in vitro in a concentration dependent manner. Neither retinol nor retinoic acid was included in any of the components of the self-prepared medium in this work. However, I observed, dependence on RARβ- and/or RARγ-regulated RA signalling in serum-free monolayer cultures. Nevertheless, neuronal differentiation in serum-free monolayer cultures was assumed to be RARα-independent because (i) RARα was slightly downregulated after neuronal induction, (ii) the truncated RARα of the RAC65 mutant had no effect on induction efficiency, and (iii) a pan-RAR inhibitor suppressed neuronal differentiation. In contrast to serum-free monolayer cultures, the truncated RARα prevented neuronal differentiation by application of the conventional protocol where cells are grown in free floating cell aggregates in serum-containing medium. Proteome analysis of P19 cells, treated by the self-developed differentiation protocol over five days showed increased levels of cellular RA binding proteins that mediate the cellular RA transport and are involved in canonical as well as non-canonical RA signalling.
...
1. Das Wachstum und die Fähigkeit zur Butyratproduktion von E. callanderi KIST612 wurde in geschlossenen Batch-Kulturen mit den Substraten Glukose, Methanol, Formiat, H2 + CO2 und CO untersucht. E. callanderi KIST612 zeigte sich nur bei Wachstum auf 20 mM Glukose oder 20 mM Methanol in der Lage, Butyrat in größeren Mengen (3,7 – 4,3 mM) zu produzieren. Das Hauptprodukt bei allen untersuchten Wachstumssubstraten war jedoch Acetat.
2. In bioinformatischen Analysen des Genoms von E. callanderi KIST612 konnte nur eine A1AO-ATP-Synthase gefunden werden, welche eine V-typ c-Untereinheit bestehend aus 4 TMH‘s mit nur einer Na+-Bindestelle aufweist. Diese konnte aus gewaschenen Membranen von E. callanderi durch Saccharose-Dichtegradientenzentrifugation, Anionenaustausch-Chromatographie (DEAE) sowie einer Größenausschluss-Chromatographie (Superose 6) bis zur apparenten Homogenität gereinigt werden. Nach Produktion einzelner Untereinheiten (A, B, C, D, E, F und H) in E. coli und Generierung von Antikörpern, konnten alle Untereinheiten (A, B, C, D, E, F, H, a sowie c) in der gereinigten Enzympräparation immunologisch oder mittels „Peptide-Mass-Fingerprinting“ nachgewiesen werden. Es konnte somit erstmals eine A1AO-ATP-Synthase aus einem mesophilen Organismus ohne Verlust von Untereinheiten gereinigt werden.
3. Der Gesamtkomplex wies unter nativen Bedingungen eine molekulare Masse von ca. 670 kDa auf. In elektronenmikroskopischen Aufnahmen zeigte sich anhand der hantelförmigen Strukturen, dass die A1AO-ATP-Synthase als intakter Gesamtkomplex gereinigt werden konnte.
4. Die gereinigte A1AO-ATP-Synthase wurde zunächst anhand ihrer ATP-Hydrolyse-Aktivität biochemisch charakterisiert. Die ATP-Hydrolyse-Aktivität hatte ein pH-Optimum von 7 – 7,5 und ein Temperaturoptimum bei 37 °C. Durch Messung der ATPase-Aktivität in Abhängigkeit von verschiedenen Mengen an Na+ konnte die vorhergesagte Na+-Abhängigkeit des Enzyms nachgewiesen werden. Zudem zeigten Hemmstoffexperimente mit DCCD, dass dieser Inhibitor mit Na+ um die gemeinsame Bindestelle in der c-Untereinheit konkurriert. Dies bestätigte nochmals, dass das Enzym funktionell gekoppelt gereinigt werden konnte.
5. Zur weiteren Untersuchung der Ionenspezifität wurde der an die ATP-Hydrolyse gekoppelte Ionentransport durch Rekonstitution des Enzyms in Liposomen und anschließender Messung des Na+- oder H+-Transports gemessen. In den Proteoliposomen konnte mit Hilfe von 22Na+ gezeigt werden, dass das Enzym Natriumionen translozieren kann. Während in Anwesenheit des Natriumionophors ETH 2120 kein 22Na+-Transport beobachtet werden konnte, führte die Anwesenheit des Protonophors TCS zu einer geringfügigen Stimulation der 22Na+-Translokation. Insgesamt konnte ein primärer Na+-Transport nachgewiesen werden, welcher von der A1AO-ATP-Synthase aus E. callanderi katalysiert wird.
6. Durch Rekonstitution der A1AO-ATP-Synthase aus E. callanderi in Liposomen konnte erstmals biochemisch nachgewiesen werden, dass ein solches Enzym trotz seiner V-Typ c-Untereinheit in der Lage ist, ATP zu synthetisieren. Durch die Zugabe von Ionophoren (ETH 2120 und TCS) konnte der elektrochemische Ionengradient aufgehoben werden, wodurch keine ATP-Synthese beobachtet werden konnte. Der erstmalige Nachweis der ATP-Synthese wurde bei einem ΔµNa+ von 270 mV erbracht.
7. Die ATP-Synthese zeigte sich ebenfalls abhängig von der Na+-Konzentration. Der KM-Wert lag bei 1,1 ± 0,4 mM und war vergleichbar mit dem für die ATP-Hydrolyse ermittelten Wert. Ebenso konnte für die ATP-Synthese-Richtung gezeigt werden, dass DCCD mit Na+ um die gemeinsame Bindestelle in der c-Untereinheit konkurriert.
8. Um den biochemischen Nachweis zu erbringen, dass die A1AO-ATP-Synthase auch unter physiologisch relevanten Potentialen zur ATP-Synthese befähigt ist, wurde der energetische Schwellenwert der ATP-Synthese bestimmt. Dieser betrug 87 mV als Triebkraft für ΔpNa, 94 mV als Triebkraft für Δψ und 90 mV als Triebkraft für ΔµNa+. Erstaunlicherweise konnte die ATP-Synthese der A1AO-ATP-Synthase aus E. callanderi KIST612 sowohl durch Δψ als auch ΔpNa angetrieben werden. Unterschiedliche Kombinationen von Δψ und ΔpNa führten zu dem gleichen energetischen Schwellenwert; Δψ und ΔpNa waren im Enzym aus E. callanderi KIST612 äquivalente Triebkräfte.
9. Der energetische Schwellenwert der A1AO-ATP-Synthase aus E. callanderi KIST612 wurde mit dem der F1FO-ATP-Synthasen aus A. woodii, E. coli und P. modestum verglichen. Dazu wurden die Enzyme im ATP-Synthase-defizienten E. coli-Stamm DK8 produziert und anschließend durch Ni2+-NTA-Affinitätschromatographie gereinigt. Nach Einbau der Enzyme in Liposomen waren alle Enzyme in der Lage, ATP als Reaktion auf ΔµNa+ (A. woodii und P. modestum) oder ΔµH+ (E. coli) zu synthetisieren. Im Vergleich zum Enzym aus E. callanderi zeigten sich zwei auffällige Unterschiede. Erstens war keine der F1FO-ATP-Synthasen in der Lage, ΔpNa/ΔpH als alleinige Triebkraft zu nutzen. Während die ATP-Synthese in den Enzymen aus E. coli und P. modestum nur durch ΔµH+ bzw. ΔµNa+ angetrieben werden konnte, konnte das Enzym aus A. woodii zusätzlich auch durch Δψ als einzige Triebkraft angetrieben werden.
...
This work comprises the investigation of four different biosynthesis gene clusters from Xenorhabdus. Xenorhabdus is an entomopathogenic bacterium that lives in mutualistic symbiosis with its Steinernema nematode host and together they infect and kill insect larvae. Xenorhabdus is well known for the production of so-called specialised metabolites and many of these compounds are synthesised by non-ribosomal peptide synthetases (NRPSs) or NRPS-polyketide synthase (PKS)-hybrids. These enzymes are organised in a modular manner and produce structurally very diverse molecules, often with the help of modifying domains and tailoring enzymes. In general, the genes involved in the biosynthesis are organised in so-called biosynthetic gene clusters (BGCs) in the genome of the producing strain. Exchanging the native promoter with an inducible promoter, e.g. PBAD, allows the targeted activation of the BGC and in turn the analysis of the biosynthesis product via LC-MS analysis.
The first BGC investigated in this work is responsible for the biosynthesis of xenofuranones. Based on gene deletions, this work shows that the NRPS-like enzyme XfsA produces a carboxylated furanone intermediate which is subsequently decarboxylated by XfsB to yield xenofuranone B. The next step in xenofuranone biosynthesis is the O-methylation of xenofuranone B to yield xenofuranone A. A comparative proteomics approach allowed the identification of four methyltransferase candidates and subsequent gene deletions confirmed one of the candidates to be responsible for methylation of xenofuranone B. The proteome analysis was based on the comparison of X. szentirmaii WT and X. szentirmaii Δhfq because distinct levels of the methylated xenofuranone A were observed when the xfs BGC was activated in either WT or Δhfq strain. Hfq is a global transcriptional regulator whose deletion is associated with the down regulation of natural product biosynthesis in Xenorhabdus. The strong PBAD activation of the xfs BGC also allowed the detection of two novel xenofuranone derivatives which arise from incorporation of one 4-hydroxyphenylpyruvic acid as first or second building block, respectively.
PBAD based activation of the second BGC addressed in this work lead to the detection of a novel metabolite and compound purification allowed NMR-based structure elucidation. The molecule exhibits two pyrrolizidine moieties and was named pyrrolizwilline (pyrrolizidine + twin (German: “Zwilling”)). The BGC comprises seven genes and single gene deletions as well as heterologous expression in E. coli and NRPS engineering were conducted to investigate the biosynthesis. The first two genes xhpA and xhpB encode a bimodular NRPS and a monooxygenase which synthesise a pyrrolizixenamide-like structure, similar to PxaA and PxaB in pyrrolizixenamide biosynthesis. It is suggested that the acyl side chain incorporated by XhpA is removed by the α,β-hydrolase XhpG. The keto function is then reduced by two subsequent two electron reductions catalysed by XhpC and XhpD. One of these two reduced pyrrolizidine units most likely is extended with glyoxalate prior to non-enzymatic dimerisation with the second pyrrolizidine moiety. To finally yield pyrrolizwilline, L-valine is incorporated, probably by the free-standing condensation domain XhpF.
The third BGC investigated is responsible for the production of a tripeptide composed of β-D-homoserine, α-hydroxyglycine and L-valine and is referred to as glyoxpeptide. This work demonstrates that the previously observed glyoxpeptide derivative is derived from glycerol present in the culture medium. Furthermore, this work shows that the monooxygenase domain, which is found in an unusual position between motifs A8 and A9 within the adenylation domain, is responsible for the α-hydroxylation of glycine. It is suggested that the α-hydroxylation of glycine renders the tripeptide prone to hydrolysis via hemiacetal formation. Hence, the XgsC_MonoOx domain might be an interesting candidate for further NRPS engineering.
The fourth BGC addressed is responsible for the production of xildivalines and this work describes two additional derivatives which are detected only when the promoter is exchanged and activated in the X. hominickii WT strain but not in X. hominickii Δhfq. Deletion of the methyltransferase encoding gene xisE results in the production of non-methylated xildivalines. It remains to be determined when the N-methylation of L-valine takes place. It is discussed that the methyltransferase could act on the NRPS released product but also during the assembly. The peptide deformylase is not involved in the proposed biosynthesis as xildivaline production is detected in a ΔxisD strain. The PKS XisB features two adjacent, so-called tandem T domains. The inactivation of the first or the second T domain by point mutation causes decreased production titres of detected xildivalines in the respective mutant strain when compared to the wild type.
Clean water is fundamental to human health and ecosystem integrity. However, water quality deteriorates due to novel anthropogenic pollutants present at microgram per liter concentrations in urban water cycles (termed micropollutants). Wastewater treatment plants (WWTP) have been identified as major point sources for aquatic (micro-)pollutants. Chemical and ecotoxicological analyses have shown that conventional biological WWTPs do not fully remove micropollutants and associated toxicities, which is often because of mobile, polar and/or recalcitrant compounds and transformation products (TPs). To minimize possible environmental risks, advanced wastewater treatment (AWWT) technologies could be a promising mitigation measure. Multiple processes are therefore being developed and evaluated such as ozonation and ozonation followed by granulated activated carbon (GAC) or biological filtration. Assessing the performance of these combined AWWTs was the focus the TransRisk project. Within this project, this thesis accomplished four major goals.
Firstly, the preparation of (waste)water samples was optimised for in vitro bioassays. Acidification, filtration and solid phase extraction (SPE) were tested for their impact on environmentally relevant in vitro endocrine activities, mutagenicity, genotoxicity and cytotoxicity. Significantly different outcomes of these assays were detected comparing neutral and acidified samples. Sample filtration had a lesser impact, but in some cases retention of particle-bound compounds could have caused significant toxicity losses. Out of three SPE sorbents the Telos C18/ENV at sample pH 2.5 extracted highest toxicity, some undetected in aqueous samples. These results indicate that sample preparation needs to be optimised for specific sample matrices and bioassays to avoid false-positive or -negative detects in effect-based analyses.
Secondly, the above listed in vitro toxicities were monitored in a protected region for drinking water production in South-West Germany (2012-2015). Out of 30 sampling sites surface water and groundwater were the least polluted. Nonetheless, a few groundwater samples induced high anti-estrogenic activity that prompted further monitoring. The latter included a waterworks in which no toxicity was detected. Hospital wastewater also had elevated in vitro toxicities and hospitals are, thus, relevant intervention points for source control. The biological WWTPs were effective in removing most of the detected toxicity, and the selected bioassays proved to be pertinent tools for water quality assessment and prioritisation of pollution hotspots.
Thirdly, the in vivo bioassay ISO10872 based on Caenorhabditis elegans (C. elegans) was adapted for this thesis. Using this model, a median effect concentration (EC50) for reproductive toxicity of the polycyclic aromatic hydrocarbon β-naphthoflavone (β- NF) of 114 µg/L was computed which is slightly lower than reported in the scientific literature. β-NF induced cyp-35A3::GFP (a biomarker in transgenic animals) in a time and concentration dependent manner (≤ 21.3–24 fold above controls). β-NF spiked wastewater samples supported earlier hypotheses on particle-bound pollutants. Reproductive toxicity (96 h) and cyp-35A3 induction (24 h) of biologically treated and/or ozonated wastewater extracts and growth promoting effects of GAC/biologically filtered ozonated wastewater extracts were observed. This suggested the presence of residual bioactive/toxic chemicals not included in the targeted chemical analysis. It also highlighted the importance of integrating multiple (apical and molecular) endpoints in wastewater assessments.
Fourthly, five in vitro and the adapted C. elegans bioassay were integrated into a wastewater quality evaluation (developed within TransRisk). Out of the five AWWT options, ozonation (at 1 g O3,applied/g DOC, HRT ~ 18 min) combined with nonaerated GAC filtration was rated most effective for toxicity removal. All five AWWTs largely removed estrogenic and (anti-)androgenic activities, but not anti-estrogenic activity and mutagenicity, which even increased during ozonation. This has been observed in related studies and points towards toxic TPs. These results also emphasized the need for implementing an effective post-treatment for ozonation. The results from a parallel in vivo study with Lumbriculus variegatus and Potamopyrgus antipodarum conducted on site at the WWTP (using flow through systems) were in accordance with the C. elegans results. In this context, it is suggested to further implement C. elegans as sensitive, feasible and ecologically relevant model.
In conclusion, this thesis shows how optimised sample preparation, long-term (in vitro) environmental monitoring, sensitive and ecologically relevant (in vivo) bioassays as well as innovative evaluation concepts, are pivotal in improving the removal of micropollutants and their toxicities with AWWTs. Future research should further develop and evaluate measures at sewer systems, conventional biological, tertiary and other advanced treatment technologies, as well as sociopolitical strategies (e.g., source control or natural conservation) and restoration projects. The effect-based tools optimised in this thesis will support assessing their success.
Zur Evolution der Hirnmorphologie und Anpassungen an Extremhabitate im Taxon Poecilia (Teleostei)
(2020)
Diese Dissertation befasst sich mit den Auswirkungen kontrastierender Umweltbedingungen auf die Gehirnmorphologie von neotropischen Fischen der Gattung Poecilia, welche unterschiedlichen abiotischen sowie biotischen Stressoren ausgesetzt sind. Da das Gehirn der Teleostei ein energetisch kostspieliges Organ und viel plastischer ist als z. B. bei Säugetieren, stellt sich die Frage, wie die Gehirnanatomie durch divergierende ökologische Faktoren in verschiedenen Umgebungen geformt wird, die ´extreme´, ´ressourcenbeschränkte und günstige´ Umgebungen repräsentieren. Zur Beantwortung dieser Frage wurden intraspezifische Studien an freilebenden und Laborindividuen von Poecilia-Arten durchgeführt, um die evolutionäre und ökologische Formgebung des Gehirns besser verstehen zu lernen. Im ersten Teil der Arbeit wurden Gehirnvolumina verglichen zwischen reproduktiv isolierten Populationen des neotropischen Fisches Poecilia mexicana (Ntotal = 95), die in Dunkelheit leben (Cueva Luna Azufre), in einem nahegelegenen Oberflächenhabitat (El Azufre), welcher giftigen Schwefelwasserstoff enthält und einer Kombination aus beiden Stressoren Dunkelheit und H2S (Cueva del Azufre). In einer zweiten Studie wurde auf anatomische („konvergente“) Veränderungen im Teleost-Gehirn entlang eines natürlichen Gradienten von Sulfidkonzentrationen getestet. Hierfür wurden Gehirne (Ntotal = 100) von P. mexicana verglichen, die in drei Flusssystemen im Süden Mexikos unabhängig voneinander eine erhöhte Toleranz gegenüber Schwefelwasserstoff (H2S) entwickelt haben. Dazu gehörten eine phylogenetisch alte H2S-adaptierte Form (P. sulphuraria) und zwei P. mexicana Formen, welche frühere Stufen der Anpassung an H2S darstellen. Zur Überprüfung des Einflusses anderer abiotischer und biotischer Faktoren auf die Morphologie der Gehirnregionen wurde eine weitere Studie durchgeführt. Hierbei wurden die phänotypischen Variationen der Gehirnregionen und der Körpermorphologie von Poecilia vivipara-Populationen (Ntotal = 211) aus Lagunen des Restinga de Jurubatiba Nationalpark untersucht, die sich in abiotischen Umgebungsbedingungen, insbesondere in Salzgehalt, Wassertransparenz, Phosphat und Nitrat sowie biotischen Faktoren wie Prädatorendichte unterschieden. Die erste Studie zeigte lebensraumabhängige Unterschiede bei freilebenden Fischen. Bei Fischen, die in Dunkelheit ohne H2S (LA) oder in Oberflächenhabitaten mit H2S lebten, wurden vergrößerte telenzephale Lappen, kleinere Augen und optische Tekta gefunden. Fische aus der sulfidischen Höhle (CA) zeigten zusätzlich vergrößerte Corpus cerebelli. Der Vergleich mit den Gehirnen von Labor aufgezogenen weiblichen Fischen (Ntotal = 25) zeigt eine allgemeine Verringerung der Gehirngröße sowie eine geringe Abweichung der Gehirngröße zwischen Labor aufgezogenen und freilebenden Fischen. Auch in der zweiten Studie zeigten alle in H2S-haltigen Lebensräumen lebenden Fische kleinere Augen, ein kleineres optisches Tektum und ein kleineres Gehirnvolumen, jedoch größere Corpus cerebelli und Hypothalamusvolumen als Fische aus nicht-sulfidischen Lebensräumen. Flusssystem-spezifische Effekte wurden für die telenzephalen Lappen, das gesamte Gehirn und die Augengröße festgestellt, da die Geschlechter je nach Quelle des Flusssystems unterschiedlich auf das Vorhandensein von H2S reagierten. Die dritte Studie zeigt auch, dass andere Umwelteinflüsse bemerkenswerte Verschiebungen im Gehirn und in den Gehirnregionen verursachen können. Fische, die im Süßwasser leben, zeigten eine verringerte Gesamthirngröße, telenzephale Lappen, Corpus cerebelli und Hypothalamusvolumen. Darüber hinaus zeigten Fische aus Salzwasserlagunen (hypersalin), ein verringertes Volumen des optischen Tektum, während telenzephale Lappen, Corpus cerebelli und Hypothalamusvolumen im Vergleich zu Süßwasserfischen vergrößert waren. Im Brackwasser lebende Fische wiesen im Vergleich zu Süß- und Salzwasserfischen die größten Gehirnregion-Volumen auf. Darüber hinaus zeigten die Ergebnisse über die Lagunen hinweg auch Unterschiede in der Morphologie der Kopf- und Augendurchmesser. Bei Augengröße, Kopfgröße, optischem Tektum Volumen, Hypothalamusvolumen und dem Gesamthirnvolumen wurde ein sexueller Dimorphismus beobachtet. Die dargestellten Ergebnisse verdeutlichen, dass die gefundenen Muster nahezu mit denen von H2S-Fischen identisch sind. Die ausgeprägten Unterschiede in den Hirnregionen zwischen freilebenden Fischen können als Teil der Mosaikentwicklung interpretiert werden. Die Ergebnisse der Laborpopulation zeigen jedoch eine hohe phänotypische Plastizität. Diese Studie unterstreicht damit die Bedeutung der Kombination der Untersuchung von freilebenden mit im Labor lebenden Individuen zur Beantwortung von Fragen der Gehirnentwicklung. Kleinere Augen und ein kleineres optisches Tektum, aber größere telenzephale Lappen wurden auch bei Fischen aus einem sulfidischen Oberflächenhabitat in der Nähe einer der Höhlen gefunden und sind den Ergebnissen zufolge das Resultat begrenzter Sehkraft in trüben sulfidischen Lebensräumen.
...
Ziel dieser Arbeit war es, einen genaueren Einblick in die Rolle von PaCLPXP für den Energiemetabolismus von P. anserina zu erhalten und mögliche Komponenten zu identifizieren, welche wichtig für die Langlebigkeit der PaClpP-Deletionsmutante sind. Folgende neue Erkenntnisse konnten hierbei gewonnen werden:
1. Die Substrat-Analyse durch eine Cycloheximid-Behandlung und anschließender Proteom-Analyse legte erfolgreich eine Reihe potentieller bisher nicht bekannter Substrate von PaCLPP offen. Interessanterweise waren unter den identifizierten Proteinen viele ribosomale Untereinheiten und Komponenten verschiedener Stoffwechselwege des Energiemetabolismus zu finden. Am auffälligsten unter diesen Substraten war die extreme Anreicherung eines Retikulon-ähnlichen Proteins, das einen neuen Aspekt der möglichen molekularbiologischen Rolle von PaCLPP in P. anserina andeutet.
2. Durch die Zugabe von Butyrat zum Medium, konnte erfolgreich die Autophagie sowohl im P. anserina Wildtyp als auch in der PaClpP-Deletionsmutante reduziert werden. Diese Verminderung der Autophagie sorgt bei ΔPaClpP für eine Verkürzung der Lebensspanne. Dieser Effekt ist spezifisch für die PaClpP-Deletionsmutante, während die Auswirkung von Butyrat auf den Wildtyp nur marginal ist. Dieses Ergebnis untermauert frühere Analysen dieser Deletionsmutante, welche besagen, dass die Langlebigkeit von ΔPaClpP Autophagie abhängig ist (Knuppertz und Osiewacz, 2017).
3. Die Metabolom-Analyse von ΔPaClpP im Vergleich zum Wildtyp zeigt, dass das Fehlen der PaCLPP zu Veränderungen in der Menge der Metaboliten der Glykolyse und des Citratzyklus kommt. Außerdem sind die Mengen der meisten Aminosäuren und der Nukleotide betroffen. Diese Analyse beweist, dass das Fehlen dieser mitochondrialen Protease weitreichende Folgen für die ganze Zelle hat. Durch die signifikante Verringerung von ATP und die Anreicherung von AMP in jungen ΔPaClpP-Stämmen und durch den Umstand der gesteigerten Autophagie in dieser Mutante, fiel das Augenmerk auf die AMPK. Dieses veränderte AMP/ATP-Verhältnis ist ein Indiz für eine gesteigerte AMPK-Aktivität und könnte auch den Umstand der gesteigerten Autophagie in ΔPaClpP erklären.
4. Das Gen codierend für die katalytische α-Untereinheit der AMPK (PaSnf1) konnte erfolgreich in P. anserina deletiert werden. Das Fehlen von PaSNF1 führt zu einer reduzierten Wuchsrate, eine beeinträchtige weibliche Fertilität und eine verzögerte Sporenreifung. Es konnte gezeigt werden, dass die Autophagie infolge einer PaSnf1-Deletion nicht gänzlich unterdrückt wird, PaSNF1 allerdings für die Stress-induzierte Autophagie notwendig ist. Überraschenderweise führt die Abwesenheit von PaSNF1 zu einer verlängerten Lebensspanne im Vergleich zum Wildtyp. Die meisten Effekte infolge einer PaSnf1-Deletion konnten durch die Einbringung eines FLAG::PaSNF1-Konstrukts komplementiert werden.
5. Eine gleichzeitige PaSnf1 und PaClpP-Deletion führt zu eine unerwarteten, extremen Lebenspannenverlängerung, die die Verlängerung der Lebensspanne bei der PaClpP-Deletionsmutante noch übertrifft. Interessanterweise geht dieser Phänotyp nicht mit einer erhöhten Autophagie einher. Des Weiteren konnte beobachtet werden, dass das Fehlen von PaSNF1 sowohl in ΔPaSnf1 als auch in ΔPaSnf1/ΔPaClpP zu einer veränderten Mitochondrien-Morphologie im Alter führt. Die Abwesenheit von PaSNF1 verursacht, dass die Stämme auch im Alter (20d) noch überwiegend filamentöse Mitochondrien aufweisen. Zudem zeigen die drei analysierten Deletionsstämme (ΔPaSnf1, ΔPaClpP und ΔPaSnf1/ΔPaClpP) massive Einschränkungen wenn sie auf die mitochondriale Funktion angewiesen sind.
6. Auffallend war, dass bei ΔPaSnf1, ΔPaClpP und bei ΔPaSnf1/ΔPaClpP die Stämme mit dem Paarungstyp „mat-“ langlebiger sind als die Stämme mit dem Paarungstyp „mat+“. Dieser Effekt ist bei der ΔPaSnf1/ΔPaClpP-Doppelmutante am stärksten ausgeprägt. Weitere Untersuchungen dazu ergaben, dass die Paarungstypen immer dann eine Rolle spielen, wenn die Stämme mitochondrialem Stress ausgesetzt, oder aber auf die mitochondriale Funktion angewiesen sind. Verantwortlich für diese Unterschiede sind zwei rmp1-Allele, die mit den unterschiedlichen Paarungstyp-Loci gekoppelt sind und mit dem jeweiligen Paarungstyp-Locus vererbt werden (rmp1-1 mit „mat-“; rmp1-2 mit „mat+“).
Seit den 1950er Jahren hat sich Plastik als unverzichtbare Ressource im menschlichen Alltag etabliert. Als negative Folge dieses Booms wird seit einigen Jahrzehnten jedoch eine zunehmende Belastung aquatischer Ökosysteme mit Plastikmüll bzw. dessen Degradationsprodukten, sogenanntes „Mikroplastik“ (MP, < 5 mm) bzw. „Nanoplastik“ (NP, < 1 µm), beobachtet. Ziel dieser Arbeit war die Untersuchung des aktuellen Vorkommens von MP in limnischen Gewässern, die Analyse der Interaktion zwischen MP und limnischen Wirbellosenarten und der daraus resultierenden Toxizität sowie eine erste Risikoabschätzung.
Das Vorkommen von Mikroplastik in limnischen Gewässern wurde exemplarisch anhand der Elbe als großes Fließgewässer in Deutschland untersucht. Durch die Auswertung von elf Probestellen entlang des Verlaufs der Mittel- und Unterelbe konnte gezeigt werden, dass die MP-Konzentrationen im Sediment (2,26x10^4 – 2,27x10^7 P m^-3) im Mittel fast 150.000-fach höher sind als in der Wasserphase (0,88–13,24 P m^-3). Sedimente sind somit eine Senke für MP. Die Zusammensetzung der Polymerarten sowie MP-Formen deuten zudem an, dass die Partikel sowohl aus diffusen wie auch aus Punktquellen (z.B. Industrieabwässer) stammen. Im globalen Vergleich können die MP-Konzentrationen in deutschen Fließgewässern z. Z. als durchschnittlich betrachtet werden. Allerdings muss insgesamt davon ausgegangen werden, dass die bisher bestimmten MP-Umweltkonzentrationen die realen Konzentrationen möglicherweise unterschätzen. So zeigte die Elbestudie, dass die Sedimentfeinfraktion < 100 µm einen bedeutenden Polymeranteil enthielt. Die meisten bisher durchgeführten Studien zur Bestimmung von MP-Partikeln in Flüssen haben Partikel < 100 µm jedoch nicht in ihrer Analyse berücksichtigt.
Die Interaktion von MP mit limnischer Biota wurde anhand der Artgruppen der Muscheln (Bivalvia), Schnecken (Gastropoda) sowie Krebstiere (Crustacea) näher untersucht. Die Intensität der Interaktion ist maßgeblich von der Aufnahme von MP durch die verschiedenen Arten abhängig. Anhand von zahlreichen Aufnahmestudien mit verschiedenen limnischen Arten, darunter den Muschelarten Dreissena polymorpha, Sinanodonta woodiana und Anodonta anatina, der Lungenschnecke Lymnaea stagnalis sowie der Amphipodenart Gammarus pulex, wurde nachgewiesen, dass die MP-Aufnahme von den Eigenschaften der exponierten Arten bzw. Individuen, den MP-Charakteristika sowie den Expositionsbedingungen abhängt. Die Experimente mit Muscheln verdeutlichten die rasche Aufnahme, aber auch Exkretion von MP-Partikeln innerhalb weniger Stunden. In allen drei Artgruppen war die Aufnahme konzentrationsabhängig mit zunehmender Aufnahme bei steigenden MP-Konzentrationen. Die Muschelexperimente zeigten jedoch auch, dass eine gleichzeitige Exposition mit anderen Partikeln (z.B. Nahrung) zu einer reduzierten Aufnahme führt. Auch die Größe der Testorganismen beeinflusste die Aufnahme: So nahmen im Fall der Muscheln und Krebse kleinere Individuen (bzw. im Fall der Muscheln auch Arten) relativ pro Körpermasse mehr MP-Partikel auf als größere Individuen bzw. Arten. Für alle untersuchten Arten wurde darüber hinaus gezeigt, dass die MP-Größe relevanten Einfluss auf die Menge an aufgenommenen Partikeln hat.
Ein Vergleich zwischen den Artgruppen zeigte, dass Muscheln als filtrierende Organismen in den Laboruntersuchungen bei gleicher Expositionskonzentration mehr MP aufnahmen als Krebse (Zerkleinerer) und Schnecken (Weidegänger). Im Gegensatz zu Muscheln nutzen Krebstiere und Schnecken allerdings die Grenzschicht zwischen Wasser- und Sedimentphase als Suchraum für ihre Nahrung und sind in der Umwelt (auf Grund des höheren MP-Vorkommens in Sedimenten) somit möglicherweise gegenüber höheren MP-Konzentrationen exponiert als Muscheln. Die Extrapolation der gewonnenen Labordaten sowie der Vergleich mit publizierten Umweltdaten legen allerdings nahe, dass das MP-Vorkommen in Individuen aller drei Artgruppen bisher auf einige wenige MP-Partikel begrenzt ist. Ausgeprägte Unterschiede zwischen den Artgruppen sind bisher nicht erkennbar.
MP-Toxizitätsstudien mit G. pulex, L. stagnalis sowie D. polymorpha konnten trotz der Berücksichtigung einer Vielzahl an Endpunkten (Mortalität, Reproduktion, Nahrungsaufnahme, oxidativer Stress, Energiereserven, Immunzellaktivität) und trotz des Einsatzes zum Teil sehr hoher MP-Konzentrationen weit oberhalb aktueller Umweltkonzentrationen nur sehr wenige MP-induzierte Effekte nachweisen, darunter eine Steigerung der Filtrationsaktivität (D. polymorpha) bzw. Veränderung der Immunfunktion von Hämolymphzellen (L. stagnalis).
Zur weiteren Risikoabschätzung wurden diese Studienergebnisse mit publizierten Daten für marine und limnische Muschel- und Krebsarten in Artenempfindlichkeitsverteilungen (Species Sensitivity Distributions, SSD) zusammengeführt und jeweils eine SSD für Muscheln und Krebstiere erstellt. Die Erstellung einer SSD nur für limnische Arten ist zum jetzigen Zeitpunkt auf Grund der geringen Datenlage noch nicht möglich.
...
Human GLUTs represent a family of specialized transporters that facilitate the diffusion of hexoses through membranes along a concentration gradient. The 14 isoforms share high sequence identity but differ in substrate specificity and affinity, and tissue distribution. According to their structure similarity, GLUTs are divided into three classes, with class 1 comprising the most intensively studied isoforms GLUTs1 4. An abnormal function of different GLUT members has been related to the pathogenesis of various diseases, including cancer and diabetes. Hence, GLUTs are the subject of intensive research, and efforts concentrate on identifying GLUT-selective ligands for putative medical purposes and their application in studies aiming to further unravel the metabolic roles of these transporters.
The hexose transporter deficient (hxt0) yeast strain EBY.VW4000 is devoid of all its endogenous hexose transporters and unable to grow on glucose or related hexoses. This strain has proven to be a valuable platform to investigate heterologous transporters due to its easy handling, increased robustness, and versatile applications. However, the functional expression of GLUTs in yeast requires certain modifications. Single point mutations of GLUT1 and GLUT5 led to their functional expression in EBY.VW4000, whereas the native GLUT1 was actively expressed in EBY.S7, a hxt0 strain carrying the fgy1 mutation that putatively reduces the phosphatidylinositol-4-phosphate (PI4P) content in the plasma membrane. GLUT4 was only actively expressed in the hxt0 strain SDY.022, which also contains the fgy1 mutation and in which ERG4 is additionally deleted. Erg4 is one of the late enzymes in the ergosterol pathway, and therefore SDY.022 probably has an altered sterol composition in its membrane.
The goal of this thesis was to actively express GLUT2 and GLUT3 in a hxt0 yeast strain, providing a convenient system for their ligand screening. A PCR-derived amino acid exchange in the sequence of GLUT3 enabled its functional expression in EBY.VW4000 and the unmodified GLUT3 protein was active in EBY.S7. Functional expression of GLUT2 was achieved by rational design. The extracellular loop between the transmembrane regions 1 and 2 is significantly larger in GLUT2 than in other class 1 GLUTs. By truncating this loop by 34 amino acids and exchanging an alanine for a serine, a GLUT3-like loop was implemented. The resulting construct GLUT2∆loopS was functional in EBY.S7. With an additional point mutation in the transmembrane region 11, GLUT2∆loopS_Q455R was also actively expressed in EBY.VW4000. Inhibition studies with the known GLUT inhibitors phloretin and quercetin showed a reduced transporter activity for GLUT2 and GLUT3 in uptake assays and growth tests when inhibitors were present, demonstrating that both systems are amenable for ligand screening experiments.
The newly established GLUT2 yeast system was then used to screen a library of compounds pre-selected by in silico screening. Thereby, eleven identified GLUT2 inhibitors exhibited strong potencies with IC50 values ranging from 0.61 to 19.3 µM. By employing the other yeast systems, these compounds were tested for their effects on GLUT1, and GLUTs3-5, revealing that nine of the identified ligands were GLUT2-selective. In contrast, one was a pan-class 1 inhibitor (inhibiting GLUTs1-4), and one affected GLUT2 and GLUT5, the two fructose transporting isoforms. These compounds will serve as useful tools for investigations on the role of GLUT2 in metabolic diseases and might even evolve into pharmaceutical agents targeting GLUT2-associated diseases.
Due to the beneficial effect of the putatively changed sterol composition in SDY.022 (by ERG4 deletion) on the functional expression of GLUT4, it was hypothesized that the presence of the human sterol cholesterol, or cholesterol-like sterols, might have a beneficial effect on GLUT expression, too. Thus, it was attempted to generate hxt0 strains that synthesize these sterols by genetic modifications targeting the ergosterol pathway. In the scope of these experiments, several strains with different sterol compositions were generated. Drop tests on glucose medium with the different strains expressing GLUT1 or GLUT4 revealed that the deletion of ERG6 is clearly advantageous for a functional expression of GLUT1 (but not GLUT4). This indicates that the methyl group at the ergosterol side chain (introduced by Erg6 and reduced by Erg4) negatively influences GLUT1 activity. However, this effect on GLUT1 activity was less pronounced than the putative altered PI4P content in EBY.S7.
Additionally, in this thesis, a new tool to measure glucose transport rates of transporters expressed in the hxt0 yeast system was developed to facilitate their kinetic characterization. For this, the pH-sensitive GFP variant pHluorin was employed as a biosensor for the cytosolic pH (pHcyt) by measuring the ratio (R390/470) of emission intensities at 512 nm from two different excitation wavelengths (390 and 470 nm). Sugar-starved cells exhibit a slightly acidic pHcyt because ATP production is depleted, reducing the activity of ATP-dependent proton pumps.
...
My PhD work employed genetic and pharmacological manipulations, coupled with highresolution live imaging, to understand intercellular communications during zebrafish cardiovascular development. The heart is the first organ to form, and it is composed of several tissues, among which interactions are crucial. I identified two important interactions between muscular and non-muscular tissues in poorly characterized contexts, and the molecules required for the signalling. First, I discovered an important cellular and molecular crosstalk orchestrating the development of the cardiac outflow tract (i.e., the aortic root in mammals).
Endothelial-derived TGF-beta signalling controls the generation of the local extracellular matrix (ECM). The ECM in turn affects endothelial proliferation as well as smooth muscle cell organization (Boezio et al, 2020; Bensimon-Brito*, Boezio* et al, 2020). In my second project, I investigated the crosstalk between the epicardial layer and the myocardial wall. By generating epicardial-impairment models, I identified a novel role for the epicardium in regulating cardiomyocyte volume during heart development (Boezio et al, 2021). Ultimately, this research contributed to our understanding of how paracrine signalling controls the multicellular interactions integral to organogenesis.
Tissue translocation, multigenerational and population effects of microplastics in Daphnia magna
(2021)
The last century saw the widespread adoption of plastic materials throughout nearly every aspect of our lives. Plastics are synthetic polymers that are made up of monomer chains. The properties of the monomer in conjunction with chemical additives allow plastics to have a sheer endless variety of features and use cases. They are cheap, lightweight, and extremely durable. Plastic materials are often engineered for single-use and in conjunction with high production volumes and insufficient waste management and recycling across the globe, this leads to a large number of plastics entering the environment. Marine ecosystems are considered sinks. However, freshwater ecosystems as entry pathways are highly affected by plastic waste as well. Throughout the past decade, the impact of plastic waste on human and environmental health has received a lot of attention from the ecotoxicological community as well as the public. Small plastic fragments (< 1 mm called microplastics) are a large part of this emerging field of research. Within this, the water flea Daphnia magna is probably the most common organism that is used to assess microplastics toxicity. As a filter-feeding organism, it indiscriminately ingests particles from the water column and is thus highly susceptible to microplastics. For this thesis, we identified some gaps in the available data on the ecotoxicity of microplastics to daphnids. To illuminate some of those gaps the present thesis was aimed at five main aspects:
(1) Tissue translocation of spherical microplastics in Daphnia magna
(2) Investigation of the toxicity of irregularly shaped microplastics
(3) Multigenerational and population effects of microplastics
(4) Comparison of the toxicity of microplastics and natural particles
(5) Effects of particle-aging on microplastics toxicity
The thesis is comprised of three peer-reviewed articles and one so-far unpublished study as “additional results”. The first study was aimed at understanding tissue translocation of spherical microplastics to lipid storage droplets of daphnids. The crossing of biological membranes is discussed as a prerequisite to eliciting tissue damage and an inflammatory response. Previously, researchers reported the translocation of fluorescently labeled spherical microplastics to lipid storage droplets of daphnids, even though no plausible biological mechanism to explain this occurrence. Therefore, in order to learn more about this process and potentially illuminate the mechanism we replicated the study. We were able to observe a fluorescence signal inside the lipid droplets only after increasing the exposure concentrations. Nonetheless, it appeared to be independent of particles. This led to the hypothesis, that the lipophilic fluorescent dye uncoupled from the particles and subsequently accumulated in lipid storage droplets. The hypothesis was further confirmed through an additional experiment with a silicone-based passive sampling device showing that the fluorescence occurred both independent of particles and digestive processes. Accordingly, we concluded that the reported findings were a microscopic artifact caused by the uncoupling of the dye from the particles. Therefore, a fluorescence signal alone is not a sufficient proxy to assume that particles have translocated. It needs to be coupled with additional methods to ensure that the observation is indeed caused by the translocation of particles.
It is still unclear whether the toxicity profile of microplastics is different from that of naturally occurring particles or if they are “just another particle”, as there are innumerable amounts in the natural environment surrounding an organism. The goal of the second study was to compare the toxicity of irregularly shaped polystyrene microplastics to that of the natural particle kaolin. The environment is full of natural non-food particles that daphnids ingest more or less indiscriminately and therefore are well adapted to deal with. Daphnids have a short generation time and usually experience food limitation in nature. Therefore, short-term studies only looking at acute toxicity with ad libitum food availability are not representative of the exposure scenario in nature. For a more realistic scenario, we, therefore, used a four-generation multigenerational design under food limitation to investigate how effects translate from one generation to the next. We observed concentration-dependent effects of microplastics but not of natural particles on mortality, reproduction, and growth. Some of the effects increased from generation to generation, leading to the extinction of two treatment groups. Here, microplastics were more toxic than natural particles. At least part of this difference can be explained by physical properties leading to the quick sedimentation of the kaolin, while microplastics remained in the water column. Nonetheless, buoyancy and sedimentation would also affect exposure in the environment and are likely different for most microplastics than for most naturally occurring particle types.
...
In order to form an organ, cells need to take up specialized functions and tasks. Cellular specialization is guided by an interplay of chemical signals and physical forces, where one influences the other. One aspect in cellular identity is its shape, which e.g. defines how susceptible the cell may be to intercellular signaling or in which section of the cell cycle it is and therefore can tell us about its current state. Shape changes are introduced by motor proteins that are controlled and activated in a locally confined manner. For my thesis, I was interested to understand better how cellular shape and geometry impacts downstream cell and organ development. What happens if a cell cant transition to a specific shape? How does it affect tissue structure? How does it affect further development?
One regulator of motor proteins like non-muscle myosin is Shroom3, which recently has been been shown to be expressed and involved in the development of the zebrafish lateral line organ (1 ). Development of the lateral line occurs through a migrating cluster of initially about 150 cells, the posterior lateral line primordium (pLLP), which migrates from the anterior (head) to the posterior (tail) while depositing cell clusters in a regular pattern. Literature on development of the lateral line suggests that in order for a cell cluster to be deposited from the pLLP, rosette formation is a key requirement. Therefore our expectation from the shroom3 mutant was that the number of clusters deposited was significantly reduced. To our surprise, when we first inspected the end of migration lateral line phenotype we found many individuals with a significant increase in cell clusters deposited.
This made us re-think the role of Shroom3 during rosette assembly and the processes its involved in.
To study the effects of Shroom3 on lateral line development, a mutant line was generated and crossed with various transgenic lines which express fluorescently labeled proteins that locate to organelles such as the plasmamembrane or the nucleus. Following, the mutant with its fluorescent labels was microscopically imaged under different conditions to quantify and analyze various cell-morphometric features. Even though the zebrafish is a popular model organism and its perfectly suited for developmental biology and advanced microscopy, there were no methods that would allow for a standardized and more automated pipeline of data acquisition and processing.
Therefore, in order to accurately quantify the morphogenic processes Shroom3 is involved in, I developed a new toolset that significantly improved and facilitated my research. The toolset consists of (1) a new sample mounting method that is based on a 3D agarose gel that increases the number of embryos that can be mounted and imaged at once and speeds up the imaging process significantly (2) for subseqent image analysis I developed four programs that automate the process and therefore make the results much more reproducible and the analysis much more efficient. The first program is used for end of migration analyses, to deduce the pattern, count and size of Lateral Line cell clusters. The second is used not for end of migration, but for migration analyses (on timelapse recordings). Besides this it also prepares the images for more advanced downstream migration analyses and allows to analyse fluorescence signal on a second channel. The third program is used to analyse the pLLP only at high spatial resolution and to deduce the cell count, 3D cell morphometrics (like the volume) and cell orientation. The fourth program finally is used downstream of the second and third program and is capable of detecting and comparing them with the look of wildtype rosettes.
Here I show that in absence of Shroom3 rosette formation in the migrating pLLP is destabilized leading to facilitated cell cluster deposition and I show how this might be related to traction forces due to a possible interdependence of pLLP acceleration and speed of migration. Furthermore I show that apical constriction and rosette formation is not blocked in Shroom3 deficient embryos, but that larger rosettes are fragmented into many smaller ones. Finally, I give an outlook on how the absense of Shroom3 and hence the absense of morphological changes may deregulate gene transcription by elevating the levels Atoh1a, a transcription factor necessary for hair cell development.
My results and methodology demonstrate the importance of morphology in guiding developmental processes and how rather small morphological changes on the cellular level can impact further development significantly. My work also shows how powerful modern genetics, imaging and image analysis are and how diverse they are in terms of range of questions they are capable of answering. The methods and tools I developed prepare the ground for at least three quarters of the analyses I carried out and together with the documentation and data I provide, they are highly reproducible. In that regard I am especially happy that one of my developments, an improved sample preparation method, is already used by many different labs all over the world helping them to make their results more reproducible.
Across the entire animal kingdom, sociality, i.e. the tendency of individual animals to form a group with conspecifics, is a common trait. Environmental changes have to be met with corresponding, quick adaptations. For social species, the presence of conspecifics is important for survival and if social animals are deprived of access to conspecifics, this can lead to strong and lasting changes on a physiological level as well as behaviour. Gene expression changes responsible for these adaptations have so far not been understood in detail. As social isolation leads to changes on a neuronal level, it is important to investigate the gene expression changes that are induced in the brain. In this thesis, next-generation RNA-sequencing was applied to zebrafish, a well-established model organism characterized by its high degree of companionship. Within the entire brain, gene expression was analysed in zebrafish that were raised either with conspecifis or in isolation, ranging from 5 to 21 days post fertilization. Using this approach, several genes were identified that were downregulated by social isolation. In this thesis, I focused on one of these consistently downregulated genes, parathyroid hormone 2 (pth2). The expression of pth2 was demonstrated to be bidirectionally regulated by the number of conspecifics present and to be responsive to changes in the social environment within 30 minutes. Regulation of pth2 does not occur by visual or chemosensory access to conspecifcs, but is mediated by mechanosensory perception of other fish via the lateral line. In an experiment using an artificial mechanical stimulation paradigm, it was shown that the features necessary to elicit pth2 transcription closely mimick the locomotion of actual zebrafish. Other, similar stimulation paradigms are not capable to induce this transcriptional response.
Terpenes are one of the largest and most diverse class of natural products, produced by organisms from all kingdoms of life and with important applications in the pharma, flavor and fragrance industries. Well-known examples of terpenes are the pharmaceuticals artemisinin and taxol, the flavor and fragrance compounds menthol, santalol and sclareol, the structural material polyisoprene and the biofuel precursor farnesene. The methods and results presented in this work offer a variety of ways to modify terpene precursors for the creation of new terpene molecules. The application of these methodologies in well-established production systems could lead to the production of new substances, with applications in the industrial fields of pharmaceuticals, flavors and fragrances, and biofuels.
Global biodiversity is changing rapidly and contemporary climate change is an important driver of this change. As climate change continues, the challenge is to understand how it may affect the future of biodiversity. This is relevant to informing policy and conservation, but it requires reliable future projections of biodiversity. Biodiversity is the variety of life on Earth which includes the diversity of species. The species on Earth are linked in diverse networks of biotic interactions. Interacting species can respond differently to climate change. This can cause spatial or temporal mismatches between interacting species and result in secondary extinctions of species that lose obligate interaction partners. Yet, accounting for biotic interactions in biodiversity projections remains challenging. One way to address this challenge is the use of trait-based approaches because the impact of climate change on interacting species is influenced by species’ functional traits, i.e., measurable characteristics of the species that influence their abiotic and biotic interactions. First, species’ functional traits influence how species respond to climate change. Second, they influence whether the species find compatible interaction partners in reshuffled species assemblages under climate change. Thus, the overarching aim of this dissertation was to explore how trait-based approaches can increase our understanding of how climate change might affect interacting species. For this, I focussed on interactions between fleshy-fruited plants and avian frugivores along a tropical elevational gradient.
I investigated three principal research questions. First, I investigated how traits related to the sensitivity of avian frugivores to climate change and their adaptive capacity vary along elevation and covary across species. I combined estimates of species’ climatic niche breadth (approximating species’ sensitivity) with traits influencing species’ dispersal ability, dietary niche breadth and habitat niche breadth (aspects of species’ adaptive capacity). Species’ climatic niche breadth increased with increasing elevation, while their dispersal ability and dietary niche breadth decreased with increasing elevation. Across species, there was no significant relationship of the sensitivity of the avian frugivores to climate change and their adaptive capacity. The opposing patterns of species’ sensitivity to climate change and their adaptive capacity along elevation imply that species from assemblages at different elevations may respond differently to climate change. The independence between species’ sensitivity and adaptive capacity suggests that it is important to account for both sensitivity and adaptive capacity to fully understand how climate change might affect biodiversity.
Second, I assessed how climate change might influence the co-occurrence of interaction partners with compatible traits, i.e., the functional correspondence of interacting species. I integrated future projections of species’ elevational ranges considering different vertical dispersal scenarios with analyses of the functional diversity of interacting species assemblages. The functional correspondence of fleshy-fruited plants and avian frugivores was lowest if plant and bird species were projected to contract their ranges towards higher elevations in response to increasing temperatures. Contrastingly, if species were projected to expand their ranges upslope, the functional correspondence remained close. The low functional correspondence under a scenario of range contraction indicates that plant species with specific traits might miss compatible interaction partners in future assemblages. This could negatively affect their seed dispersal ability. These results suggest that ensuring the integrity of biotic interactions under climate change requires that species can shift their ranges upslope unlimitedly.
Third, I examined whether avian seed dispersal is sufficient for plants to track future temperature change along the elevational gradient. With a trait-based modelling approach, I simulated seed-dispersal distances avian frugivores can provide to fleshy-fruited woody plant species and quantified the number of long-distance dispersal events the plant species would require to fully track projected temperature shifts along elevation. Most plant species were projected to require several long-distance dispersal events to fully track the projected temperature shifts in time. However, the number of required long-distance dispersal events varied with the degree of trait matching and plant species’ traits. These findings suggest that avian seed dispersal is insufficient for plants to track future temperature change along the elevational gradient as woody plant species might not be able to undergo several consecutive long-distance dispersal events within a short time window, due to their long maturation times. These results also imply that the ability of bird-dispersed plant species to track climate change is associated with the specialization of the seed dispersal system and with plant species’ traits.
Trait-based approaches are promising tools to study impacts of climate change on interacting species. The trait-based approaches that I have developed in this thesis are applicable more widely, e.g., to other types of biotic interactions, or to assess the effects of other drivers of global change. Moreover, these approaches may be further developed to model changes in biotic interactions under global change more dynamically. Taken together, I have shown how a trait-based perspective could help to account for biotic interactions in biodiversity projections. The development of such approaches and the gained knowledge are urgently needed to facilitate the conservation of biodiversity in a rapidly changing world.
Genetic and genomic tools have provided researchers with the opportunity to address fundamental questions regarding the reintroduction of species into their historical range with greater precision than ever before. Reintroduction has been employed as a conservation method to return locally extinct species to their native range for decades. However, it remains unknown how genetic factors may impact population establishment and persistence at the population and metapopulation level in the short- and long-term. Genetic methods are capable of producing datasets from many individuals, even when only low quality DNA can be collected. These methods offer an avenue to investigate unanswered questions in reintroduction biology, which is vital to provide evidence based management strategies for future projects. The Eurasian lynx (Lynx lynx) and European wildcat (Felis silvestris) are elusive carnivores native to Eurasia and have been the subject of multiple reintroduction attempts into their native range. During the 19th and 20th century, the Eurasian lynx was extirpated from West and Central Europe due to increasing habitat fragmentation and persecution. Similarly, the European wildcat was the subject of human persecution, residing in a few refugia in West and Central Europe. After legal protection in the 1950s, subsequent reintroduction projects of both species began in the 1970s and 1980s and continue to the present. Despite this large focus on species conservation, little attention has been given to the consequences these reintroductions have on the genetic composition of the reintroduced populations and if the populations have a chance of persisting in the long term. These species have not yet benefited from the large range of genetic and genomic techniques currently available to non-model organisms, leaving many fundamental aspects of their reintroduction poorly understood. In my dissertation, I investigate demography, population structure, genetic diversity and inbreeding at the population and metapopulation level in both species. In the introduction, which lays the foundation for the subsequent chapters of this PHD, I provide background on reintroduction, its role in conservation and the genetic consequences on populations, especially populations of apex and mesocarnivores. In Publication I, I investigated the reemergence of the European wildcat in a low mountain region in Germany using fine-scale spatial analysis. I found that the reintroduced population has persisted and merged with an expanding natural population. The reintroduced population showed no genetic differentiation from the natural population suggesting there is a good chance this population has retained sufficient genetic diversity despite reintroduction. In Publication II, I tracked population development and genetic diversity over 15 years in a reintroduced lynx population to determine the genetic ramifications on a temporal scale. I found slow genetic erosion after a period of outbreeding, which fits in line with other reintroduced taxa sharing similar demographic histories. I also found the number of genetic founders to be a fraction of the total released individuals, indicating that reintroduced populations of elusive carnivores may have fewer founder individuals than previously thought. In Publication III, I sampled all surviving lynx reintroductions in West and Central Europe as well as 11 natural populations to compare levels of genetic diversity and inbreeding across the species distribution. I found that all reintroduced populations have lower genetic variability and higher inbreeding than natural populations, which urgently requires further translocations to mitigate possible negative consequences. These translocations could stem from other reintroduced populations or from surrounding natural populations. The results contribute to a growing body of evidence indicating that inbreeding is likely to be more prevalent in wild populations than previously understood. Finally, in the discussion I explore how genetic methods can be applied to post-reintroduction monitoring of felid species to illuminate questions relating to genetic composition after release. The methods employed in these studies and in future work will be highly dependent on the research questions posed. Additionally, I investigate the drivers of the observed genetic patterns including founder size, source population, environmental factors, and population growth. I found that genetic diversity loss patterns across these two felid species are not clearly defined, however, management actions can be taken to mitigate the negative effects of reintroductions. These management actions include further translocation, introducing a sufficient number of released individuals and situating reintroductions adjacent to natural populations. All of these actions can minimize genetic drift and inbreeding, two factors which negatively impact small populations. This thesis further supports mounting evidence that genetic considerations should be assessed before releasing individuals, which allows for incorporation of scientific evidence into the planning process thereby increasing the overall success of reintroduction projects. Ultimately, the resources developed during this dissertation provide a solid baseline and foundation for future work regarding the consequences of reintroductions. This is especially important as an increasing number of species are at risk of extinction and reintroductions of both the European wildcat and Eurasian lynx, as well as many others, are planned in the coming years.
Morbus Parkinson (abgekürzt als PD vom Englischen Parkinson’s disease) ist nach Alzheimer die zweithäufigste neurodegenerative Erkrankung. Die Hauptmerkmale sind Rigidität und Bradykinesie, sowie Tremor und posturale Instabilität. Im Gehirn lässt sich bei Parkinsonpatienten post mortem ein Verlust an Neuronen in der Substantia nigra feststellen, was zu den ersten beiden Anzeichen führt. Zudem gibt es intrazelluläre Einschlüsse in den betroffenen Nervenzellen – Lewy-Körperchen genannt – die aus Alpha-Synuklein und anderen Proteinen wie Ubiquitin zusammengesetzt sind. Außerdem ist der Eisenmetabolismus in Gehirnen von Parkinsonpatienten gestört und man findet Eisen-Ablagerungen, vor allem im Mittelhirn. Die Ursachen für PD sind bislang nicht abschließend geklärt. Der Großteil der Fälle ist sporadischer Natur mit unbekannter Ursache und nur bei einem geringen Anteil liegt eine Mutation in einem einzelnen Gen zugrunde. Die häufigsten Mutationen tritt in den Genen für Alpha-Synuklein (SNCA), PINK1 und PARKIN auf.
Die Serin-Threonin-Kinase PINK1 und die E3-Ubiquitin-Protein-Ligase PARKIN sind zwei Proteine, die in Stresssituationen an der Mitochondrien-Außenmembran am Abbau von alten oder nicht richtig funktionierenden Mitochondrien beteiligt sind. Dieser Vorgang nennt sich Mitophagie.
Die dieser Arbeit zugrunde liegenden Publikationen gehen den Zusammenhängen zwischen mitochondrialen Fehlfunktionen und der Pathogenese von PD nach. Da die Krankheit meist erst im hohen Alter auftritt, davon größtenteils ohne direkte Ursache, liegt der Schluss nahe, dass neben genetischen Ursachen auch Umweltfaktoren eine größere Rolle spielen könnten. Um dies näher zu analysieren, wurden experimentell verschiedene Stressoren eingesetzt.
Insgesamt wurden folgende Aspekte untersucht:
I. Welche Auswirkungen hat das Fehlen von PINK1 auf die Zelle? Gibt es einen Biomarker, der mit höherem Alter immer stärker verändert ist?
II. Welchen Einfluss haben Umweltfaktoren wie veränderte Eisen-Exposition auf die Zelle und was verändert sich beim Fehlen von PINK1?
III. Wie können mitochondriale Fehlfunktionen präferentiell das Nervensystem betreffen, wenn es nicht um respiratorische Insuffizienz geht?
Die einzelnen Studien zeigten folgende Ergebnisse:
Torres-Odio/Key et al. 2017 widmete sich der Suche nach molekularen Biomarkern, wodurch PD präsymptomatisch erkannt und die Progression der Erkrankung eingeschätzt werden kann. Die Transkriptom-Analyse der Kleinhirne von Mäusen mit Pink1-/--Mutation in drei verschiedenen Altersstufen zeigte eindrücklich, dass nicht ein einzelner Faktor immer stärker verändert war, sondern, dass immer mehr Faktoren und daher auch eine steigende Zahl an
Signalwegen mit höherem Alter beteiligt waren. Diese Veränderungen betrafen inflammatorische Signalwege, insbesondere Faktoren, die mit der Erkennung und Verarbeitung von zellfremden Nukleinsäuren assoziiert sind. Aufgrund der evolutionären Herkunft von Mitochondrien als frühere Protobakterien haben mitochondriale Nukleinsäuren und Proteine zum Teil bakterielle Ähnlichkeiten, und könnten bei Fehlfunktionen ins Zytosol gelangen. Vor diesem Hintergrund lassen die Ergebnisse der Studie den Schluss zu, dass das angeborene Immunsystem in Neuronen durch eine PINK1-assoziierte mitochondriale Störung aktiviert wird.
In der Publikation Key et al. 2020 wurde Eisen als ein im täglichen Leben vorkommender Stressor eingesetzt und es wurden systematisch Faktoren des Eisenstoffwechsels bei hohen und niedrigen Eisenspiegeln im Zusammenhang mit Parkinson-Mutationen untersucht. Da Eisen für die Gesundheit von Mitochondrien eine große Rolle spielt und Eisen-Chelatoren als Therapie bei PD Patienten bereits diskutiert werden, haben die molekularen Befunde große Relevanz. Die Ergebnisse zeigen, dass unter niedrigen Eisenspiegeln Proteine reduziert waren, die am Nukleotid-Stoffwechsel beteiligt sind, sowie Faktoren, die Eisen-Schwefel-Cluster als Cofaktoren haben und wichtig für die Nukleotid-Qualitätskontrolle sind. Das Fehlen von Eisen führte zu einer Induktion von Pink1 und Prkn, was auf verstärkte Mitophagie hindeutet. Insgesamt konnte gezeigt werden, dass die mitochondriale Eisen-Schwefel-Cluster Biogenese und die post-transkriptionelle Eisenregulation entscheidend für die Pathogenese von PD, bzw. das gesunde Fortbestehen einer Zelle und letztlich auch eines Organismus sind.
In Key et al. 2019 wurde erstmalig das Gesamt-Ubiquitylom aus Gehirnen von gealterten Parkin-knockout (KO) Mäusen erhoben und analysiert, um Ubiquitylierungs-Substrate von PARKIN zu identifizieren. Hierbei zeigte sich eine veränderte Ubiquitylierung von mehreren Faktoren, die an der zellulären Calcium-Homöostase beteiligt sind. Weitere elektrophysiologische Experimente in Gehirnen von gealterten Parkin-/--KO Mäusen ergaben, dass in Nervenzellen im Locus coeruleus die Geschwindigkeit der spontanen Taktgeber erhöht, dass die langsame Nachhyperpolarisation reduziert und, dass die Dauer der Aktionspotentiale erniedrigt war, ohne Veränderung der Kaliumkanal-Ströme.
Insgesamt geht aus den drei Studien hervor, dass mitochondriale Fehlfunktionen bei dauerhaftem Bestehen weitreichende Folgen für die Gesundheit des Nervensystems haben können, denn auch kleine Veränderungen, seien es durch Mutationen oder Umweltfaktoren wie Eisen, können in einer so großen Lebensspanne wie der des Menschen über Krankheit oder Gesundheit entscheiden!
In allen drei Domänen des Lebens ist in der Translation die Initiation der geschwindigkeits-bestimmende Schritt. Die Effizienz der Translationsinitiation und ihre unterschiedliche Regula-tion ist von Translationsinitiationsfaktoren (IFs) abhängig. Bakterien enthalten nur drei IFs, während die Anzahl bei Archaeen (aIFs) und Eukaryoten (eIFs) deutlich höher ist.
Das Archaeon Haloferax volcanii beispielsweise besitzt 14 Gene, die für aIFs bzw. deren Untereinheiten kodieren. Eine Deletionsanalyse ergab, dass fünf aIFs essenziell und neun aIFs nicht essenziell sind. Um einen Einblick in die Funktions- und Interaktionsbereiche der aIFs in H. volcanii zu erhalten, wurden die aIFs mit einem His-Tag versehen und überexpri-miert. Die Überexpression erfolgte in der jeweiligen Deletionsmutante. Für essenzielle aIFs fand sie im Wildtyp statt. Durch Affinitätsaufreinigungen wurden die aIFs und ihre Bindungs-partner isoliert und mittels Massenspektrometrie (MS) identifiziert. Für den Ausschluss unspe-zifischer Proteine dienten zwei stringente Kontrollen als Referenz, das Reportergen Dihydro-folatreduktase (HVO_1279) mit His-Tag und das Expressionsplasmid ohne Gen.
Die ersten Arbeiten konzentrierten sich auf den heterotrimeren Faktor aIF2. Er bindet die Ini-tiator-tRNA und ist damit für die Bildung des Präinitiationskomplexes von zentraler Bedeu-tung. Der Faktor aIF2 besteht aus jeweils einer α-, β- und γ-Untereinheit. In H. volcanii existie-ren zwei Orthologe für aIF2β. Die Überexpressionen der α-, β1-, β2- und γ-Untereinheiten führten zur Co-Isolation der jeweils anderen Untereinheiten des aIF2 (α, β1/ β2, γ).
Die Strategie der Co-Affinitätsaufreinigung und MS wurde auf alle weiteren annotierten aIFs ausgedehnt, um mögliche Funktionen zu identifizieren und ein potenzielles Interaktionsnetz-werk der aIFs zu erstellen. Für alle aIFs konnte ein unterschiedliches Muster an co-gereinigten Proteinen festgestellt werden. Mitgereinigte Proteine waren aIFs, Proteine der Translation, Transkription, Replikation und ribosomale Proteine. Auch RNA-Polymerase-Untereinheiten (RNAPUs) konnten co-isoliert werden. Mit 13 der 14 aIFs konnten andere Ini-tiationsfaktoren co-gereinigt werden. Sechs aIFs konnten zu Beginn bei keinem weiteren Initi-ationsfaktor mitgereinigt werden. Einer dieser Faktoren war aIF2β-1, der jedoch in den Affini-tätsaufreinigungen mit nachfolgender FPLC von aIF2β-2 identifiziert werden konnte. Der Fak-tor aIF1 konnte nur in der stationären Phase von aIF2α mitgereinigt werden.
Die am häufigsten co-gereinigten Proteine waren aIF2Bδ-1 und aIF5B. Für aIF2Bδ-1 kam dies überraschend, da er bereits als Translationsinitiationsfaktor ausgeschlossen wurde. Mit dem Faktor aIF2Bδ-1 selbst konnten fünf aIFs co-gereinigt werden.
Da mit den aIFs auch RNAPUs co-gereinigt werden konnten, wurden sieben RNAPUs ebenfalls mit einem His-Tag versehen und überexprimiert. Auch mit den RNAPUs konnten aIFs, sowie weitere Proteine der Translation mitgereinigt werden.
Diese Umstände legen nahe, dass es möglicherweise eine engere Verbindung der Tran-skription und Translation in H. volcanii geben könnte, als bisher angenommen.
Fatty acids in oomycetes
(2021)
Das Vorkommen von Kunststoffmaterialien <5 mm, sogenanntem Mikroplastik
(MP), in marinen Ökosystemen wurde bereits eingehend untersucht. Im Gegensatz dazu existieren erhebliche Wissenslücken hinsichtlich der Abundanz und der Auswirkung von MP in limnischen Ökosystemen. Vor diesem Hintergrund steht das Umweltvorkommen, mögliche Eintragspfade und die Auswirkungen von MP auf aquatische Invertebraten im Fokus dieser Arbeit. Zur Bestimmung der MP-Abundanz in Fließgewässern sind Sedimente der Elbe untersucht worden. Hierfür wurde zunächst eine Methode zur Extraktion und Identifizierung von MP aus Umweltproben entwickelt, optimiert und validiert. In der anschließenden Analyse konnten in elf Probenahmestellen 55–17400 MP kg-1 in den Sedimenten nachgewiesen werden. Der Einfluss der Gezeitenströmung wurde anhand der abnehmenden MP-Abundanz in der Tideelbe deutlich. Insgesamt weisen die Ergebnisse darauf hin, dass Sedimente von Fließgewässern eine Senke für MP darstellen. Für die Evaluation von Eintragspfaden von MP in Oberflächengewässer wurden die
Einleiter von fünf Kläranlagen beprobt und 240–897 MP m-3 in den Einleitern detektiert. Die Detailuntersuchung einer Kläranlage zeigte, dass >99% der MP-Fracht im Verlauf der Abwasseraufbereitung entfernt wird. Hierbei erfolgte die Hauptentfernung
bereits in der Vorklärung. Somit stellen Kläranlagen effektive Barrieren für den Eintrag von MP dar.
Insgesamt wird ersichtlich, dass die getesteten Arten C. riparius und G. pulex relativ insensitiv gegenüber einer MP-Exposition sind. So konnten bei G. pulex keine und bei C. riparius erst bei sehr hohen MP-Konzentrationen adverse Effekte detektiert werden. Hierbei ist die Autökologie der Spezies eine mögliche Erklärung für die Toleranz gegenüber partikulären Stressoren. Auf Basis dieser Daten sowie der ermittelten MPAbundanz kann das Umweltrisiko von MP in limnischen Ökosystemen vorläufig als
gering eingeschätzt werden. Hierbei gilt es jedoch zu beachten, dass eine abschließende
Bewertung aufgrund der nach wie vor existierenden Unsicherheiten nicht möglich ist. Diese Unsicherheiten betreffen die Umweltkonzentration von MP <80 μm, das Verhaltensowie das Wirkpotential dieser heterogenen und dynamischen Stressorenklasse
in umweltrelevanten Szenarien.
Cellular communication is a concept that can be explained as the transfer of signals or material (such as cytokines, ions, small molecules) between cells from the same or different type, across either short or long distances. Once this signal or material is received, it will, as a rule, promote a functional effect. Several routes, involved in this transfer, are well described and are of global importance for organ/tissue communication in an organism.
The brain interacts dynamically with the immune system, and the main route known to mediate this communication, is via the release of cytokines (by peripheral blood cells), which can then activate certain brain cell types, such as microglia, directly, or activate the vagus nerve transferring signals to neuronal populations in the brain. The communication between these two systems plays a key role in the pathophysiology of neurodegenerative diseases, and the mechanisms involved in this interaction are of central importance for understanding disease initiation and progression and search for therapeutic models.
The Momma lab previously addressed the mechanisms of interaction between the peripheral immune system and the brain by investigating cellular fusion of haematopoietic cells with neurons after inflammation. They addressed the question of whether this phenomenon also occurs under non-invasive conditions. To approach this problem, a genetic tracing model that relies on the Cre-Lox recombination system was used. Transgenic mice expressing Cre recombinase specifically in the haematopoietic lineage were crossed into a Cre-reporter background, thus all haematopoietic cells irreversibly express the reporter marker-gene EYFP. Using this model, EYFP was detected in non-haematopoietic tissues, suggesting the existence of a communication mechanism never described before. As cells containing two nuclei were never detected, fusion as a mechanism was excluded, suggesting that Cre reaches non-haematopoietic cells via a different signalling pathway. The Momma lab investigated whether the transfer of material through extracellular vesicles (EVs) could be behind this periphery-to-brain communication. Using the genetic mouse model, they were able to trace the transfer of Cre RNA via EVs between cells in vivo, generating the first in vivo evidence of functional RNA transfer by EVs between blood and brain.
The last decade has witnessed a rapid expansion of the field of EVs. Initially considered as waste disposal material, recent evidence has challenged this view. EVs are currently considered as a widespread intercellular communication system that can transport and transfer all types of biomolecules, from nucleic acids to lipids and proteins. However, several important questions are still under investigation. One of them is whether EVs are involved in brain pathophysiology, as inflammation plays an important role in onset and progression of neurodegenerative diseases and is well described in Parkinson Disease (PD). Based on preliminary data in a mouse, peripherally injected with a low dose of Lipopolysaccharide (LPS, an endotoxin found in the outer-membrane of Gram-negative bacteria, which causes an immune response), neurons and other cell population in the brain take up EVs from the periphery. Particularly, dopaminergic neurons from Substantia Nigra and Ventral Tegmental Area have been shown to receive functional RNA, transported through EVs, which can lead up to 20% of recombination. Furthermore, different neuronal populations from Hippocampus, Cortex and Cerebellum exhibit recombination, indicating a widespread signalling from blood to the brain. Therefore, the goal of my PhD thesis was to investigate the mechanisms of this transfer and the triggers that lead to EV uptake by neural cells in vivo both in pathological and physiological conditions.
In this project, the extent and function of EV-mediated signalling from blood to brain is explored in the context of peripheral inflammation and neurodegenerative diseases. Firstly, EVs isolated from WT mice were further characterized using size-exclusion chromatography (SEC), Western Blot (WB) and electron microscopy in order to extend the knowledge from previous work done in the Momma lab. Secondly, to expand on the biological relevance of the fact that inflammation is correlated with an increase in EV uptake, different approaches using the genetic murine tracing model were used. Recombination events from haematopoietic cells to the brain have been followed after peripheral injection of LPS. Peripheral inflammation caused by LPS injection led to widespread recombination events in the brain, specifically in microglia and neurons, including dopaminergic (DA) neurons. In contrast, astrocytes, oligodendrocytes and endothelial cells were never or very rarely recombined. Additionally, peripheral LPS injection in a murine model, where Cre is expressed only in erythrocytes, led to recombination events only in microglia, suggesting that the type of EV-secreting cell plays a role in the targeting of EVs to a specific cell population.
Der Verzehr von radioaktiv belasteten Pilzfruchtkörpern stellt ein Gesundheitsrisiko für den Menschen dar und auch fast 35 Jahre nach der Reaktorkatastrophe von Tschernobyl im Jahr 1986 sind Pilze aus Waldökosystemen zum Teil noch stark durch das ausgetretene radioaktive 137Cs belastet. Die Einschätzung der Belastung und somit des Gesundheitsrisikos ist aufgrund einer Vielzahl von Einflussfaktoren, wie z. B. der Pilzart, der Tiefe des Myzels, der Bodenkontamination und der Feuchtigkeit des Bodens, schwierig. Ziel dieser Arbeit war es die Variabilität, den Einfluss verschiedener Faktoren sowie die effektive Halbwertszeit der 137Cs-Aktivität in Pilzfruchtkörpern zu ermitteln. Des Weiteren wurde überprüft, ob die Bodenkontamination für eine Abschätzung der 137Cs-Aktivität von Pilzfruchtkörpern herangezogen werden kann. Für die Untersuchungen wurden über mehrere Jahre Proben von Maronenröhrlingen (Imleria badia) und Steinpilzen (Boletus edulis) aus vier Waldgebieten in Mittel- und Süddeutschland mit unterschiedlichem Aktivitätseintrag nach der Reaktorkatastrophe von Tschernobyl im Jahr 1986 analysiert. Die Gebiete waren Eichenzell, Wülfersreuth, Oberschönenfeld und der Nationalpark Bayerischer Wald. Als Ergänzung dienten zugesendete Proben derselben Pilzarten von Mitgliedern aus Pilzvereinen aus ganz Deutschland. Zusätzlich zu den Pilzproben wurden Bodenproben gemessen, um zum einen die aktuelle Bodenkontamination zu bestimmen und zum anderen zu überprüfen, ob der Großteil des 137Cs weiterhin im Bereich des Pilzmyzels zu finden ist.
Für die Untersuchung der örtlichen Variabilität der 137Cs-Aktivität wurden Maronenröhrlinge (Imleria badia) aus dem Waldgebiet Eichenzell in den Jahren 2017 bis 2019 analysiert. Innerhalb eines Sammeltages variierten die Messwerte verschiedener Proben innerhalb des Waldgebietes teilweise um den Faktor sechs. Dabei ist die Variabilität innerhalb eines Teilgebietes größer als zwischen beiden Teilgebieten des Waldgebietes Eichenzell. Für ein repräsentatives Ergebnis eines Gebietes ist es aufgrund der Variabilität erforderlich, eine ausreichende Menge an Fruchtkörpern zu analysieren.
Um die effektive Halbwertszeit der 137Cs-Aktivität in Maronenröhrlingen (Imleria badia) zu ermitteln, wurden Proben aus drei Waldgebieten über fünf bis neun Jahre analysiert. Die Wahl der drei Waldgebiete erfolgte anhand des 137Cs-Aktivitätseintrags nach der Reaktorkatastrophe von Tschernobyl im Jahr 1986. Die Bodenkontaminationswerte variieren von 3.000 Bq/m² in Eichenzell über 12.500 Bq/m² in Wülfersreuth bis 35.000 Bq/m² in Oberschönenfeld. Die effektiven Halbwerts-zeiten liegen in einem engen Bereich von 5,2 bis 5,8 Jahre mit einem Mittelwert von 5,4 ± 0,3 Jahren. Damit reduziert sich die radioaktive Belastung der Pilzfruchtkörper in etwa fünfmal schneller als durch die rein physikalische Halbwertszeit des 137Cs von 30,08 Jahren. Durch die Hinzunahme von bereits im Jahr 1990 veröffentlichten Daten ergab sich eine längere effektive Halbwertszeit von 7,7 ± 0,6 Jahren.
Für die Untersuchung der zwei Einflussfaktoren Exposition des Sammelgebiets (Hangausrichtung nach Ost oder West) und Höhenlage wurden sowohl Maronenröhrlinge (Imleria badia) als auch Steinpilze (Boletus edulis) hinsichtlich der 137Cs-Aktivität gemessen, um die Auswirkung auf Pilzarten mit unterschiedlichem Akkumulationsvermögen zu analysieren. Als Untersuchungsgebiet diente der Nationalpark Bayerischer Wald, da dieser ein großes Gebiet umfasst und verschiedene Ausprägungen der beiden Faktoren abbildet. Zudem wurde das Gebiet in Folge der Reaktorkatastrophe von Tschernobyl stark kontaminiert und der Park ist ein beliebtes Pilzsammelgebiet. Anhand der 137Cs-Aktivität von Bodenproben konnte das Gebiet in zwei Regionen (Cluster) eingeteilt werden: eine Region mit hohem und eine mit niedrigem Aktivitätseintrag. Im Vergleich wiesen Maronenröhrlinge (Imleria badia) durchschnittlich eine um den Faktor fünf höhere 137Cs-Aktivität als Steinpilze (Boletus edulis) auf. Der Faktor Höhenlage zeigte im Gegensatz zur Exposition einen Einfluss auf die Kontamination der Pilzfruchtkörper. In Bezug auf die Höhenlage war der Einfluss nur im Falle eines hohen Aktivitätseintrags signifikant, wobei die Pilzproben aus der niedrigsten Höhenlage am höchsten belastet waren.
Zur Ermittlung der vertikalen Verteilung des 137Cs im Boden wurden in den Waldgebieten Eichenzell und Nationalpark Bayerischer Wald Proben bis zu einer Tiefe von 24 cm entnommen und anschließend in 2 cm Schichten analysiert. Alle Verteilungen konnten mit einem Gauß-Fit oder einem multiplen Gauß-Fit mit 2 bis 3 Maxima abgebildet werden. Das erste Maximum lag in allen Fällen in den organischen Horizonten oder im Übergangsbereich zum Ah-Horizont. Folglich befindet sich der Großteil des 137Cs fast 35 Jahre nach der Reaktorkatastrophe von Tschernobyl immer noch im Bereich des Pilzmyzels und kann somit von den Pilzen aufgenommen und in den Fruchtkörpern angereichert werden.
Der Vergleich der 137Cs-Aktivität der Pilz- und Bodenproben aus dem Nationalpark Bayerischer Wald ergab sowohl für Maronenröhrlinge (Imleria badia) als auch für Steinpilze (Boletus edulis) eine positive Korrelation. Nach Unterteilung der Proben anhand der Höhenlage zeigte sich eine noch stärkere Korrelation. Dies zeigt, dass neben der Bodenkontamination auch die Höhenlage einen Einfluss auf die 137Cs-Aktivität der Fruchtkörper hat.
...
Non-ribosomal peptide synthetase docking domains : structure, function and engineering strategies
(2021)
Non-ribosomal peptide synthetases (NRPSs) are known for their capability to produce a wide range of natural compounds and some of them possess interesting bioactivities relevant for clinical application like antibiotics, anticancer, and immunosuppressive drugs. The diverse bioactivity of non-ribosomal peptides (NRPs) originates from their structural diversity, which results not only from the incorporation of non-proteinogenic amino acids into the growing peptide chain, but also the formation of heterocycles or further peptide modifications like methylation, hydroxylation and acetylation.
The biosynthesis of NRPs is achieved via the orchestrated interplay of distinct catalytic domains, which are grouped to modules that are located on one or more polypeptide chains. Each cycle starts with the selection and activation of a specific amino acid by the adenylation (A) domain, which catalyzes the aminoacyl adenylate formation under ATP consumption. This activated amino acid is then bound via a thioester bond to the 4’-phosphopantetheine cofactor (PPant-arm) of the following thiolation (T) domain. Before substrate loading, the PPant-arm is post-translationally added to the T domain by a phosphopantetheinyl transferase (PPTase), which converts the inactive apo-T domain in its active holo-form. In the last step of the catalytic cycle, two T domain bound peptide building blocks are connected by the condensation (C) domain, resulting in peptide bond formation and transfer of the nascent peptide chain to the following module. Each catalytic cycle is performed by a C-A-T elongation module until the termination module with a C-terminal thioesterase (TE) domain is reached. Here, the peptide product is released by hydrolysis or intramolecular cyclisation.
In comparison to single-protein NRPSs, where all modules are encoded on a single polypeptide chain, multi-protein NRPS systems must also maintain a specific module order during the peptide biosynthesis. Therefore, small C-terminal and N-terminal communication-mediating (COM) domains/docking domains (DD) were identified in the C- and N-terminal regions of multi-protein NRPSs. It was shown that these domains mediate specific and selective non-covalent protein-protein interaction, even though DD interactions are generally characterized by low affinities.
The first publication of this work focuses on the Peptide-Antimicrobial-Xenorhabdus peptide-producing NRPS called PaxS, which consists of the three proteins PaxA, PaxB and PaxC. Here, in particular the trans DD interface between the C-terminal attached DD of PaxB and N-terminal attached DD of PaxC was structurally investigated and thermodynamically characterized by isothermal titration calorimetry (ITC), yielding a dissociation constant (KD) of ~25 µM, which is a DD typical affinity known from further characterized DD pairs. The artificial linking of the PaxB/C C/NDD pair via a glycine-serine (GS) linker facilitated the structure determination of the DD complex by solution nuclear magnetic resonance (NMR) spectroscopy. In comparison to known docking domain structures, this DD complex assembles in a completely new fold which is characterized by a central α-helix of PaxC NDD wrapped in two V-shaped α-helices of PaxB CDD.
The first manuscript of this work focuses on the application of synthetic zippers (SZ) to mimic natural docking domains, enabling the easy assembly of NRPS building blocks encoded on different plasmids in a functional way. Here, the high-affinity interaction of SZs unambiguously defines the order of the synthetases derived from single-protein NRPSs in the engineered NRPS system and allows the recombination in a plug-and-play manner. Notably, the SZ engineering strategy even facilitates the functional assembly of NRPSs derived from Gram-positive and Gram-negative bacteria. Furthermore, the functional incorporation of SZs into NRPS modules is not limited to a specific linker region, so we could introduce them within all native NRPS linker regions (A-T, T-C, C-A).
The second publication and the second manuscript of this thesis again focus on the multi-protein PaxS, in particular on the trans interface between the proteins PaxA and PaxB on a molecular level by solution NMR. Therefore, the PaxA CDD adjacent T domain was included into the structural investigation besides the native interaction partner PaxB NDD. Before a three-dimensional structure could be obtained from NMR data, the NH groups located in the peptide bonds had to be assigned to the respective amino acids of the proteins (backbone assignment). Based on these backbone assignments, the secondary structure of PaxA T1-CDD and PaxB NDD in the absence and presence of the respective interaction partner were predicted.
The structural and functional characterization of the PaxA T1-CDD:PaxB NDD complex is summarized in manuscript two. The thermodynamic analysis of this complex by ITC determined a KD value of ~250 nM, whereas the discrete DDs did not interact at all. The high-affinity interaction allowed to determine the solution NMR structure of the PaxA T1-CDD:PaxB NDD complex without the covalent linkage of the interaction partners and an extended docking domain interface could be determined. This interface comprises on the one hand α-helix 4 of the PaxA T1 domain together with the α-helical CDD, and on the other hand the PaxB NDD, which is composed of two α-helices separated by a sharp bend.
...
Most cellular processes are regulated by RNA-binding proteins (RBPs). These RBPs usually use defined binding sites to recognize and directly interact with their target RNA molecule. Individual-nucleotide resolution UV crosslinking and immunoprecipitation (iCLIP) experiments are an important tool to de- scribe such interactions in cell cultures in-vivo. This experimental protocol yields millions of individual sequencing reads from which the binding spec- trum of the RBP under study can be deduced. In this PhD thesis I studied how RNA processing is driven from RBP binding by analyzing iCLIP-derived sequencing datasets.
First, I described a complete data analysis pipeline to detect RBP binding sites from iCLIP sequencing reads. This workflow covers all essential process- ing steps, from the first quality control to the final annotation of binding sites. I described the accurate integration of biological iCLIP replicates to boost the initial peak calling step while ensuring high specificity through replicate re- producibility analysis. Further I proposed a routine to level binding site width to streamline downstream analysis processes. This was exemplified in the re- analysis of the binding spectrum of the U2 small nuclear RNA auxiliary factor 2 (U2AF2, U2AF65). I recaptured the known dominance of U2AF65 to bind to intronic sequences of protein-coding genes, where it likely recognizes the polypyrimidine tract as part of the core spliceosome machinery.
In the second part of my thesis, I analyzed the binding spectrum of the serine and arginine rich splicing factor 6 (SRSF6) in the context of diabetes. In pancreatic beta-cells, the expression of SRSF6 is regulated by the transcription factor GLIS3, which encodes for a diabetes susceptibility gene. It is known that SRSF6 promotes beta-cell death through the splicing dysregulation of genes essential to beta-cell function and survival. However, the exact mechanism of how these RNAs are targeted by SRSF6 remains poorly understood. Here, I applied the defined iCLIP processing pipeline to describe the binding landscape of the splicing factor SRSF6 in the human pancreatic beta-cell line EndoC-H1. The initial binding sites definition revealed a predominant binding to coding sequences (CDS) of protein-coding genes. This was followed up by extensive motif analysis which revealed a so far, in human, unknown purine-rich binding motif. SRSF6 seemed to specifically recognize repetitions of the triplet GAA. I also showed that the number of contiguous triplets correlated with increasing binding site strength. I further integrated RNA-sequencing data from the same cell type, with SRSF6 in KD and in basal conditions, to analyze SRSF6- related splicing changes. I showed that the exact positioning of SRSF6 on alternatively spliced exons regulates the produced transcript isoforms. This mechanism seemed to control exons in several known susceptibility genes for diabetes.
In summary, in my PhD thesis, I presented a comprehensive workflow for the processing of iCLIP-derived sequencing data. I applied this pipeline on a dataset from pancreatic beta-cells to unveil the impact of SRSF6-mediated splicing changes. Thus, my analysis provides novel insights into the regulation of diabetes susceptibility genes.
Die Physiologie des Schmerzes umfasst komplexe immunologische, sensorische und inflammatorische Prozesse im Rückenmark, im Gehirn und in der Peripherie. Wiederholte nozizeptive Stimulation induziert pathophysiologische Veränderungen bei der Schmerzweiterleitung, aus denen eine periphere oder zentrale Sensibilisierung resultiert. Diese kann bei dafür anfälligen Patienten zu der Ausbildung von chronischen Schmerzzuständen führen. Obwohl das Wissen über die genauen molekularen Vorgänge der Schmerz-Chronifizierung noch immer unvollständig ist, sind die Identifizierung von Risikofaktoren vernünftige Schritte, um die individuelle Anfälligkeit für die Entwicklung chronischer Schmerzen zu bestimmen. Das Hauptziel dieser Doktorarbeit bestand daher in der Identifikation humaner genetischer Biomarker für chronische Schmerzzustände.
Octanoic acid (C8 FA) is a medium-chain fatty acid which, in nature, mainly occurs in palm kernel oil and coconuts. It is used in various products including cleaning agents, cosmetics, pesticides and herbicides as well as in foods for preservation or flavoring. Furthermore, it is investigated for medical treatments, for instance, of high cholesterol levels. The cultivation of palm oil plants has surged in the last years to satisfy an increasing market demand. However, concerns about extensive monocultures, which often come along with deforestation of rainforest, have driven the search for more environmentally friendly production methods. A biotechnological production with microbial organisms presents an attractive, more sustainable alternative.
Traditionally, the yeast Saccharomyces cerevisiae has been utilized by mankind in bread, wine, and beer making. Based on comprehensive knowledge about its metabolism and genetics, it can nowadays be metabolically engineered to produce a plethora of compounds of industrial interest. To produce octanoic acid, the cytosolic fatty acid synthase (FAS) of S. cerevisiae was utilized and engineered. Naturally, the yeast produces mostly long-chain fatty acids with chain lengths of C16 and C18, and only trace amounts of medium-chain fatty acids, i.e. C8-C14 fatty acids. To generate an S. cerevisiae strain that produces primarily octanoic acid, a mutated version of the FAS was generated (Gajewski et al., 2017) and the resulting S. cerevisiae FASR1834K strain was utilized in this work as a starting strain.
The goal of this thesis was to develop and implement strategies to improve the production level of this strain. The current mode of quantification of octanoic acid includes labor-intensive, low-throughput sample preparation and measurement – a main obstacle in generating and screening for improved strain variants. To this end, a main objective of this thesis was the development of a biosensor. The biosensor was based on the pPDR12 promotor, which is regulated by the transcription factor War1. Coupling pPDR12 to GFP as the reporter gene on a multicopy plasmid allowed in vivo detection via fluorescence intensity. The developed biosensor enabled rapid and facile quantification of the short- and medium-chain fatty acids C6, C7 and C8 fatty acids (Baumann et al., 2018). This is the first biosensor that can quantify externally supplied octanoic acid as well as octanoic acid present in the culture supernatant of producer strains with a high linear and dynamic range. Its reliability was validated by correlation of the biosensor signal to the octanoic acid concentrations extracted from culture supernatants as determined by gas chromatography. The biosensor’s ability to detect octanoic acid in a linear range of 0.01-0.75 mM (≈1-110 mg/L), which is within the production range of the starting strain, and a response of up to 10-fold increase in fluorescence after activation was demonstrated.
A high-throughput FACS (fluorescence-activated cell sorting) screening of an octanoic acid producer strain library was performed with the biosensor to detect improved strain variants (Baumann et al., 2020a). For this purpose, the biosensor was genomically integrated into an octanoic acid producer strain, resulting in drastically reduced single cell noise. The additional knockout of FAA2 successfully prevented medium-chain fatty acid degradation. A high-throughput screening protocol was designed to include iterative enrichment rounds which decreased false positives. The functionality of the biosensor on single cell level was validated by adding octanoic acid in the range of 0-80 mg/L and subsequent flow cytometric analysis. The biosensor-assisted FACS screening of a plasmid overexpression library of the yeast genome led to the detection of two genetic targets, FSH2 and KCS1, that in combined overexpression enhanced octanoic acid titers by 55 % compared to the parental strain. This was the first report of an effect of FSH2 and KCS1 on fatty acid titers. The presented method can also be utilized to screen other genetic libraries and is a means to facilitate future engineering efforts.
In growth tests, the previously reported toxicity of octanoic acid on S. cerevisiae was confirmed. Different strategies were harnessed to create more robust strains. An adaptive laboratory evolution (ALE) experiment was conducted and several rational targets including transporter- (PDR12, TPO1) and transcription factor-encoding genes (PDR1, PDR3, WAR1) as well as the mutated acetyl-CoA carboxylase encoding gene ACC1S1157A were overexpressed or knocked out in producer or non-producer strains, respectively. Despite contrary previous reports for other strain backgrounds, an enhanced robustness was not observable. Suspecting that the utilized laboratory strains have a natively low tolerance level, four industrial S. cerevisiae strains were evaluated in growth assays with octanoic acid and inherently more robust strains were detected, which are suitable future production hosts.
...
The division Ascomycota(Fungi) contains a large number of taxa known to reproduce only asexually by the formation of conidia or other non-motile propagules produced by mitotic cellular devisions. They are called anamorphic, mitosporic, asexual or conidial fungi and ecologically, they are often found associated with plant debris in different stages of decay. In general, saprobic anamorphs of ascomycetous affinities are poorly studied and their outstanding diversity is currently underexplored. Phylogenetic relationships are unknown for many of them and they are still largely underrepresented in the current phylogenetic classification system of Fungi, with many morphologically defined anamorphic taxa still awaiting taxonomic reassessment in the light of molecular approaches. The increasing usage of molecular markers combined with robust statistical methods has allowed their phylogenetic affinities to be revealed and to gradually incorporate many of them into the different taxonomic groups of the division Ascomycota. However, the phylogenetic placement and taxonomic status of a large number of saprobic taxa remain unresolved due to the lack of DNA sequence data.
The present dissertation aims to explore the rich but understudied diversity of those anamorphic fungi traditionally known as hyphomycetes that inhabit dead plant debris. It consists of five publications in which a polyphasic approach integrating morphological, developmental, cultural and molecular data was used to incorporate novel or incertae sedis taxa within Ascomycota and to make more sound decisions regarding their taxonomic status. Specific objectives include: 1. the collection, isolation and morphological characterization of selected anamorphic fungi representing putative new or interesting taxa of uncertain phylogenetic placement; 2. the generation of novel DNA sequence data to infer their phylogenetic relationships and to resolve their taxonomic affinities within Ascomycota; 3. the testing of any previously available morphologically based hypotheses on their putative position, generic placement or relationships with teleomorphic, pleomorphic or other anamorphic taxa; and 4. the determination of their generic validity, monophyly and taxonomic boundaries using molecular data and phylogenetic analyses methods.
Materials studied in these five projects consisted of specimens collected during field work carried out by the author or collaborators in different countries including USA, the Czech Republic and Panama between the years 2014 and 2017. The target substrates were dead leaves of different palm trees, dead wood and bark of pines and twigs or stems of unknown shrubs and woody vines that are all known to harbor a rich saprobic mycobiota. Putative novelties or anamorphic taxa with unknown or poorly studied phylogenetic affinities were selected for further morphological and molecular investigation. Micromorphological studies were based on fungal structures observed on natural substrate, herbarium specimens and in culture. DNA was extracted from cultures and PCR amplification followed by Sanger sequencing was carried out using relevant molecular markers employed in fungal phylogenetic studies. Newly obtained DNA sequence data were analyzed following a standard phylogenetic analysis pipeline and phylogenetic relationships were reconstructed using character-based methods such as Maximum Likelihood and Bayesian inference.
Conclusion is that anamorphic Ascomycota inhabiting dead plant debris represents a largely untapped source of biodiversity and information still in need of further exploration. A new capnodiaceous genus Castanedospora, seven new species named Taeniolella sabalicola, Hermatomyces bifurcatus, H. constrictus, H. megasporus, H. sphaericoides, H. verrucosus and Septonema lohmanii, and two new combinations, Castanedospora pachyanthicola and H. reticulatus, are proposed based on morphological and DNA sequence data. Molecular phylogenetics was confirmed as the tool of choice for the inference of relationships in novel or incertae sedis anamorphic fungi that are otherwise difficult to assess in the absence of a teleomorphic state. They were first resolved or revisited for several saprobic species such as Ernakulamia cochinensis, H. sphaericus, H. tucumanensis or Septonema fasciculare in a suitable framework for phylogenetic hypothesis testing. Molecular data allowed to fully incorporate all these taxa in Ascomycota, particularly within the classes Dothideomycetes and Sordariomycetes, and to provide a foundation for better taxonomic decisions on their classification. Large and polyphyletic genera such as Taeniolella, Sporidesmium and Septonema, partially treated in this work and containing mostly saprobic species of obscure affinities, remained in need of further investigation.
The oleochemical and petrochemical industries provide diverse chemicals used in personal care products, food and pharmaceutical industries or as fuels, oils, polymers and others. However, fossil resources are dwindling and concerns about these conventional production methods have risen due to their strong negative impact on the environment and contribution to climate change.
Therefore, alternative, sustainable and environmentally friendly production methods for oleochemical compounds such as fatty acids, fatty alcohols, hydroxy fatty acids and dicarboxylic acids are desired. The biotechnological production by engineered microorganism could fulfill these requirements. The concept of metabolic engineering, which is the modification of metabolic pathways of a host organism for increased production of a target compound, is a widely used strategy in biotechnology to generate cell factories or chassis strains for robust, efficient and high production. In this work, the versatile model and industrial yeast Saccharomyces cerevisiae was manipulated by metabolic engineering strategies for increased production of the medium-chain fatty acid octanoic acid and de novo production the derived 8-hydroxyoctanoic acid.
Octanoic acid production was enabled by the fatty acid biosynthesis pathway by use of a mutated fatty acid synthase (FASRK) in a wild type FAS deficient strain. The yeast fatty acid synthase (FAS) consists of two polypeptides, α and β, which assemble to a α6β6 complex in a co-translational manner by interaction of the subunits. Because this step might be subject to cellular regulation, the α- and β- subunits of fatty acid synthase were fused to form a single-chain construct (fusFASRK), which displayed superior octanoic acid production compared with split FASRK. Thus, FASRK expression was identified as a limiting step of octanoic acid production. But the strains that produce octanoic acid have a severe growth defect that is undesirable for biotechnological applications and could lead to lower production titers. One reason is the strong
inhibitory effect of octanoic acid. Another possibility is that the mutant FAS no longer produces enough essential long-chain fatty acids. To compensate for this, the mutated split and fused FAS variants were co-expressed individually in a strain harboring genomic wild type FAS alleles. In
addition, mutant and wild type variants of fused and split FAS were co-expressed together in a FAS deficient strain. However, both cases resulted in decreased octanoic acid titers potentially by physical and/or metabolic crosstalk of the FAS variants.
The fatty acid biosynthesis relies on cytosolic acetyl-CoA for initiation and derived malonyl-CoA for elongation and requires NADPH for reductive power. To increase production of octanoic acid, engineering strategies for increased acetyl-CoA and NADHP supply were investigated. First, the flux through the native cytosolic acetyl-CoA and NADPH providing pyruvate dehydrogenase bypass was enhanced by overexpression of the target genes ADH2, ALD6 and ACSL461P from Salmonella enterica in combination or individually. Next, the acety-CoA forming heterologous phosphoketolase/phosphotransacetylase pathway was expressed and NADPH formation was increased by redirecting the flux of glucose-6-phosphate into the NADPH producing oxidative branch of the pentose phosphate pathway. In particular, the flux through glycolysis and pyruvate dehydrogenase bypass was reduced by downregulating the expression of the phosphoglucose isomerase PGI1 and deleting the acetaldehyde dehydrogenase ALD6. Glucose-6-phosphate was guided into the pentose phosphate pathway by overexpressing the glucose-6-phosphate dehydrogenase ZWF1. The first approach did not influence octanoic acid production but the latter increased yields in the glucose consumption phase by 65 %. However,
combining the superior fusFASRK with acetyl-CoA and NADPH supply engineering strategies did not result in additive production effects, indicating that other limitations hinder high octanoic acid accumulation. Limitations could be caused in particular by the strong inhibitory effects of octanoic acid or by intrinsic limitations of the FASRK mutant. To enlarge the octanoic acid production platform towards other derived valuable oleochemical compounds the de novo production of 8-hydroxyoctanoic acid was targeted. Since short- and medium-chain fatty acids have a strong inhibitory effect on Saccharomyces cerevisiae, the inhibitory effect of hydroxy fatty acid and dicarboxylic with eight or ten carbon atoms were compared and revealed only little or no growth impairment. Subsequently, the formation of 8-hydroxyoctanoic acid was targeted by a terminal hydroxylation of externally supplied octanoic acid in a bioconversion. For that, three heterologous genes, encoding for cytochromes P450 enzymes and their cognate cytochrome P450 reductases were expressed and 8-hydroxyoctanoic acid production was compared. In addition, the use of different carbon sources was compared.
...
Exploring the in vivo subthreshold membrane activity of phasic firing in midbrain dopamine neurons
(2021)
Dopamine is a key neurotransmitter that serves several essential functions in daily behaviors such as locomotion, motivation, stimulus coding, and learning. Disrupted dopamine circuits can result in altered functions of these behaviors which can lead to motor and psychiatric symptoms and diseases. In the central nervous system, dopamine is primarily released by dopamine neurons located in the substantia nigra pars compacta (SNc) and ventral tegmental area (VTA) within the midbrain, where they signal behaviorally-relevant information to downstream structures by altering their firing patterns. Their “pacemaker” firing maintains baseline dopamine levels at projection sites, whereas phasic “burst” firing transiently elevates dopamine concentrations. Firing activity of dopamine neurons projecting to different brain regions controls the activation of distinct dopamine pathways and circuits. Therefore, characterization of how distinct firing patterns are generated in dopamine neuron populations will be necessary to further advance our understanding of dopamine circuits that encode environmental information and facilitate a behavior.
However, there is currently a large gap in the knowledge of biophysical mechanisms of phasic firing in dopamine neurons, as spontaneous burst firing is only observed in the intact brain, where access to intrinsic neuronal activity remains a challenge. So far, a series of highly-influential studies published in the 1980s by Grace and Bunney is the only available source of information on the intrinsic activity of midbrain dopamine neurons in vivo, in which sharp electrodes were used to penetrate dopamine neurons to record their intracellular activity. A novel approach is thus needed to fill in the gap. In vivo whole-cell patch-clamp method is a tool that enables access to a neuron’s intrinsic activity and subthreshold membrane potential dynamics in the intact brain. It has been used to record from neurons in superficial brain regions such as the cortex and hippocampus, and more recently in deeper regions such as the amygdala and brainstem, but has not yet been performed on midbrain dopamine neurons. Thus, the deep brain in vivo patch-clamp recording method was established in the lab in an attempt to investigate the subthreshold membrane potential dynamics of tonic and phasic firing in dopamine neurons in vivo.
The use of this method allowed the first in-depth examination of burst firing and its subthreshold membrane potential activity of in vivo midbrain dopamine neurons, which illuminated that firing activity and subthreshold membrane activity of dopamine neurons are very closely related. Furthermore, systematic characterization of subthreshold membrane patterns revealed that tonic and phasic firing patterns of in vivo dopamine neurons can be classified based on three distinct subthreshold membrane signatures: 1) tonic firing, characterized by stable, non-fluctuating subthreshold membrane potentials; 2) rebound bursting, characterized by prominent hyperpolarizations that initiate bursting; and 3) plateau bursting, characterized by transient, depolarized plateaus on which bursting terminates. The results thus demonstrated that different types of phasic firing are driven by distinct patterns of subthreshold membrane activity, which may potentially signal distinct types of information. Taken together, the deep brain in vivo patch-clamp technique can be used for the investigation of firing mechanisms of dopamine neurons in the intact brain and will help address open questions in the dopamine field, particularly regarding the biophysical mechanisms of burst firing in dopamine neurons that control behavior.
Plastics contain a complex mixture of chemicals including polymers, additives, starting substances and side-products of processing. These plastic chemicals are prone to leach into the packaged goods, in the case of food contact materials (FCMs), or into the natural environment, in the case of plastic debris. Thus, plastics represent an exposure source of chemicals for humans and wildlife alike. While it is widely known that individual plastic chemicals, such as bisphenol A and phthalates, are hazardous, little is known on the overall chemical composition and toxicity of plastics. When fragmented into smaller particles, referred to as microplastics (< 5 mm), the plastic itself can be ingested by many species. It is well established that microplastic ingestion can have negative consequences for a wide range of organisms including invertebrates, but the contribution of plastic chemicals to the toxicity of microplastics is unclear.
Given the above, the present thesis aimed at a comprehensive toxicological, ecotoxicological and chemical characterization of everyday plastics. For a comparative evaluation, 77 plastic products were selected covering 16 material types (e.g., polyethylene) made from petroleum or renewable feedstocks. These products included biodegradable products, FCMs and non-FCMs, as well as raw materials and final products, respectively. In the first two studies, the chemical mixtures contained in the 77 products were extracted with methanol and extracts were analyzed in a set of four in vitro bioassays and by non-target high-resolution gas or liquid chromatography mass spectrometry. Since an exposure only occurs if chemicals actually leach under realistic conditions, in a third study migration experiments with water were conducted for 24 out of the 77 products. The aqueous migrates were assessed in the same way as the methanolic extracts. In addition, the freshwater invertebrate Daphnia magna was exposed chronically to microplastics made of polyvinylchloride (PVC), polyurethane (PUR) and polylactic acid (PLA) to investigate the contribution of chemicals in microplastic toxicity, in a fourth study.
The experimental findings demonstrate that a wide variety of chemicals is present in plastics. A single plastic product can contain up to several thousand chemical features, most of which unique to that product and at the same time unknown. The results also indicate that the majority of these chemical mixtures are toxic in vitro. Accordingly, 65% of the plastic extracts induced baseline toxicity and 42% an oxidative stress response, while 25% had an antiandrogenic and 6% an estrogenic activity. This implies that chemicals causing unspecific toxicity are more prevalent in plastics than such with endocrine effects. These chemicals can also leach from plastics under realistic conditions. Between 17 and 8936 chemical features were detected in a single migrate sample and all 24 tested migrates induced in vitro toxicity. This means that humans and wildlife can actually be exposed to toxic plastic chemicals under realistic conditions. Generally, each product has its individual toxicological and chemical fingerprint. Thus, neither material type, feedstock, biodegradability nor the food contact suitability of a product can serve as a predictor for the toxicity, the chemical composition or complexity of a product. Likewise, this means that bio-based and biodegradable materials are not superior to their petroleum-based counterparts from a toxicological perspective despite being promoted as sustainable alternatives to conventional plastics.
Moreover, the present thesis demonstrates that plastic chemicals can be the main driver for microplastic toxicity. Irregular microplastics made of PVC, PUR and PLA adversely affected life-history traits of D. magna in a polymer type- and endpoint-dependent manner at concentrations between 100 and 500 mg L-1 and with a higher efficiency than natural kaolin particles. While the toxicity of PVC was triggered by the chemicals used in the material, the effects of PUR and PLA were induced by the physical properties of the particle.
In addition, in the fifth study, results and observations made during this thesis were integrated inter- and transdisciplinarily with the perspectives of a social scientist and a product manufacturer. This elucidated that knowledge on plastic ingredients is often concealed, is lacking or not applicable in practice. These intransparencies hinder the safety evaluation of plastic products as well as the choice and sale of the least toxic packaging material.
Overall, the present thesis highlights that the chemical safety of plastics and their bio-based and biodegradable alternatives is currently not ensured. Thus, chemicals require more consideration in the toxicity and risk assessment of plastics and microplastics. Product-specific and complex chemical compositions, including unknown compounds, pose a challenge here. Two essential steps towards non-toxic products are to increase transparency along the product life cycle and to reduce the chemical complexity of plastics by communication and regulation. The results of the present thesis indicate that products exist which do not contain toxic chemicals. These can serve to direct the design of safer plastics. Since toxicity and chemical complexity seem to increase with processing, the integration of toxicity testing during the production steps would further support the safe and sustainable production and use of plastic products.
Sympathetic influences on articular cartilage regeneration capacity and osteoarthritis manifestation
(2021)
The pathogenesis of osteoarthritis (OA) involves articular cartilage, synovial tissue and subchondral bone and is therefore a disease of the whole joint. OA is characterized by progressive degradation of cartilage, synovial inflammation, osteophyte formation and subchondral bone sclerosis. Cartilage-surrounding tissues are innervated by tyrosine hydroxylase (TH)-positive sympathetic nerve fibers with the most important sympathetic neurotransmitter norepinephrine (NE) detected in the synovial fluid of OA patients. Furthermore, adrenergic receptors are expressed in different knee joint tissues. Most in vitro studies indicate a potential role of the β2-adrenergic receptor, which has been not investigated during OA pathogenesis in vivo. The role of the sympathetic nervous system (SNS) in OA progression has not yet been studied. Therefore, the objective of this study was to analyze how the SNS and NE influence the MSC dependent cartilage regeneration in vitro and the OA pathogenesis and manifestation in vivo.
In the first part of this study, the effect of NE on the chondrogenesis of sASC, which are known to play an important role in cartilage regeneration was analyzed in vitro. In the second part of this study, the role of the SNS was studied in vivo in mice that were sympathectomized chemically followed by surgically induced OA. The specific focus was on the β2-adrenergic receptor effects on OA pathogenesis, which were analyzed in β2-adrenergic receptor-deficient mice.
The in vitro experiments have shown that NE reduced the chondrogenic potential of sASCs by decreasing the expression of type II collagen and sGAG. NE mediated these effects mainly by the α2-AR signalling. Furthermore, NE treatment led to activation of the ERK1/2 signal pathway. These findings suggested that the sympathetic neurotransmitter NE might suppress the chondrogenic capacity of MSC and their dependent cartilage regeneration and may also play a role in OA progression and manifestation.
The in vivo study has shown that sympathectomy reduced synovial TH-positive nerve fibers in the synovium and the NE concentration in the spleen significantly. In WT mice, DMM leads to increased NE concentrations in the spleen compared to sham mice indicating an increased SNS activity after mechanical stress or inflammation due to DMM. Sympathectomy leads to less pronounced cartilage degeneration (OARSI score) after DMM compared to DMM in WT mice. Furthermore, the release of the type II collagen degradation fragment CTX-II was abolished in Syx DMM mice compared to WT DMM mice, suggesting that less SNS activity due to sympathectomy reduced the cartilage degeneration during OA pathogenesis. Similarly, sympathectomy decreased the synovitis score significantly after DMM compared to DMM in
WT mice. Synovitis in WT mice was accompanied by increased MMP-13 expression in the synovium after DMM, compared to Syx mice. Cartilage degeneration seemed to be driven mainly by the increased synovial inflammation accompanied by an increased MMP13 expression in synoviocytes and not in chondrocytes. The pathological changes in synovium and cartilage might also be linked to each other, as indicated by the moderate correlation between the synovial inflammation (synovitis score) and cartilage degeneration (OARSI score). Subchondral bone volume as well the thickness of the subchondral bone plate (SCBP) and calcified cartilage (CC) were increased in Syx mice compared to WT after DMM. The data on DMM induction in β2-AR deficient mice revealed that the β2-AR signaling is involved in cartilage degeneration and the aggravated subchondral bone changes as these mice had less pronounced cartilage degeneration compared to WT mice. While the cartilage degeneration was similar, the subchondral bone changes were more pronounced in β2-AR deficient mice compared to the Syx mice.
Overall, the SNS had differential effects in cartilage, synovium and subchondral bone. A reduced SNS activity by sympathectomy attenuated cartilage degeneration and synovitis but aggravated the OA specific subchondral bone changes. These findings provide new insights into the development of novel therapeutic strategies for OA by targeting the SNS in a tissue- specific manner.
In der vorliegenden Arbeit wurde das Zinkfinger-µ-Protein HVO_2753 des halophilen Archaeons Haloferax volcanii hinsichtlich seiner biologischen Funktion und seiner Struktur charakterisiert.
Zinkfinger-µ-Proteine wurden bisher nur sehr wenig untersucht, während ihnen jedoch in den letzten Jahren steigendes Interesse entgegengebracht wird. Im Genom von H. volcanii sind mehr als 40 solcher Zinkfinger-µ-Proteine codiert. Von diesen besitzt mit HVO_2753 lediglich eines nicht nur zwei, sondern vier der charakteristischen C(P)XCG-Muster, was für die Anwesenheit von zwei Zinkfinger-Motiven spricht. Während Homologe von HVO_2753 in vielen Euryachaeota vorkommen und manche davon als Zink-Ribbon RNA-Bindeproteine annotiert sind, ist über ihre Funktion jedoch nichts bekannt. Zur Charakterisierung des Proteins wurde zunächst eine in frame-Deletionsmutante seines Gens erstellt und diese einer phänotypischen Charakterisierung unterzogen. Die Mutante wies, verglichen mit dem Wildtyp, keine Unterschiede im Wachstum in Komplexmedium oder in synthetischem Medium mit Glukose als Kohlenstoffquelle auf. Ein schweres Defizit konnte jedoch sowohl bei der Adhäsion und Biofilmbildung als auch der Schwärmfähigkeit der Deletionsmutante festgestellt werden. Während die Schwärmfähigkeit des Wildtyps durch plasmidische Expression von HVO_2753 in der Deletionsmutante teilweise wiederhergestellt werden konnte, war eine solche Komplementation bei der Biofilmbildung nicht möglich. Die Analyse der Relevanz ausgewählter Aminosäuren, wie beispielsweise das jeweils erste Cystein in jedem C(P)XCG-Muster zeigte, dass die Substitution jeder einzelnen der getesteten Aminosäuren einen Funktionsverlust des Proteins nach sich zieht. Die Untersuchung des HVO_2753-Transkripts mittels Northern Blot-Analyse bestätigte erste Hinweise aus vorangegangenen dRNA- und RNA-Seq-Studien, die eine Co-Transkription von HVO_2753 mit dem Nachbargen HVO_2752, das für den Translations-Elongationsfaktor aEF-1 beta codiert, aufzeigten. Daraufhin erfolgte eine Untersuchung des Ribosomenprofils, bei der keine Unterschiede zwischen der Deletionsmutante und der Überexpressionsmutante von HVO_2753 festgestellt werden konnten.
Eine Variante von HVO_2753 mit N-terminalem Hexahistidin-Tag wurde homolog überproduziert und aufgereinigt. Die Überproduktion und Aufreinigung wurden im Zuge dieser Arbeit weiter, speziell für HVO_2753, optimiert. So konnten große Mengen von HVO_2753n überproduziert und bei nativen Salzbedingungen mittels Nickel-Affinitätschromatographie und anschließender Größenausschlusschromatographie aufgereinigt werden. Eine massenspektrometrische Analyse bestätigte sowohl das Molekulargewicht als auch die Abwesenheit posttranslationaler Modifikationen. Die Untersuchung der Menge an gebundenem Zink im Protein erfolgte beim Zink-Assay mit Hilfe des hochsensitiven und hochspezifischen Fluorophors ZnAF-2F. Dabei konnte gezeigt werden, dass überraschenderweise lediglich ein Zink-Ion in HVO_2753 gebunden vorliegt.
Zur weiteren Funktionsaufklärung erfolgte eine Interaktionspartnersuche. Hierfür wurde HVO_2753 überproduziert, ein in vivo-Crosslink und anschließend eine native Aufreinung durchgeführt. Die massenspektrometrische Analyse ausgewählter Fraktionen nach der Größenausschlusschromatographie ergaben eine Vielzahl an möglichen Bindepartnern. Besonders häufig wurde hier die GalE family Epimerase/Dehydratase gefunden. Eine weitere Methode zur Suche nach Interaktionspartnern richtete sich auf RNAs. Hier konnten mittels eines eigens entwickelten Protokolls neben RNAs des Translationsapparates auch mehrfach die tRNA(Glu) gefunden werden.
Zusätzlich sollte die Transkriptomanalyse mittels RNA-Sequenzierung Unterschiede zwischen Wildtyp, Deletionsmutante und Komplementationsmutante aufzeigen. Hier wurden weitreichende Auswirkungen der Deletion von HVO_2753 gefunden. Zahlreiche Gene in mehreren Operons zur Motilität und Chemotaxis lagen in der Deletionsmutante stark herunterreguliert vor, während die Gene einiger Metallionen-Transporter und der Eisen(III)-Siderophor-Biosynthese hochreguliert vorlagen. In der Komplementationsmutante konnten nur von den letzteren Genen Transkriptlevel vergleichbar mit denen des Wildtyps wiedergefunden werden.
In dieser Arbeit konnte gezeigt werden, dass das kleine Zinkfinger-Protein HVO_2753 eine essenzielle Rolle in der positiven Regulation der Motilität, Chemotaxis und der Adhäsion bzw. Biofilmbildung spielt. Gleichzeitig übt HVO_2753 eine negative Regulation auf den Metallionen-Transport und die Biosynthese des Eisen(III)-Siderophors aus.
Photorhabdus and Xenorhabdus are Gram-negative, entomopathogenic bacteria, living in endosymbiosis with the soil-dwelling nematode of the genera Steinernema and Heterorhabditis. The life cycle of these nematodes consists of non-feeding infective juvenile (IJ) stage, which actively searches for insects in the soil. After penetrating the insect prey, Photorhabdus and Xenorhabdus bacteria are released from the nematode gut. The bacteria proliferate and produce toxins to kill the insect. Photorhabdus and Xenorhabdus support nematode development throughout the life cycle and to get rid of food competitors by providing a wide variety of specialized metabolites (SMs). However, little is known about which SMs function as so called “food signals” to trigger the development process.
The IJs develop into adult, self-fertilizing hermaphrodites in a process called recovery, while feeding on cadaver and bacterial biomass. Heterorhabditis and Steinernema proceed to breed until nutrients are exhausted. Next generation IJs (NG-IJs) develop and leave the cadaver to search for another insect prey.
Photorhabdus and Xenorhabdus can be cultivated in defined medium under laboratory conditions. By placing IJs on a plate containing their respective bacterial symbiont, the complete life cycle of the nematodes can be observed in vitro. The in vitro nematode bioassay was used as a tool to investigate the development of the nematode.
The aim of this study was to find the food signals responsible for nematode development. Different Photorhabdus deletion strains unable to produce one or several SMs were co-cultivated with nematodes in the nematode bioassay. Subsequently, two aspects of the life cycle were investigated: recovery and NG-IJ development.
As isopropyl stilbene (IPS) is postulated to function as a food signal to support nematode recovery, it was used as a starting point for investigations. This study was focused on the biosynthetic pathway of IPS, including intermediates, side products and derivatives to investigate which one is in fact responsible for supporting nematode development.
The biosynthesis of IPS requires two precursors, phenylalanine and leucine (Figure 5). The first topic was focused on the phenylalanine derived pathway. Photorhabdus laumondii deletion mutants, defective in intermediate steps of this pathway, were created. The deletion of the genes coding for the phenylalanine ammonium lyase (stlA), converting phenylalanine into cinnamic acid (CA), the coenzyme A (CoA) ligase (stlB) and the operon coding for a ketosynthase and aromatase (stlCDE), were used. These strains were used for nematode bioassay including complementation of mutant phenotypes by feeding experiments. Recovery of nematodes grown on the deletion strains was always lower than recovery of nematodes grown on wild type bacteria. Feeding IPS to a deletion strain did not restore wild type level nematode recovery, thus IPS cannot be the food signal. Instead, the food signal must be another compound derived from this part of biosynthetic pathway. Lumiquinone and 2,5-dihydrostilbene are suggested to function as food signals and need to be investigated in future work.
The second part of this study was focused on the leucine derived pathway, which involved the Bkd complex forming the iso-branched part of IPS. A deletion of bkd was created and phenotypically analysed, subsequently performed with the nematode bioassay. Not only IPS but also other branched SMs, like photopyrones and phurealipids are synthetised by the Bkd complex. Deletions strains defective in producing photopyrones and phurealipids were also performed in nematode bioassays to investigate effects of these SMs individually. Branched SMs did not have an impact on nematode development, but nematodes grown on the ΔbkdABC strain showed a reduced nematode recovery and almost diminished NG-IJs development. As the Bkd complex also produces branched chain fatty acids (BCFAs), feeding experiments were performed with lipid extracts of wild type and mutant strain. All lipid extracts improved recovery, but only wild type lipids could complement NG-IJ development. This strongly indicates that BCFAs play an important role in NG-IJ development, which needs to be proven with purified BCFA feeding. This is an interesting finding, which could improve nematode production for biocontrol agent usage.
The role of IPS derived to epoxy stilbene (EPS) for nematode development, was another focus in the nematode life cycle. Recently it was demonstrated that EPS does not support nematode development. However, EPS forms adducts with amino acids. In my thesis, novel adducts containing the amino acid phenylalanine or a tetrapeptide were characterized. Another adduct, most likely being an EPS dimer, was also characterized. The biological role of such adducts was discussed to be potentially important for insect weakening and the structure of the novel compounds need to be structure elucidated and tested for bioactivity.
Operons wurden zuerst im Jahre 1961 beschrieben. Bis heute ist bekannt, dass die prokaryotischen Domänen Bacteria und Archaea Gene sowohl in monocistronischen als auch in bi- oder polycistronischen Transkripten exprimieren können. Häufig überlappen Gene sogar in ihren Sequenzen. Diese überlappenden Genpaare stehen nicht in Korrelation mit der Kompaktheit ihres Genoms. Das führt zu der Annahme, dass eine Art der Regulation vorliegt, welche weitere Proteine oder Gene nicht benötigt. Diese könnte eine gekoppelte Translation sein. Das bedeutet die Translation des stromabwärts-liegenden Gens ist abhängig von der Translation eines stromaufwärts-liegenden Gens. Diese Abhängigkeit kann zum Beispiel durch lang reichende Sekundärstrukturen entstehen, bei welchen Ribosomenbindestellen (RBS) des stromabwärts-liegenden Gens blockiert sind. Die de novo-Initiation am stromabwärts-liegenden Gen kann nur stattfinden, wenn das erste Gen translatiert wird und dabei die Sekundärstruktur an der RBS aufgeschmolzen wird. Für Genpaare in E. coli ist dieser Mechanismus gut untersucht. Ein anderes Beispiel für die Translationskopplung ist die Termination-Reinitiation, bei welcher ein Ribosom das erste Gen translatiert bis zum Stop-Codon, dort terminiert und direkt am stromabwärts-liegenden Start-Codon reinitiiert. Der Mechanismus via Termination-Reinitiation ist bis jetzt nur für eukaryontische Viren beschrieben worden. Im Gegensatz zu einer Kopplung über Sekundärstrukturen kommt es bei der Termination-Reinitiation am stromabwärts-liegenden Gen nicht zu einer de novo-Initiation sondern eine Reinitiation des Ribosoms findet statt. Diese Arbeit analysiert jene Art der Translationskopplung an Genen polycistronischer mRNAs in jeweils einem Modellorganismus als Vertreter der Archaea (Haloferax volcanii) und Bacteria (Escherichia coli). Hierfür wurden Reportergenvektoren erstellt, welche die überlappenden Genpaare an Reportergene fusionierten. Für diese Reportergene ist es möglich die Transkriptmenge zu quantifizieren sowie für die exprimierten Proteine Enzymassays durchgeführt werden können. Aus beiden Werten können Translationseffizienzen berechnet werden indem jeweils die Enzymaktivität pro Transkriptmenge ermittelt wird. Durch ein prämatures Stop-Codon in diesen Konstrukten ist es möglich zu unterscheiden ob es für die Translation des zweiten Gens essentiell ist, dass das Ribosom den Überlapp erreicht. Hiermit konnte für neun Genpaare in H. volcanii und vier Genpaare in E. coli gezeigt werden, dass eine Art der Kopplung stattfindet bei der es sich um eine Termination-Reinitiation handelt. Des Weiteren wurde analysiert, welche Auswirkungen intragene Shine-Dalgarno Sequenzen bei dem Event der Translationskopplung besitzen. Durch die Mutation solcher Motive und dem Vergleich der Translationseffizienzen der Konstrukte, mit und ohne einer SD Sequenz, wird für alle analysierten Genpaare beider Modellorganismen gezeigt, dass die SD Sequenz einen Einfluss auf diese Art der Kopplung hat. Zwischen den Genpaaren ist dieser Einfluss jedoch stark variabel. Weiterhin wurde der maximale Abstand zwischen zwei bicistronischen Genen untersucht, für welchen Translationskopplung via Termination-Reinitiation noch stattfinden kann. Hierfür wird durch site-directed mutagenesis jeweils ein prämatures Stop-Codon im stromaufwärts-liegenden Gen eingebracht, welches den intergenen Abstand zwischen den Genen in den jeweiligen Konstrukten vergrößert. Der Vergleich aller Konstrukte eines Genpaars zeigt in beiden Modellorganismen, dass die Termination-Reinitiation vom intergenen Abstand abhängig ist und die Translationseffizienz des stromabwärts-liegenden Reporters bereits ab 15 Nukleotiden Abstand abnimmt.
Eine weitere Fragestellung dieser Arbeit war es, den genauen Mechanismus der Termination-Reinitiation zu analysieren. Für Ribosomen gibt es an der mRNA nach der Termination der Translation zwei Möglichkeiten: Entweder als 70S Ribosom bestehen zu bleiben und ein weiteres Start-Codon auf der mRNA zu suchen oder in seine beiden Untereinheiten zu dissoziieren, während die 50S Untereinheit die mRNA verlässt und die 30S Untereinheit über Wechselwirkungen an der mRNA verbleiben kann. Um diesen Mechanismus auf molekularer Ebene zu untersuchen, wird ein Versuchsablauf vorgestellt. Dieser ermöglicht das Event bei der Termination-Reinitiation in vitro zu analysieren. Eine Unterscheidung von 30S oder 70S Ribosomen bei der Reinitiation der Translation des stromabwärts-liegenden Gens wird ermöglicht. Die Idee dabei basiert auf einem ribosome display, bei welchem Translationskomplexe am Ende der Translation nicht in ihre Bestandteile zerfallen können, da die eingesetzte mRNA kein Stop-Codon enthält Der genaue Versuchsablauf, die benötigten Bestandteile sowie proof-of-principal Versuche sind in der Arbeit dargestellt und mögliche Optimierungen werden diskutiert.
Viele Gruppen der Lebewesen, insbesondere Insekten breiten sich durch steigende Temperaturen zunehmend in Gebieten aus, in denen sie ursprünglich nicht vorkommen(Novikov und Vaulin 2014; Bebber 2015). Hierbei ist die steigende Temperatur in
verschiedenen Gebieten der Hauptfaktor für Expansionen dieser Arten in Richtung des nördlichen Polarkreises. Einige dieser Arten sind sehr tolerant für verschiedene Variablen und können damit ihr Verbreitungsgebiet deutlich nach Norden hin ausdehnen. Aufgrund steigender Temperaturen werden jedoch andere Arten in ihrem Verbreitungsgebiet eingeschränkt oder ihre Verbreitung verschiebt sich in nördliche Richtung (Ogden und Lindsay 2016; Lawler et al. 2009). Auch für die Verbreitung von Krankheiten spielen Temperaturen, Ausbreitungen oder Verbreitungsverschiebungen eine wichtige Rolle (Mordecai et al. 2019).
So können, durch die Etablierung der passenden Vektoren, bisher nur in wärmeren Gebieten auftretende Krankheiten zukünftig auch in unseren Breitengraden eingeschleppt und
verbreitet werden. Bremsen, invasive Stechmücken aber auch einheimische Mücken tragen alle ein Potential,verschiedenste Krankheitserreger zu verbreiten, auch wenn die Eignung als
Vektor für jede Art unterschiedlich groß ausfällt und manche Arten daher kaum beobachtet und untersucht werden. Mit dem Augenmerk auf sich ändernde Verbreitungsgebiete hinsichtlich zukünftigen klimatischen Veränderungen und sich wandelnden anthropogenen Einflüssen sollten jedoch auch Arten mit bisher geringem Vektorpotential mit in Beobachtungsprogramme aufgenommen werden.
Wir untersuchten in Projekt I auf kontinentaler Skala die Verbreitung von sechs verschiedenen Bremsenarten und konnten sowohl Rückschlüsse auf eine mangelhafte Beobachtung der
Arten ziehen als auch Artpräferenzen hinsichtlich der Landschaftsnutzung, Auswirkungen des Klimas auf die Verbreitung der Art und bisher unbekannte Toleranzen hinsichtlich tiefen Temperaturen und äußerst verkürzten Wärmeperioden aufdecken. Eine Größenordnung niedriger wurde in Projekt II, basierend auf aktuellen und Vergangenen Klimadaten, die zukünftige und aktuelle Verbreitung einer invasiven, sich zukünftig ausbreitenden Stechmückenart innerhalb Deutschlands modelliert. Durch bisherig im Untersuchungsgebiet nur begrenztes Auftreten konnten noch keine Rückschlüsse auf die unterschiedlichen Präferenzen für das Habitat gezogen werden, es können jedoch für zukünftige Berechnungen Habitatpräferenzen aus anderen Gebieten hinzugezogen werden um die Art und ihre fortschreitende Ausbreitung genauer zu beobachten. Auf der kleinsten untersuchten Ebene konnten in Projekt III innerhalb eines Mikrohabitates verschiedenste Rückschlüsse auf limitierende oder förderliche abiotische Faktoren, die teilweise bisherig nicht oder nur geringfügig beobachtet wurden, gezogen werden. Ebenfalls konnten Auswirkungen der umgebenden Landschaft auf die Abundanzen der Tiere beobachtet werden. Mithilfe von verschiedenen Modellen und in Abhängigkeit von Klimakarten, Landbedeckungsdaten und Landnutzung sowie Eigenschaften und Toleranzen der untersuchten Arten lassen sich in verschiedenen Größenordnungen geeignete Habitate von einheimischen sowie invasiven Arten identifizieren und zukünftige Verbreitungen effizient vorhersagen.
Insgesamt können, basierend auf all diesen Daten, dadurch für alle untersuchten Faktoren Modelle auf andere Gebiete übertragen werden um somit potentielle Verbreitungen dort
vorherzusagen. Auf unseren Daten basierend können so zum Beispiel Modellierungen für die potentielle Ausbreitung der untersuchten Tabaniden innerhalb anderer Kontinente berechnet werden und Monitoringprogramme können die Ergebnisse unserer Studie als Startpunkt aufgreifen, um durch Beprobung an modellierten Standorten die Korrektheit unserer Modelle zu überprüfen und sowohl Landschaftstypen als auch Artzusammensetzung aufzunehmen um das Modell zu bestätigen oder zu verbessern. Die Modellierung der invasiven Art Aedes albopictus bietet die Möglichkeit, diese Art in Zukunft innerhalb der möglichen Ausbreitungskorridore genauer zu beobachten um ihre fortschreitende Verbreitung zu
verifizieren oder eventuelle Änderungen des klimatischen Verlaufes mit einzubinden und das Modell anzupassen. Die Untersuchung des Mikrohabitats von Culex pipiens pipiens und Culex torrentium bietet, auch hinsichtlich anderer Arten in diesem Habitat, eine potente Methode, Vorhersagen für Artvorkommen innerhalb anderer Unterirdischen Objekte zu berechnen. Hier können, bei ausreichend großer Datenlage, eine Vielzahl von Faktoren in die Auswertung mit einfließen.
Die durchgeführten Studien bestätigen die Notwendigkeit für verbesserte Monitoringkonzepte für alle vektorkompetenten Tiergruppen hinsichtlich der sich ändernden klimatischen Bedingungen, des globalen Handels und die sich wandelnde Nutzung der Landschaften durch den Menschen und darin begründete Veränderungen der Artenzusammensetzung eines Habitates, zeigen Möglichkeiten, diese Konzepte mit bisher
ungenutzten Daten aufzubauen und zu verbessern und können gleichzeitig zu deren Verbesserung herangezogen werden.
Taxa under scrutiny in this thesis are Halophytophthora-like oomycetes. The genus Halophytophthora, proposed in 1990, is an assemblage of unrelated species grouped together on the basis habitat preference, i.e. the mangrove or saltmarsh biome, and morphological similarity to Phytophthora. The premise “Phytophthora-like species from the mangrove environment” became the genus concept for Halophytophthora and lasted for almost 2 decades which resulted to the addition of several species (i.e. H. elongata, H. exoprolifera, H. porrigovesica, H. kandeliae, H. masteri, and H. tartarea). At the onset of molecular phylogenetics, Halophytophthora was inferred as a highly polyphyletic taxon and the genus concept was found to be unsuitable. This thesis adds to this, since six Phytophthora spp. were isolated from the mangrove environment, two of which were found in the Philippines (Phytophthora elongata and Phytophthora insolita). After a thorough assessment of the morphologic and phylogenetic data of taxa included in this thesis, several taxonomic novelties were introduced – a new family (Salispinaceae), a new genus (Calycofera), new species (Calycofera cryptica, Phytopythium dogmae, Phytopythium leanoi, Salisapilia coffeyi, and Salispina hoi), and new combinations (Calycofera operculata, Salisapilia bahamensis, S. elongata, S. epistomia, S. masteri, S. mycoparasitica). In addition, Salisapiliaceae and Salisapilia were emended.
Nematophilic bacteria as a source of novel macrocyclised antimicrobial non-ribosomal peptides
(2020)
A solution to ineffective clinical antimicrobials is the discovery of new ones from under-explored sources such as macrocyclic non-ribosomal peptides (NRP) from nematophilic bacteria. In this dissertation an antimicrobial discovery process –from soil sample to inhibitory peptide– is demonstrated through investigations on six nematophilic bacteria: Xenorhabdus griffiniae XN45, X. griffiniae VH1, Xenorhabdus sp. nov. BG5, Xenorhabdus sp. nov. BMMCB, X. ishibashii and Photorhabdus temperata. To demonstrate the first step of bacterium isolation and species delineation, endosymbionts were isolated from Steinernema sp. strains BG5 and VH1 that were isolated directly from soil samples in Western Kenya. After genome sequencing and assembly of novel Xenorhabdus isolates VH1 and BG5, species delineation was done via three overall genome relatedness indices. VH1 was identified as X. griffiniae VH1, BG5 as Xenorhabdus sp. nov. BG5 and X. griffiniae BMMCB was emended to Xenorhabdus sp. nov. BMMCB. The nematode host of X. griffiniae XN45, Steinernema sp. scarpo was highlighted as a putative novel species. To demonstrate the second step of genome mining and macrocyclic non-ribosomal peptide structure elucidation, chemosynthesis and biosynthesis, the non-ribosomal peptide whose production is encoded by the ishA-B genes in X. ishibashii was investigated. Through a combination of refactoring the ishA-B operon by a promoter exchange mechanism, isotope labelling experiments, high resolution tandem mass spectrometry analysis, bioinformatic protein domain analysis and chemoinformatic comparisons of actual to hypothetical mass spectrometry spectra, the structures of Ishipeptides were elucidated and confirmed by chemical synthesis. Ishipeptide A was a branch cyclic depsidodecapeptide macrocyclised via an ester bond between serine and the terminal glutamate. It chemosynthesis route was via a late stage macrolactamation and linearised Ishipeptide B was synthesised via solid phase iterative synthesis. Ishipeptides were not N-terminally acylated despite being biosynthesised from the IshA protein that had a C-starter domain. It was highlighted that more than restoration of the histidine active site of this domain is required to restore N-terminal acylation activity.
To demonstrate the final step of determination of antimicrobial activity, minimum inhibitory concentrations of Ishipeptides and Photoditritide from Photorhabdus temperata against fungi and bacteria were determined. None were antifungal while only the macrocyclic compounds were inhibitory, with Ishipeptide A inhibitory to Gram-positive bacteria at 37 µM. The cationic Photoditritide, a cyclic hexapeptide macrocyclised via a lactam bond between homoarginine and tryptophan, was 12 times more inhibitory (3.0 µM), even more effective than a current clinical compound, Ampicillin (4.2 µM). For both, macrocyclisation was hypothesised to contribute to antimicrobial activity. Ultimately, this dissertation demonstrated not only nematophilic bacteria as a source of novel macrocyclic antimicrobial non-ribosomal peptides but also a process of antimicrobial discovery–from soil sample to inhibitory peptide– from these useful bacteria genera. This is significant for the fight against antimicrobial resistance.
Spinocerebellar ataxia type 2 (SCA2) is an autosomal dominant neurodegenerative movement disorder caused by expansion of CAG repeats in the ATXN2 gene beyond 33 units, while healthy individuals carry 22-23 repeats. First symptoms of SCA2 include uncoordinated movement, ataxic gait and slowing of the saccadic eye movements in line with the early pronounced atrophy of cerebellum, spinal cord and brainstem. Cerebellar Purkinje cells and spinal cord motor neurons are the most affected cells from ATXN2 expansions. Later on, patients manifest distal amyotrophy, problems in breathing and swallowing, depression and cognitive decline caused by widespread degeneration throughout the brain. The striking loss of mass in the brain, due to severe myelin fat atrophy, is accompanied by a similar reduction in the peripheral fat stores. After the devastating progression of disease, the severity and duration of which depends on the CAG repeat size, genetic background and environmental factors, patients succumb to SCA2 mostly because of respiratory failure at the terminal stage. Larger repeat sizes lead to an earlier manifestation of the disease and a more rapid progression. Aside from SCA2, intermediate-length and short pathogenic CAG expansions in ATXN2 between 26-39 repeats significantly increase the risk of developing other neurodegenerative disorders, such as amyotrophic lateral sclerosis (ALS), fronto-temporal lobar dementia (FTLD) or Parkinson plus tauopathies like progressive supranuclear palsy (PSP) in various cohorts across the world.
Ataxin-2 (ATXN2) is a ubiquitously expressed cytosolic protein most famous for its involvement in neurodegenerative disease caused by the expanded poly-glutamine (polyQ) domain corresponding to a genomic (CAG)n tract. This N-terminal polyQ domain has no known function, other than increasing the aggregation propensity of mutant ATXN2 and facilitating interaction with other polyQ containing proteins, leading to their sequestration. The progressive accumulation of ATXN2 into cytosolic foci, and also that of its interaction partners over time, underlies the molecular pathomechanism. Next to polyQ domain, ATXN2 also contains a Like-Sm domain (Lsm), an Lsm-associated domain (LsmAD), multiple proline-rich domains (PRD) and a Poly(A)-Binding-Protein (PABP)-interacting motif (PAM2).
Through its Lsm/LsmAD domains, ATXN2 directly binds to a large number of transcripts, regulating their quality and translation rate. In a similar fashion, through its direct interaction with PABP via PAM2 motif, ATXN2 indirectly modifies the fate of even larger number of transcripts and global translation. Several PRDs scattered across the protein help ATXN2 associate with growth factor receptors and other endocytosis factors, modulating nutrient uptake and downstream signaling.
ATXN2 is a stress response factor. Therefore, its involvement in nutrient uptake plays a crucial part in cell’s capability to overcome non-permissive conditions. Upon nutrient deprivation, oxidative stress, proteotoxicity, heat stress or Ca2+ imbalance, ATXN2 relocalizes into cytosolic ribonucleoprotein particles known as stress granules (SGs), together with PABP, several eukaryotic translation initiation factors, many other RNA-binding proteins (RBP) with their target transcripts and the small ribosomal subunit. Collectively, they modulate the stability of the trapped transcripts, favoring the maturation and translation of IRES-dependent stress response proteins instead, according to the specific need. Many RBPs interact either directly or in an RNA-dependent manner in the SGs, and due to the large number of ALS-causing mutations identified in them (such as TDP-43, FUS, TIA-1, hnRNPA2/B1), SGs became a hot topic in neuropathology. Acute SGs serve to halt translation and growth, and to spend energy only for survival until stress disappears. However, chronic SG assembly eventually activates apoptotis leading to cell death. While the polyQ expansions in ATXN2 enhance SG stability, reduce their dissociation rate after stress, and lead to aberrant post-translational modifications of other SG components like TDP-43, complete loss of ATXN2 delays SG formation and results in easily dissolvable foci.
Most of the stressors that induce SG formation eventually converge on energetic deficit. Therefore, it is logical that the ultimate task of SGs is to stop further growth when it cannot be afforded. In yeast, the molecular mechanism underlying this growth arrest was explained as sequestration of the master growth regulator complex, Target-of-Rapamycin Complex 1 (TORC1), into SGs in an ATXN2-dependent manner. The repressor effect of ATXN2 on mammalian TORC1 (mTORC1) and global protein translation had already been documented in earlier studies; complete loss of ATXN2 function in knock-out mouse (Atxn2-KO) resulted in mTORC1 hyperactivity and transcriptional upregulation of multiple ribosomal subunits indicating an increased need for these machines. ...
Nematophilic bacteria as a source of novel macrocyclised antimicrobial non-ribosomal peptides
(2020)
A solution to ineffective clinical antimicrobials is the discovery of new ones from under-explored sources such as macrocyclic non-ribosomal peptides (NRP) from nematophilic bacteria. In this dissertation an antimicrobial discovery process –from soil sample to inhibitory peptide– is demonstrated through investigations on six nematophilic bacteria: Xenorhabdus griffiniae XN45, X. griffiniae VH1, Xenorhabdus sp. nov. BG5, Xenorhabdus sp. nov. BMMCB, X. ishibashii and Photorhabdus temperata. To demonstrate the first step of bacterium isolation and species delineation, endosymbionts were isolated from Steinernema sp. strains BG5 and VH1 that were isolated directly from soil samples in Western Kenya. After genome sequencing and assembly of novel Xenorhabdus isolates VH1 and BG5, species delineation was done via three overall genome relatedness indices. VH1 was identified as X. griffiniae VH1, BG5 as Xenorhabdus sp. nov. BG5 and X. griffiniae BMMCB was emended to Xenorhabdus sp. nov. BMMCB. The nematode host of X. griffiniae XN45, Steinernema sp. scarpo was highlighted as a putative novel species. To demonstrate the second step of genome mining and macrocyclic non-ribosomal peptide structure elucidation, chemosynthesis and biosynthesis, the non-ribosomal peptide whose production is encoded by the ishA-B genes in X. ishibashii was investigated. Through a combination of refactoring the ishA-B operon by a promoter exchange mechanism, isotope labelling experiments, high resolution tandem mass spectrometry analysis, bioinformatic protein domain analysis and chemoinformatic comparisons of actual to hypothetical mass spectrometry spectra, the structures of Ishipeptides were elucidated and confirmed by chemical synthesis. Ishipeptide A was a branch cyclic depsidodecapeptide macrocyclised via an ester bond between serine and the terminal glutamate. It chemosynthesis route was via a late stage macrolactamation and linearised Ishipeptide B was synthesised via solid phase iterative synthesis. Ishipeptides were not N-terminally acylated despite being biosynthesised from the IshA protein that had a C-starter domain. It was highlighted that more than restoration of the histidine active site of this domain is required to restore N-terminal acylation activity.
To demonstrate the final step of determination of antimicrobial activity, minimum inhibitory concentrations of Ishipeptides and Photoditritide from Photorhabdus temperata against fungi and bacteria were determined. None were antifungal while only the macrocyclic compounds were inhibitory, with Ishipeptide A inhibitory to Gram-positive bacteria at 37 µM. The cationic Photoditritide, a cyclic hexapeptide macrocyclised via a lactam bond between homoarginine and tryptophan, was 12 times more inhibitory (3.0 µM), even more effective than a current clinical compound, Ampicillin (4.2 µM). For both, macrocyclisation was hypothesised to contribute to antimicrobial activity. Ultimately, this dissertation demonstrated not only nematophilic bacteria as a source of novel macrocyclic antimicrobial non-ribosomal peptides but also a process of antimicrobial discovery–from soil sample to inhibitory peptide– from these useful bacteria genera. This is significant for the fight against antimicrobial resistance.
The compound class of the fabclavines was described as secondary or specialized metabolites (SM) for Xenorhabdus budapestensis and X. szentirmaii. Their corresponding structure was elucidated by NMR and further derivatives could be identified in both strains. Biochemically, fabclavines are hybrid SMs derived from two non-ribosomal-peptide-synthetases (NRPS), one type I polyketide-synthase (PKS) and polyunsaturated fatty acid (PUFA) synthases. In detail, a hexapeptide is connected via partially reduced polyketide units to an unsual polyamine. Structurally, they are related to the (pre-)zeamines, described for Serratia plymuthica and Dickeya zeae. Fabclavines exhibit a broad-spectrum bioactivity against a variety of different organisms like Grampositive and Gram-negative bacteria, fungi, protozoa but also against eukaryotic celllines.
In this work, the fabclavine biosynthesis was elucidated and assigned to two independently working assembly lines. The NRPS-PKS-pathway is initiated by the first NRPS FclI via generation of a tetrapeptide, which is elongated by the second NRPS FclJ, leading to a hexapeptide. Alternatively, FclJ can also act as direct start of the biosynthesis, resulting in the final formation of shortened fabclavine derivatives with a diinstead of a hexapeptide. In both cases, the peptide moiety is transferred to the iterative type I PKS FclK, leading to an elongation with partially reduced polyketide units. The resulting NRPS-PKS-intermediate is still enzyme-bound. The PUFA-homologues FclC, FclD and FclE in combination with FclF, FclG and FclH belong to the polyamine-forming pathway. Briefly, repeating decarboxylative Claisen thioester condensation reactions of acyl-coenzym A building blocks lead to the generation of an acyl chain in a PKS- or fatty acid biosynthesis-like manner. The corresponding β-keto-groups are either completely reduced or transaminated in a specific and repetitive way, resulting in the concatenation of so-called amine-units. The final β-keto-group is reduced to a hydroxy-group and the intermediate is reductively released by the thioester reductase FclG. A subsequent transamination step leads to the final polyamine. The NRPS-PKS- as well as the polyamine-pathway are connected by FclL. This condensation domain-like protein catalyzes the condensation of the polyamine with the NRPS-PKS-part, which results in the release of the final fabclavine. The results are described in detail in the first publication (first author).
Fabclavine biosynthesis gene cluster (BGC) are widely spread among the genus Xenorhabdus and Photorhabdus. In Xenorhabdus strains a high degree of conservation regarding the BGC synteny as well as the identity of single proteins can be observed. However, Photorhabdus strains harbor only the PUFA-homologues. While in Photorhabdus no product could be detected, our analysis revealed that the Xenorhabdus strains produce a large chemical diversity of different derivatives. Briefly, the general backbone of the fabclavines is conserved and only four chemical moieties are variable: The second and last amino acids of the NRPS-part, the number of incorporated polyketide units as well as the number of amine units in the polyamine. In combination with the elucidated biosynthesis, these variables could be assigned to single biosynthesis components as diversity mechanisms. Together with the 10 already described derivatives, a total of 32 derivatives could be detected. Interestingly, except for taxonomic closely related strains, all analyzed strains produce their own set of derivatives. Finally, we could confirm that the fabclavines are the major bioactive compound class in the analyzed strains under laboratory conditions. The results are described in detail in the second publication (first author).
Together with our collaboration partner Prof. Selcuk Hazir a potent bioactivity against Enterococcus faecalis, which is associated with endodontic infections, could be contributed to X. cabanillasii. Here, we could confirm that this bioactivity can be assigned to the fabclavines. The results are described in detail in the third publication(co-author).
Among the genus Xenorhabdus, X. bovienii represents an exception as its NRPS and PKS genes of the fabclavine BGC are missing or truncated, resulting in the exclusive production of polyamines. Furthermore, its PUFA-homologue FclC harbors an additional dehydratase (DH) domain. Upon extensive analysis a yet unknown deoxy-polyamine was identified and assigned to this additional domain. Finally, the DH domain was transferred into other polyamine pathways. Regardless of an in cis or in trans integration, the chimeric pathways produced deoxy-derivatives of its naturally occurring polyamines, suggesting that this represents another diversification mechanism. The results are described in detail in the attached manuscript (first author).
Monoterpenes and their monoterpenoid derivatives form a subclass of terpene(oid)s. They are widely used in medicines/pharmaceuticals, as flavor and fragrance compounds, or in agriculture and are also considered as future biofuels. However, for many of these substances, the extraction from natural sources poses challenges such as occurring at low concentrations in their raw material or because the natural sources are diminishing. Furthermore, many of the structurally more complex terpenoids cannot be chemically synthesized in an economic way. Therefore, microbial production provides an attractive alternative, taking advantage of the often distinct regio- and stereoselectivity of enzymatic reactions. However, monoterpenes and monoterpenoids are challenging products for industrial biotechnology processes due to their pronounced cytotoxicity, which complicates the production in microorganisms compared to longer-chain terpenes (sesquiterpenes, diterpenes, etc.).
The aim of this thesis was to generate a biotechnological complement to fossil-resources-based chemical processes for industrial monoterpenoid production. Therefore, a starting point for the further development of a microbial cell factory based on the microbe Pseudomonas putida KT2440 was aimed to be created. This production organism should be able to conduct a whole- cell biocatalysis to selectively oxyfunctionalize monoterpene hydrocarbons using renewable industrial by-products and waste streams as raw material for monoterpenoid production (Figure 1). As a model substance, the production of (-)-menthol should be addressed due to its industrial significance. (-)-Menthol is one of the world’s most widely-used flavor and fragrance compounds by volume as well as a medical component, having an annual production volume of over 30,000 tons. An approach for (-)-menthol production from renewable resources could be a biotechnological(-chemical) two-step conversion (Figure 1), starting from (+)-limonene, a by-product of the citrus fruit processing industry.
The thesis project was divided into three parts. In the first part, enzymes (limonene-3- hydroxylases) were to be identified that can convert (+)-limonene into the precursor of (-)-menthol, (+)-trans-isopiperitenol. To counteract product toxicity, in the second part, the tolerance of the intended production organism P. putida KT2440 towards monoterpenes and their monoterpenoid derivatives should be increased. Finally, in the third part, the identified hydroxylase enzymes would be expressed in the improved P. putida KT2440 strain to create a whole-cell biocatalyst for the first reaction step of a two-step (-)-menthol production, starting from (+)-limonene.
To achieve these objectives, different genetic/molecular biology and analytical methods were applied. In this way, two cytochrome P450 monooxygenase enzymes from the fungi Aureobasidium pullulans and Hormonema carpetanum could be identified and functionally expressed in Pichia pastoris, which can catalyze the intended hydroxylation reaction on (+) limonene with high stereo- and regioselectivity. A further characterization of the enzyme from A. pullulans showed that apart from (+) limonene the protein can also hydroxylate ( ) limonene, - and -pinene, as well as 3-carene.
Furthermore, within this thesis, mechanisms of microbial monoterpenoid resistance of P. putida could be identified. It was shown that the different monoterpenes and monoterpenoids tested have very different toxicity levels and that mainly the Ttg efflux pumps of P. putida GS1 are responsible for the tolerance to many of these compounds. Based on these results, a P. putida KT2440 strain with increased resistance to various monoterpenoids, including isopiperitenol, could then be generated, which can be used as a host organism for the further development of monoterpenoid-producing cell factories.
While within the scope of this work the heterologous expression of the fungal gene in prokaryotic cells in a functional form could not be realized despite different approaches, the identified enzymes, the monoterpenoid-tolerant P. putida strain and a plasmid developed for heterologous gene expression in P. putida provide a starting point for the further design of a microbial cell factory for biotechnological monoterpenoid production.
Evidence is increasingly pointing towards a significant global decline in biodiversity. The drivers of this decline are numerous, including habitat change and overexploitation, rapid deforestation, pollution, exotic species and disease, and finally climate change as an emerging driver of biodiversity change (Nakamura, et al., 2013; Hancocks, 2001; Pereira, Navarro & Martins, 2012). Raising public awareness of the need to conserve biological diversity is essential to safeguard the richness of life forms all over the world (Lindemann-Matthies, 2002). In this regard, institutions such as science museums, zoos and aquariums have the potential to play an important role (Rennie & Stocklmayer, 2003). Especially, zoos can provide a productive learning environment (Miles & Tout, 1992), facilitating the promotion of public conservation awareness and the adoption of pro-environmental behaviours that would reduce negative human impacts on biodiversity (Barongi, et al., 2015).
Based on these concepts, my study contributes to the developing field of visitor studies. Taking as reference non-zoo visitors and zoo visitors, I have focused on reviewing some aspects of conservation education, such as people's awareness of conservation, people's interest in animals and people's feelings towards animals and attitudes towards zoos. The study identified differences between non-regular and regular zoo visitors in interests in animals, as well as visitor attitudes towards conservation issues and zoos. Therefore, the present study indicated that positive emotional reactions and, in particular, a perceived sense of connection to the animal were linked and depended on the frequency of zoo visits. It was as well remarkable, that conservation awareness was influenced by the interest in animals, the interest in visiting zoos, the attitudes towards these institutions, and the age and the country of origin. All these variables had a greater effect in the conservation consciousness of the participants. Additionally interestingly, the main reason for visiting zoos in every country was to learn something about animals. This highlights the educational role of zoos and broadly supports the idea that people want to visit zoos to learn something about animals, in turn facilitating pro-conservation learning and changes in attitude. They are uniquely positioned to interact with visitors, communities, and society and to contribute by providing an informative and entertaining environment. Visiting zoos could led to contribute to promoting animal connectedness and interest in species.
Carotinoide sind Pigmente, die in Pflanzen, Algen, einigen Pilzen und Bakterien vorkommen. Sie spielen eine wichtige Rolle bei der Photosynthese durch Absorption von Licht und beim Lichtschutz. Sie sind verantwortlich für die braunen, roten, orangen und gelben Farben von Obst, Gemüse, Herbstblättern und die Farbe einiger Blumen und Algen. Tiere können keine Carotinoide synthetisieren, daher ist ihre Anwesenheit auf die Nahrungsaufnahme zurückzuführen. Carotinoide sind Tetraterpenoide (40C), die aus Isoprenoidmolekülen (5C) synthetisiert werden. Der Methylerythritol-phosphatweg ist der Carotinoid-Vorläuferweg, der die Isoprenoideinheiten bildet. Carotinoide haben aufgrund ihrer gesundheitlichen Vorteile das Interesse der Nutrazeutika-Industrie geweckt.
Fucoxanthin ist ein Carotinoid, das nur in Kieselalgen, Braunalgen, Haptophyten und einigen Dinoflagellaten vorkommt. Aufgrund seiner Vorteile zur Vorbeugung von Krebs, kognitiven Erkrankungen und Fettleibigkeit sowie seiner antioxidativen Eigenschaften ist Fucoxanthin ein sehr interessantes Molekül fur die Nutrazeutikabranche.
Fucoxanthin hat eine komplexe chemische Struktur mit einer Allenbindung und einer Epoxyketogruppe. Daher wäre seine chemische Synthese kompliziert, da es auch eine stereokontrollierte Synthese erfordert86. Aus diesem Grund ist die Extraktion aus Makroalgen oder Mikroalgen die Methode der Wahl für die kommerzielle Herstellung von Fucoxanthin.
In dieser Arbeit bestand das Ziel darin, die Fucoxanthin-Produktivität in Kieselalgen mit gentechnischen Methoden zu steigern, damit die Zellen mehr Fucoxanthin produzieren. Zu diesem Zweck wurde der Effekt der Insertion zusätzlicher Kopien von Genen in das Genom untersucht, die für geschwindigkeitsbestimmende oder Schlüsselenzyme im Carotinoid- und MEP-Weg kodieren.
Zu Beginn wurden diese Effekte bei einzelnen Mutanten beobachtet. Letztendlich ist es jedoch das Ziel, eine Mutante zu erzeugen, die mehrere geschwindigkeitsbestimmende Enzyme überexprimiert, um auf diese Weise Engpässe zu vermeiden. In früheren Studien erreichten Eilers et al.54 durch die einmalige Überexpression der psy- und dxs-Gene in der Kieselalge P. tricornutum einen 2.4- und 1.8-fachen Anstieg der Fucoxanthin-Spiegel.
In dieser Arbeit führte die Insertion zusätzlicher Kopien der Gene idi und pds2 nicht dazu, dass die Zellen mehr Fucoxanthin produzieren. Im Gegensatz dazu erreichten die Mutanten mit zusätzlichen Kopien der Gen ggpps und mit zusätzlichen Kopien sowohl von psy als auch von dxs seine um 28% bzw. 10% höhere Fucoxanthin-Produktivität pro Million Zellen. Bei diesen Mutanten ist die Gesamtproduktivität jedoch geringer als beim Wildtyp, da ihr Wachstum langsamer als beim Wildtyp ist.
Unter Berücksichtigung der besten Zielgene wurden Mutanten erzeugt, die gleichzeitig zusätzliche Kopien von psy, dxs und ggpps enthielten. Die Mutanten hatten unter sehr niedriegen Lichtbedingungen eine um bis zu 61% höhere Produktivität pro Million Zellen als der Wildtyp. Ausnahmsweise wurden diese Mutanten bei sehr schwachem Licht (10 µE m-2 s-1) gezüchtet, da sie sehr gestresst waren und als Zellklumpen wuchsen. Obwohl die Gesamt-Fucoxanthin-Spiegel in diesen Mutanten unter diesen Bedingungen höher sind als im Wildtyp, sind sie daher niedriger als die Fucoxanthin-Spiegel bei den in anderen Experimenten verwendeten Lichtbedingungen (50 µE m-2 s-1). Als Ergebnis dieser Experimente kann gesagt werden, dass die Belastung der Zellen nach den genetischen Veränderungen untersucht werden muss, da dies zu einer Abnahme der Biomasse und folglich zu einer Abnahme der Fucoxanthinproduktion führt. Alternativ könnte auch eine 2-Stufen-Kultur etabliert werden, in der in einem ersten Schritt eine hohe Biomasse erreicht wird und im zweiten Schritt die Expression der interessierenden Gene induziert wird.
Aufgrund der antioxidativen Eigenschaften von Carotinoiden besteht eine übliche Strategie zur Akkumulation von Carotinoiden darin, die Zellen unter oxidative Stressbedingungen zu setzen. Diese Strategie ist jedoch nicht wirksam für die Anreicherung von Fucoxanthin unter hohen Salzkonzentrationen oder hohen Lichtbedingungen. Bessere Versuchspläne könnten jedoch eine 2-Stufen-Kultur oder adaptive Laborbedingungen gewesen sein.
Eine andere mögliche Strategie zur Erhöhung des Fucoxanthinspiegels wäre die Durchführung einer zufälligen Mutagenese der Zellen. Auf diese Weise sind keine Vorkenntnisse über den Carotinoidsyntheseweg und seine Regulation erforderlich und es kann zu Veränderungen in Genen führen, die keine offensichtlichen Ziele sind.
Experimente mit zufälliger Mutagenese erfordern ein Hochdurchsatz-Screeningsystem, da Hunderte oder sogar Tausende von Mutanten erhalten werden. Eine mögliche Strategie, um die Kultivierung der hohen Anzahl von Mutanten zu vereinfachen, ist die Einkapselung dieser Mutanten in Alginatkügelchen. Auf diese Weise können alle Mutanten in demselben Gefäß kultiviert werden. Die eingekapselten Zellen können dann beispielsweise mit einem Durchflusszytometer auf große Partikel durch Fluoreszenz- oder Absorptionsmessungen gescreent werden.
...
This work deals with the characterization of three different type II polyketide synthase systems (PKS II) from the Gram-negative bacteria Xenorhabdus and Photorhabdus.
Particular attention was paid to a biochemically underexplored class of aryl polyene (APE) pigments. Bioinformatic analysis of enzymes involved in the biosynthesis and the in vitro reconstruction proved that the synthesis of APEs involves an unusual fatty acid-like elongation mechanism. Furthermore, the discovery of unexpected protein-protein interactions provided new insights into the multienzyme complex formation of this unusual PKS II system. Through collaboration with the groups from Prof. Michael Groll and junior Prof. Nina Morgner, two protein complexes were structurally solved and several native protein multimerization events were identified and allowed us to suggest a possible protein-interaction network. The results are summarized in publication ‘An Uncommon Type II PKS Catalyzes Biosynthesis of Aryl Polyene Pigments’ (first author; J. Am. Chem. Soc.).
In addition to in vitro-analysis, in vivo-studies were used to investigate the APE compound produced by X. doucetiae in more detail. The activation of the silent biosynthetic gene cluster (BGC) led to the detection of the APE compound in the homologous host. Further combination of homologous expression and targeted deletions of the APE BGC revealed an APE-lipid-like structure. MS-based analyses and purification of intermediates allowed us to deduce structural building blocks of the APE-lipid, which is composed of an APE structural core, a glucosamine residue and an unusual long-chain fatty acid with unusual conjugated double bonds and a phosphoethanolamine head group. In combination with the above stated in vitro-data, we assumed a plausible biosynthetic mechanism of the APE-lipid. The results are summarized in the section ‘Additional Results: Tracing the Full-length APE’.
The biosynthesis of isopropylstilbene (IPS) has already been well-studied by the Bode laboratory and the group of Prof. Ikuro Abe. Studies with Photorhabdus laumondii TT01 by the Bode group revealed the distributed locations and functions of the genes involved in biosynthesis, which originate from two pathways. Particularly, the Bode group first demonstrated that an unusual ketosynthase/cyclase (StlD) catalyzes the condensation of 5-phenyl-2,4-pentadienoyl-ACP and isovaleryl-beta-ketoacyl-ACP via a Michael addition. Such a pathway for stilbene formation is distinct from those widespread in plants. The Abe group solved the structure and biochemical mechanism of StlD and further investigated the aromatization reaction of the aromatase StlC. However, the generation of the required cinnamoyl-precursor 5-phenyl-2,4-pentadienoyl-ACP as a Michael acceptor for this cyclization reaction remained elusive. In this work, we were able to reconstitute the synthesis of the Michael acceptor in vitro, by the action of enzymes from the fatty acid biosynthesis. With the knowledge about the crucial cross-talk from primary and specialized metabolism, we further determined the minimal endowment for stilbene production in a heterologous host. Here, the discovered AasS enzyme StlB is responsible for the generation of cinnamoyl-ACP and among others, plFabH plays a key role as gatekeeper enzyme for further processing. With this information in hand, we were able to obtain IPS production in E. coli. These results are presented in the manuscript ‘Biosynthesis of the Multifunctional Isopropylstilbene in Photorhabdus laumondii Involves Cross-talk Between Specialized and Primary Metabolism’ (co-first author, manuscript).
The biosynthesis of the orange-to-red-pigmented anthraquinones (AQs) is the best-studied type II PKS system according to preliminary results. While several investigations by Brachmann et al. discovered the BGC and the overall product spectrum of the main AQ-256 and its methylated derivatives, data of Quiqin Zhou (Bode group) performed biochemical in vitro analysis paired with in vivo heterologous expression of the ant-genes antA-I. This led to the identification of shunt products that indicated an AQ-scaffold derived from an octaketide intermediate that gets shortened to a heptaketide by the hydrolase AntI, resulting in the main anthraquinone AQ-256. This PKS-shortening mechanism was further confirmed by the protein crystal structure of AntI by the Groll group (publication, minor contributions, co-author, Chem Sci. ‘Molecular Mechanism of Polyketide Shortening in Anthraquinone Biosynthesis of Photorhabdus luminescens’). Further substrate analysis of the P. luminescens AQ-producer and mutants revealed an inhibitory effect of cinnamic acid against the hydrolase AntI. Cinnamic acid might therefore be involved in regulation of AQ biosynthesis (‘Anthraquinone Production is Influenced by Cinnamic Acid’, first author, manuscript).
Biochemical analysis from Quiqin Zhou with the minimal PKS of the AQ-synthase further revealed the exclusive activation of the AQ-ACP by the PPTase AntB. The PPTase is insoluble alone but gets stabilized by the CoA-ligase, most likely inactive, working as a chaperone. Thus, the minimal PKS endowment to produce the octaketide scaffold compromises, besides the ACP, the KS:CLF heterodimer and the MCAT, the co-occurrence of the PPTase AntB and the CoA-ligase AntG. For the first time, X-ray crystallography depicted a minimal PKS in action, by obtaining the structural data of native complexes from an ACP:KS:CLF, the KS:CLF alone and an ACP:MCAT in their non-active and active forms. It was possible to confirm a KS-bound hexaketide, which was built upon heterologous expression of the KS:CLF. Mutagenesis with amino-acids proposed to be involved in protein-protein interactions in the ACP:KS:CLF complex revealed some interesting protein-interaction sites. Additionally, an induced-fit mechanism of the MCAT with the ACP during the malonylation reaction confirmed a monodirectional transfer reaction (‘Structural Snapshots of the Minimal PKS System Responsible for Octaketide Biosynthesis’ co-author, manuscript under review).
In the past decades, the use and production of chemicals has been on the rise globally due to increasing industrialization and intensive agriculture; resulting in the occurrence and ecotoxicological risks of chemicals of emerging concern (CECs) in the aquatic compartments. Risks include changes in community structure resulting in the dominance of one species and ecosystem imbalance. When dominant disease-causing organisms are in the environment, the disease transmission is increased. For example, host snails for the schistosomiasis, a human trematode disease, are known to be tolerant to pesticide
exposure compared to the predators. This would therefore result in an increased abundance of snails which consequently increase the disease transmission in the human population.
Kenya, being a low income country faces a lot of challenges with provision of clean water, diseases and sanitation facilities, and increasing population which results in intensive agriculture coupled with pesticide use. Although a lot of research has been carried out on the environmental occurrence and risk of CECs (Chapter 1), most of these studies have been done in developed countries with limited information from Africa. Additionally, research in Africa focused on urban areas with limited number of compounds analyzed and mostly in the water phase, and inadequate information on the effects of CECs on the aquatic organisms. In order to reduce this knowledge gap, this dissertation focused on identification and quantification of CECs present in water, sediment and snails from western Kenya, and the contribution of pesticides to the transmission of schistosomiasis.
Chapter 2 gives a summary of the results and discussion of the dissertation. In Chapter 3, a comprehensive chemical analysis was carried out on 48 water samples to identify compounds, spatial patterns and associated risks for fish, crustacean and algae using toxic unit (TU) approach. A total of 78 compounds were detected with pesticides and biocides being the compounds most frequently detected. Spatial pattern analysis revealed limited compound grouping based on land use. Acute risk for crustaceans and algae were driven by one to three individual compounds. These compounds responsible for toxicity were prioritized as candidate compounds for monitoring and regulation in Kenya.
In Chapter 4, an extension of Chapter 3 was done to cover the CECs present in snails and sediment from the 48 sites. A total of 30 compounds were found in snails and 78 in sediments with 68 additional compounds being found which were not previously detected in water. Higher contaminant concentrations were found in agricultural sites than in areas without anthropogenic activities. The highest acute toxicity (TU 0.99) was determined for crustaceans based on compounds in sediment samples. The risk was driven by diazinon and pirimiphos-methyl. Acute and chronic risks to algae were driven by diuron whereas fish were found to be at low to no acute risk.
In Chapter 5, the effect of pesticide contamination on schistosomiasis transmission was evaluated by applying complimentary laboratory and field studies. In the field studies, the ecological mechanisms through which pesticides and physical chemical parameters affect host snails, predators and competitors were investigated. Pesticide data was obtained from the results in chapter 3. The overall distribution of grazers and predators was not affected by pesticide pollution. However, within the grazers, pesticide pollution increased dominance of host snails. On the contrary, the host-snail competitors were highly sensitive to pesticide exposure. For the laboratory studies, macroinvertebrates including Schistosoma-host snails, competitors and predators were exposed to 6 concentrations levels of imidacloprid and diazinon. Snails showed higher insecticide tolerance compared to competitors and predators. Finally, Chapter 6 summarizes the conclusions of this dissertation, placing it in a broader
context. In this dissertation, a comprehensive chemical characterization and risk assessment of CECs has been carried out in freshwater systems; together with the effects of pesticides on schistosomiasis transmission in rural western Kenya. Results of this dissertation showed that rural areas are contaminated posing a risk to aquatic organisms which contribute to schistosomiasis transmission. This shows the need for regular monitoring and policy formulation to reduce pollutant emissions which contributes negatively to both ecological and human health effects.
Freshwater is one of the most fundamental resources for life and is the habitat for a wide diversity of species. One of the most diverse aquatic insect taxa is Trichoptera Kirby, 1813, caddisflies. These semi-aquatic insects have aquatic larvae and terrestrial adults and are found all around the globe in freshwater habitats. Water is also one of the most important natural resources for the human population, but alarmingly, freshwaters are among the most threatened natural habitats. Thus, the monitoring and preservation of the quality of freshwater habitats should have a high priority. In order to track changes in the biota a baseline reference is necessary, but freshwater biodiversity is under-studied in many parts of the Earth such as the biodiversity hotspots of the Himalaya and the Hengduan Mountains. This thesis treats the trichopteran genus Himalopsyche Banks, 1940 (Rhyacophilidae) which has its diversity center in the Himalayas and the Hengduan Mountains. Himalopsyche larvae are large and conspicuous and only occur in clean, unpolluted streams. This makes Himalopsyche potentially suited as indicator organisms for freshwater quality monitoring, but taxonomic knowledge is yet insufficient. Based on samples from a field survey in the Hengduan Mountains targeting both larvae and adults I uncovered three new Himalopsyche species which are described in this thesis (Chapter II), and with the aid of molecular data I associated larvae of Himalopsyche to adult species (Chapter I). The molecular association enabled the first comparative morphological study of Himalopsyche species in the larval stage, and the morphological study in Chapter II revealed that there are four distinct larval types of Himalopsyche. However, no diagnostic characters to identify Himalopsyche larvae to species level were found. To understand Himalopsyche larval morphology from an evolutionary perspective, I reconstructed the first molecular phylogeny of the genus (Chapter III). This demonstrated that each larval type corresponds to a deep phylogenetic split, indicating that larval types evolved early in Himalopsyche evolution and remained constant since. Based on the phylogenetic results as well as larval and adult morphology, I re-defined five species groups of Himalopsyche: H. kuldschensis Group, H. lepcha Group, H. navasi Group, H. phryganea Group, and H. tibetana Group. The species groups differ with respect to their diversity centers. The monotypic H. lepcha Group resides in the Himalayas, and the monotypic H. phryganea Group inhabits Western Nearctic. The H. kuldschensis and H. tibetana Groups are geographically overlapping with distributions in the Himalayas, but the distribution of H. kuldschensis Group stretches more to the west to include the Tian Shan, and the H. tibetana Group is more concentrated around the eastern Himalayas and the Hengduan Mountains. The H. navasi Group has a more eastern distribution than most Himalopsyche including isolated areas such as Japan and Indonesia. The earliest split in Himalopsyche divides the H. navasi Group from remaining Himalopsyche, suggesting a more eastern area of origin of Himalopsyche than its current diversity center, with subsequent radiations in the Himalayas and Hengduan Mountains. In addition to the three chapters, in this thesis I discuss further aspects of Himalopsyche biology including genital evolution, species complexes, and Himalopsyche ecology.
Xenorhabdus and Photorhabdus are bacterial genera that live in symbiosis with entomopathogenic nematodes of the genera Steinernema and Heterorhabditis, respectively. These nematodes infect insect larvae through the trachea and then enter the hemocoel. Once inside the hemocoel, the nematodes release the bacteria through their intestine. Thereafter, the bacteria become active and kill the larvae within 48 h. During this process, the immune system of the insect host is compromised by molecules produced and secreted by the bacteria. This illustrates that the bacteria possess not only a large arsenal of biological weaponry such as antibiotics and fungicides but also lipases, proteases, etc. Therefore, they are not only able to kill the insect but also protect the cadaver from other food competitors.
During the past decades, a large number of natural products have been identified from Xenorhabdus and Photorhabdus. However, the targets and functions for many of these biological molecules are still unknown. Therefore, the goal of the doctoral thesis is to elucidate the modes of action of these natural products from Xenorhabdus and Photorhabdus with the main focus on non-ribosomal peptides (NRPs). The work can be divided into two parts. Initially, it starts with the synthesis of natural compounds and various chemically modified derivatives. Besides that, a number of peptides were synthesized for other projects to either verify their structures or quantify the amount produced by the bacteria. Then, secondary analysis methods are applied and provide additional insight into the modes of action of these compounds.
During the thesis, I carried out peptide synthesis either manually or with an automatic synthesizer system from Biotage. Here, the Fmoc-protecting group strategy was preferred in most cases. Natural products, such as silathride, xenoautoxin, phenylethylamide, tryptamide, rhabdopeptide, 3-hydroxyoctanoic acid, and PAX, were produced during this process. Furthermore, new peptide derivatives derived from synthetic NRPS approaches using the XU concept or SYNZIP were generated as standards.
Most of these natural compounds were experimentally verified by MIC tests (broth microdilution, plate diffusion) to be biologically active. For example, silathride, phenylethylamide, and tryptamide showed quorum quenching effects when tested against Chromobacterium violaceum. Initial results from collaborators (PD Dr. Nadja Hellmann/Mainz) showed that tryptamide and phenylethylamide interact with membrane or membrane proteins.
(R)-3-hydroxyoctanoic acid was synthesized to verify the molecule structure of phototemtide A, a cyclic lipopeptide with antiprotozoal activity. The rhabdopeptides are another class, which showed remarkable antiprotozoal effects. However, their mode of action was unknown. These compounds are relatively short peptide sequences, which contain hydrophobic residues, such as valine, leucine, or phenylalanine. Moreover, they possess N methylation, resulting in a rod-shaped highly hydrophobic structure. In this work, I synthesized eight new derivatives of rhabdopeptides for photo-affinity labeling (PAL). These molecules should react covalently under UV-light irradiation with the biological target of the peptides. In addition, these derivatives can be enriched in a pull-down assay using click chemistry. Afterward, analytic methods such as mass detection (proteome analysis) can be applied to elucidate the protein targets.
The PAX peptides derivatives are well-known to have anti-microbial activities and believed to be secreted into the environment by the producing bacteria. However, I found that the majority of these peptides are located in the cell pellet fraction and not in the supernatant. This has been shown through quantification using HPLC MS. New PAX derivatives were synthesized, which carry a moiety suitable for covalent modification using click-chemistry, therefore being functionalizable with a fluorescence dye. In collaboration with Dr. Christoph Spahn (Prof. Dr. Mike Heilemann group), we used confocal, as well as super-resolution microscopy, in particular, single-molecule localization microscopy (SMLM) to investigate the spatial distribution of clickable PAX molecules and revealed that they localize at the bacterial membrane. Furthermore, bioactivity assays revealed that the promotor exchanged X. doucetiae PAX mutants, which do not produce PAX molecules without chemical induction (hereby termed as pax-), were more susceptible to several insect AMPs tested. Based on these findings, a new dual mechanism of action for PAX was proposed. Besides the previously shown antimicrobial activity, these molecules with a positive net charge of +5 (pH = 7) would bind to the negatively charged bacterial surface. Hereby, the surface charge (typically negative) would be inversed resulting in a protective effect for Xenorhabdus against other positively charged AMPs. Furthermore, PAX was investigated as AMP against E. coli to study its antimicrobial mechanism of action. Here, the results show that PAX can disrupt the E. coli membrane at higher concentrations (> 30 µg/ml), enter the cytosol, and lead to reorganization of subcellular structures, such as the nucleoid during this process.
Another aspect of secondary analysis is the application of proteomic analysis. Therefore, I induced X. nematophila, X. szentirmaii, and P. luminescens with insect lysate. These samples were analyzed using HPLC-MS/MS (Q Exactive) together with a database approach (Maxquant/Andromeda). The results showed that in all strains the lipid degradation and the glyoxylate pathway were induced. This is in line with the given insect lysate diet, which mostly contained lipids. Moreover, several interesting unknown peptides and proteins were also upregulated and might get into the focus of future research.
The genus Giraffa likely evolved around seven million years ago in Indo-Asia and spread over the Arabian-African land bridge into Eastern Africa. The oldest fossil of the African lineage was found in Kenya and dated to 7-5.4 Mya. Beside modern giraffe, four additional African species have likely existed (G. gracilis, G. pygmaea, G. stillei, and G. jumae). Based on their morphological similarities, G. gracilis is often considered to be the closest relative of the modern giraffe. Nevertheless, the phylogeny within the genus Giraffa is largely unresolved.
Modern giraffe (Giraffa sp.) have been neglected by the scientific community for a long time and still very little is known about their biology. Traditionally, present-day giraffe have been considered a single species (G. camelopardalis) which is divided into six to eleven subspecies, with nine subspecies being the most accepted classification. This classification was based on morphological differences and geographic ranges. However, recent genetic analyses found hidden diversity within Giraffa and proposed four genetically distinct giraffe species (G. camelopardalis, G. reticulata, G. tippelskirchi, G. giraffa) with presumably little gene flow among them.
Gene flow on a population level is the exchange of genetic information among populations facilitated by the migration of individuals between populations. Additionally, it is an important criterion to delineate species, because many species concepts, especially the Biological Species Concept, rely on the concept of reproductive isolation. Yet, new genetic methods are identifying an increasing number of species that show signs of introgressive hybridization or gene flow among them. Therefore, strict reproductive isolation cannot always be applied to delineate species, especially in young, probably still diverging, species such as giraffe.
Therefore, giraffe are ideal study organisms to investigate the level of gene flow in recently diverged species with adjacent or potentially overlapping ranges. Furthermore, their recent classification as “Vulnerable” by the IUCN and their unreliable distribution maps require the genetic evaluation of their population structure, distribution and conservation status.
In Publication 1 (Winter et al. (2018a), Ecological Genetics and Genomics, 7–8, 1–5), I studied the distribution and matrilineal population structure of Angolan giraffe (G. giraffa angolensis) using sequences from the cytochrome b gene (1,140 bp) and the mitochondrial control region for individuals from across their known range and beyond, and additionally including individuals from all known giraffe species and subspecies. The reconstruction of a phylogenetic tree and a mitochondrial haplotype network allowed to identify the most easterly known natural population of Angolan giraffe, a population that was previously assigned to their sister-subspecies South African giraffe (G. giraffa giraffa), indicating the limit of classification by morphology and geography. Furthermore, the analyses show that Namibia’s iconic desert-dwelling giraffe population is genetically distinct, even from the nearest population at Etosha National Park, suggesting very limited, if any, natural exchange of matrilines. Yet, no geographic barriers are known for this region that would prevent genetic exchange. Therefore, the two populations are likely on different evolutionary trajectories. Limited individuals with an Etosha haplotype further suggest that translocation of Etosha giraffe into the desert population had only a minor impact on the local population. Two separate haplogroups within Etosha National Park suggest an “out of Etosha” radiation of Angolan giraffe to the East followed by a later back-migration.
In Publication 2 (Winter et al. (2018b), Ecology and Evolution, 8(20), 10156–10165), I investigated the genetic population structure of giraffe across their range (n = 137) with focus on the amount of gene flow among the proposed giraffe species with a 3-fold increased set of nuclear introns (n = 21). Limited gene flow of less than one effective migrant per generation, even between the closely related northern (G. camelopardalis) and reticulated giraffe (G. reticulata) further supports the existence of four giraffe species by a different methodology, gene flow. This is significant because most species concepts build on reproductive isolation. Furthermore, this result is corroborated by four distinct major clades in a phylogenetic tree analysis, and distinct clusters in Principal Component Analysis and STRUCTURE analysis. All these analyses suggest a low level of genetic exchange among the four giraffe species and, therefore, a high degree of reproductive isolation in accordance with the Biological Species Concept (BSC). In Addition, only a single individual in 137 was identified as being potential of natural hybrid origin, which promotes the four-species concept further. ...
A novel role for mutant mRNA degradation in triggering transcriptional adaptation to mutations
(2020)
Robustness to mutations promotes organisms’ well-being and fitness. The increasing number of mutants in various model organisms, and humans, showing no obvious phenotype (Bouche and Bouchez, 2001; Chen et al., 2016b; Giaever et al., 2002; Kok et al., 2015) has renewed interest into how organisms adapt to gene loss. In the presence of deleterious mutations, genetic compensation by transcriptional upregulation of related gene(s) (also known as transcriptional adaptation) has been reported in numerous systems (El-Brolosy and Stainier, 2017; Rossi et al., 2015; Tondeleir et al., 2012); however, the molecular mechanisms underlying this response remained unclear. To investigate this phenomenon, I develop and study multiple models of transcriptional adaptation in zebrafish and mouse cell lines. I first show that transcriptional adaptation is not caused by loss of protein function, indicating that the trigger lies upstream, and find that the response involves enhanced transcription of the related gene(s). Furthermore, I observe a correlation between levels of mutant mRNA degradation and upregulation of related genes. To investigate the role of mutant mRNA degradation in triggering the response, I generate mutant alleles that do not transcribe the mutated gene and find that they fail to induce a transcriptional response and display stronger phenotypes. Transcriptome analysis of alleles displaying mutant mRNA degradation revealed upregulation of a significant proportion of genes displaying sequence similarity with the mutated gene’s mRNA, suggesting a model whereby mRNA degradation intermediates induce transcriptional adaptation via sequence similarity. Further mechanistic analyses suggested RNA-decay factors-dependent chromatin remodeling, and repression of antisense RNAs to be implicated in the response. These results identify a novel role for mutant mRNA degradation in buffering against mutations. Besides, they hold huge implications on understanding disease-causing mutations and shall help in designing mutations that lead to minimal transcriptional adaptation-induced compensation, facilitating studying gene function in model organisms.
Even one century after Santiago Ramón y Cajal’s groundbreaking contribu- tions to neuroscience, one of the most fundamental questions in the field is still largely open, namely understanding how the shape of a dendrite is adapted to its specific biological function. A systematic investigation of this problem is challenging both technically and conceptually because neurons have diverse genetic, molecular, morphological, connectional and functional properties.
In the light of the preceding, dendritic arborisation (da) neurons of the Drosophila melanogaster larva PNS have proven to be an excellent model system for the study of such growth and patterning processes. Structure and function in these cell classes are intimately intertwined, as class type-specific dendritic arbour differentiation processes are required to satisfy a given phys- iological need. Also, there is a remarkable genetic toolkit that enables one to selectively and reproducibly label, image and manipulate each one of these sensory neuron classes. In this thesis, I address the aforementioned open problem by linking single-cell patterning, information processing and wiring optimisation in sensory da neurons to behaviour in Drosophila larva.
In particular, I study Class I ventral peripherical dendritic arborisation (c1vpda) neurons. These are a class of proprioceptive neurons that relay information on the position of the larva’s body back to the CNS during crawling behaviour to assure proper locomotion. Their stereotypical comb- like shaped dendritic branches spread along the body-wall, and they get noticeably deformed during crawling behaviour. The bending of the den- dritic branches is hypothesised to be a possible mechanism to transduce the mechanosensory inputs arising from cuticle folding. Interestingly, c1vpda neurons do not necessarily satisfy optimal wiring constraints since they are required to pattern into a specific shape to fulfil their function. Therefore, I considered the da system to study how the specific functional requirements may be combined with optimal wiring constraints during development.
Although the molecular machinery of dendrite patterning in c1vpda neurons is well studied, the precise elaboration of the comb-like shaped dendrites of these cells remains elusive. Moreover, even though a lot of work has been put into the description and quantification of growth processes of the nervous system, there are still few solid and standardised models of arbour staging and patterning. Importantly, the defining parameters that determine the dendrite elaboration program that in turn is responsible for creating the final arbour morphology are still unknown. As a result, unraveling possible universal stages of dendrite elaboration shared between different model systems and cell types is challenging.
Thus, in order to understand the development of the fine regulation of branch outgrowth that leads to the observed terminal arbour morphology in the mature cell, I collected in vivo, long-term, non-invasive high temporal res- olution time-lapse recordings of dendritic trees during the differentiation process in the embryo and its maturation phase in the larva. For further analysis, I developed new algorithms that quantified the structural changes in dendrite morphology in the time-lapse videos. My approach provides a framework to analyse such developmental data, or any dataset comprising continuous morphological dynamical processes in an unbiased way. Using these newly developed methods, I examined the development of a sample of c1vpda cells and identified five stages of differentiation in these data: initial stem polarization, extension, pruning, stabilization, and isometric stretching during larval stages.
The beginning of the growth process is marked by the polarisation of the main stem. Subsequently, during the extension phase, branches emerge interstitially from the existing main stem. Later, higher-order branches sprout from pre-existing lateral branches, increasing arbour complexity. This is followed by a pruning stage where developmental intermediate dendritic branches are removed. This step leads to a spatial rearrangement of the dendritic tree. The end of the pruning step is followed by a stabilisation period where arbour morphology remains virtually unaltered in the embryo. After hatching, c1vpda dendrites experience an isometric scaling, with their branching complexity and pattern being invariant across all larval stages.
After dissecting the c1vpda dendrites spatiotemporal differentiation process, I established a link between dendritic shape and behaviour. I measured intra- cellular Ca++ activity in the dendrite branches of l1 larvae during forward locomotion, while simultaneously recording branch deformation using a dual genetic line. I reported that post-embryonic c1vpda dendrites Ca++ responses increased in freely crawling larvae. Furthermore, I showed strong correlations between Ca++ signal and deformation of the comb-like dendritic ranches during body-wall contractions.
Then, using a geometrical model, I provided evidence that the pruning stage could reorganise the dendrite morphology to maximise mechanosensory re- sponses during body wall contraction. I showed that the angle orientation of each side branch correlates with the bending curvature and thus with the me- chanical displacement of the cell membrane during locomotion. During the pruning phase, I observed a preferential reduction of less efficient branches with low bending curvature, influencing the mechanisms of dendritic sig- nal integration of c1vpda sensory neurons. I proceeded to quantify branch dynamics at single tip resolution during pruning, providing evidence that a simple random pruning mechanism is sufficient to remodel the tree structure compatible with the observed way.
I used these time-lapse data to constrain a new computational noisy growth model with random pruning based on optimal wiring principles. This model is able to generate highly realistic synthetic c1vpda morphologies. The model furthermore requires few parameters to generate highly accurate temporal development trajectories and morphologies at single-cell level. Utilising this data and model enabled me to investigate upon the hypothesis that a noisy dendrite growth and random pruning mechanism synergise to achieve den- dritic trees efficient in terms of both wiring and function. My findings show how single neurons can create functionally specialised dendrites while min- imising wiring costs, elucidating how general principles of self-organisation may be involved in the generation of these structures.
The growing number of infections with multi-resistant bacteria or the current COVID-19 pandemic put compounds with therapeutic properties into the public focus. Non-ribosomal peptides (NRPs) are natural products that are already marketed as antibiotics, cytotoxic agents or immunosuppressants. Their biological activities rely on the structural diversity including non-proteinogenic amino acids (AAs), heterocycles or modifications like methylation or acylation.
The biosynthesis of NRPs is carried out by non-ribosomal peptide synthetases (NRPSs). These multifunctional megaenzymes show a modular architecture like in an assembly-line. Each module is thereby responsible for the incorporation and modification of one AA and therefore contains different catalytic domains. The adenylation (A) domain recognizes and activates its specific substrate in an ATP-dependent manner which is transferred to a 4’-phosphopantetheine cofactor post-translationally attached to the thiolation (T) domain. Peptide bond formation between two T domain bound substrates catalysed by the condensation (C) domain transfers the growing peptide chain to the following module. Such a C-A-T module can be extended with optional domains to integrate structural diversity and a terminal thioesterase (TE) domain usually releases the peptide via hydrolysis or intramolecular attack of nucleophiles. Inspired by the modular architecture, NRPS engineering deals with the modification of NRPs in order to increase biological activities, circumvent bacterial resistances or create de novo peptides. This can be achieved by mutasynthesis or modification of the substrate binding pocket as well as single and multiple domain substitution. However, the few successful approaches led to impaired enzymes and did not establish a general applicable guideline. In the first publication as part of this work, the development of such a guideline comprising three rules is addressed. First, the A-T-C tridomain named exchange unit (XU) is seen as a catalytic unit instead of a module. When using them as building blocks, the C domain’s specificity for the AA of the following XU has to be considered as second rule. Third, a conserved WNATE motif within the C-A linker depicts the fusion point of the XUs. Upon heterologous expression of the cloned plasmids in E. coli and high performance liquid chromatography coupled mass spectrometry-based analysis of the extracts, the ambactin-producing NRPS from Xenorhabdus was reprogrammed with one and two XUs. This only leads to a moderate loss of production titre or an even higher one when the AA configuration was changed by introducing a dual condensation/epimerization (C/E) domain. The pentamodular GameXPeptide-producing NRPS was reconstructed using up to five XUs of four different NRPSs and even completely de novo synthetases were created. The second publication describes the exchange unit condensation domain (XUC) concept and relies on a fusion point between the two subdomains (N-terminal CDsub and C-terminal CAsub) of the C domain’s V-shaped pseudodimeric structure which generates A-T didomains with flanking CAsub and CDsub. These hybrid C domain-forming building blocks depict an improvement to the XU concept by avoiding the drawback of C domain specificity. This allows a more flexible NRPS engineering that can e.g. enable peptide library design. Furthermore, beside a combination of both concepts within one NRPS and a transfer to Bacillus NRPSs, the use of XUC with relaxed A domain specificity allowed further peptide modifications by introducing non-natural AAs. The third publication deals with aldehyde and alcohol-generating reductase (R) domains which depict an alternative for peptide release in NRPSs. A promoter exchange in X. indica identified a pyrazine-producing NRPS with a minimal architecture of an A, T and R domain and was therefore termed ATRed. R domains were additionally used in engineered NRPSs to produce pyrazinones and derivatives thereof by XU substitution although most constructs failed to show production. Beyond that, an R domain has been shown to replace a TE domain in wild type synthetases leading to slightly modified NRPs and the postulated biosynthesis was incidentally revised. Furthermore, an NRPS with terminal R domain was engineered to produce a free peptide aldehyde, which are known to be potent proteasome inhibitors. For the above mentioned ATReds, the presence of up to three coding regions was further identified in 20 different Xenorhabdus strains but only six of them were verified to produce pyrazines. All ATReds share variable sequence similarities among each other and were subsequently divided into three subtypes. One subtype is supposed to perform the pyrazine biosynthesis via a non-canonical catalytic triad.
Photorhabdus and Xenorhabdus bacteria live in a highly specific symbiosis with nematodes that belong to the genus of Heterorhabditis and Steinernema, respectively. These cruiser type nematodes actively search for soil-dwelling insects and infect them via natural openings. Inside of the insect, the bacteria are released into the hemocoel where they start producing an array of secondary metabolites to bypass the insect immune system and kill the prey within 48 hours. Many of those natural products possess bioactivities against other bacteria, fungi, protozoa or insects, which makes them interesting candidates for pharmaceutical applications. Even though advanced molecular biological methods in combination with bioinformatics tools can now be used to predict biosynthetic gene clusters (BGCs) and their products, there are still many BGCs with unknown products. Even for the plethora of natural products that were successfully identified in the last couple of years, the exact ecological function often remains elusive, as laboratory conditions can vary considerably from the natural environment of the bacteria. Knowledge about the natural conditions that stimulate, or repress production of certain natural products and their underlying regulatory mechanisms yield new approaches for natural product research and enables possibilities for selective manipulations of the regulatory cascades.
The overarching goal of this work was to examine the regulatory networks in Photorhabdus and Xenorhabdus strains. The first part of this work focused on the Hfq-dependent regulation of specialized metabolite production. In those genera, the RNA chaperone, Hfq, represses expression of hexA, which encodes for a global transcriptional regulator that acts as the master repressor for SM production. Multiple global approaches were used to identify the sRNA ArcZ, which targets a specific region in the 5’-untranslated region of the hexA mRNA and ultimately guides Hfq in order to repress its expression. It was shown that a deletion of arcZ led to a drastic reduction of SM production in Photorhabdus and Xenorhabdus, consistent with the phenotype of their respective hfq deletion mutants. Transcriptomic profiling revealed far-reaching effects on the transcriptome, with up to 735 coding sequences significantly affected in the arcZ deletion strain. Finally, it was shown that the resulting chemical background, devoid of SMs, in combination with targeted promotor exchange can be used to exclusively overproduce a desired natural product, representing an alternative route of genetic manipulation.
The second part of this work focused on the influence and identification of insect related compounds that affect SM production in P. laumondii, X. szentirmaii and X. nematophila. Insect homogenate was generated from G. mellonella larvae, a model host for these bacteria. Supplementation of the cultivation medium with homogenate induced considerable shifts in the SM profiles of those bacteria. A global effect on the transcriptional output was determined by transcriptomic profiling. The core response to the simulation of an insect environment consisted of ten CDS, eight of which are involved in the degradation of fatty acids or the import of maltose and maltodextrin into the cells. Two abundant components in the insect homogenate, trehalose and putrescin, were added to the cultivation medium of those strains and subsequent HPLC-MS analysis revealed a direct correlation of their concentration in the medium and the production titres of certain SMs. These results indicated that the bacteria sense the insect environment via different insect specific components in order to initiate a metabolic adjustment, which is probably required for adaptation to the insect host.
The last part of this work examined the influence of other, so far not directly related genes on SM production, based on the isolation of P. laumondii transposon-insertion mutants with clear phenotypic alterations. Re-sequencing and SM profiling of the mutant strains revealed that a transposon-insertion in the gene encoding for a putative DNA-adenine methyltransferase affected SM production. The phenotype was confirmed by deleting this gene. Based on Single-Molecule Real-Time sequencing, the complete methylome of the WT, deletion- and complementation mutant were analysed (experimental work performed by Sacha J. Pidot, Melbourne, Australia). No obvious alterations were detected in the methylation patterns of the strains, indicating that the dam gene product does not methylate the adenine in GATC-motifs, as it was described in literature for E. coli. This data raises the question what the function of the putative DNA-adenine methyltransferase is in P. laumondii and how it can influence the secondary metabolism. Even though there is currently no clear evidence, the potential role of epigenetic gene regulation mechanisms should be considered in further work.
Die CXCR4/CXCL12-Achse ist von entscheidender Bedeutung für die Entstehung und Aufrechterhaltung einer gesunden, reifen Hämatopoese. Erstmals beschrieben wurde der später als CXCR4 bezeichnete Rezeptor 1996 allerdings als Co-Rezeptor für den Eintritt humaner HI-Viren in Lymphozyten. Ein großes Interesse bestand daraufhin darin, sowohl natürliche Inhibitoren des G-Protein gekoppelten Rezeptors zu identifizieren, als auch synthetische herzustellen, um einen Eintritt des Virus in den menschlichen Organismus zu verhindern bzw. seine Ausbreitung zu unterbinden. Ein natürlich vorkommender CXCR4-Ligand, der 2015 von Zirafi und Kollegen erstmals beschrieben wurde, fand sich im Hämofiltrat von Dialysepatienten. Der im weiteren Verlauf als EPI-X4 bezeichnete CXCR4-Antagonist wurde als Spaltprodukt von Albumin identifiziert, welches über viele Spezies hochkonserviert ist. Diese Eigenschaft interpretieren wir als Hinweis auf eine relevante physiologische Funktion des Peptids. Da die Halbwertszeit von natürlich vorkommendem EPI-X4 beim Menschen vermutlich sehr kurz ist, sind in vivo- und darauffolgende in vitro-Analysen schwierig durchzuführen. In-vitro-Spike-Analysen von synthetischem EPI-X4 in humanem Plasma ergaben eine Halbwertszeit von nur 17 Minuten. Die geringen auftretenden Konzentrationen erschweren die Problematik zusätzlich. In dieser Arbeit sollen deshalb im Mausmodell in vivo-Analysen durchgeführt werden, um die Effekte von potentiell entstehendem EPI-X4 in verschiedenen experimentellen Ansätzen aufzudecken. Ein probates, hier verwendetes Mittel, ist die Analyse einer Knock-out (KO)-Maus. Die für die Bindung an CXCR4 entscheidende Aminosäure von EPI-X4, das am N-Terminus gelegene Leucin, wurde durch Alanin ersetzt, welches die Entstehung von EPI-X4 unterbindet und zusätzlich dessen Bindung an CXCR4 verhindert. Mit Hilfe zweier Mausmodelle können nun Analysen im EPI-X4-defizienten Modell durchgeführt werden, die im Umkehrschluss Informationen über die organismische Wirkung von EPI-X4 beinhalten. Zunächst wurde in beiden Modellen die physiologisch normale reife und unreife Hämatopoese charakterisiert. Hierbei zeigte sich kein signifikanter systematischer Einfluss von EPI-X4 auf reife Leukozyten (WBC), lediglich eine leichte Lymphozytose in der HR-Ala-Variante. Im weiteren Verlauf der homöostatischen Analyse der Hämatopoese der Ala-EPI-X4-Mäuse zeigten sich keine signifikanten Unterschiede zu wildtypischen Mäusen. Sowohl reife als auch unreife Zellen zeigten, außer in der T- und B-Zelllinie, keine zahlenmäßigen oder funktionalen Auffälligkeiten, weder im Blut, noch in der Milz oder im Knochenmark. Analysen der Zellzyklusaktivität unterschiedlicher Unreifestufen wiesen ebenfalls keine Auffälligkeiten auf. Diese Daten einer normalen, von einer C57Bl/6-Maus zu erwartenden Ergebnisse dienten als Grundlage zur Bewertung und Analyse von durchgeführten hämatopoetischen Stressmodellen. Hierfür wurden
zunächst hämatopoetische Stamm- und Vorläuferzellen (HSPC) mobilisiert. In den angewandten Mobilisierungsmodellen fanden sich lediglich unter G-CSF-Behandlung im Knochenmark eine größere Anzahl Granulozyten, was auf einen Einfluss von EPI-X4 auf HSPC schließen lässt. Um potentielle Auswirkungen von EPI-X4 im Knochenmark weiter zu untersuchen, wurde ein weiteres Stressmodell gewählt, welches ebenfalls mutmaßlich die Bedingungen zur EPI-X4-Generierung schafft: Subletale Bestrahlung der Mäuse sorgt für Schäden an allen Zellarten im Knochenmark, es wird ein steriles entzündliches Milieu kreiert. Unter diesen Umständen wurde die Regeneration von Blutzellen analysiert. Es zeigten sich keine nennenswerten Unterschiede sowohl in der akuten Phase des Schadens als auch in regelmäßigen Blutentnahmen während der Regenerierung.
Die Beschreibung von natürlich vorkommendem EPI-X4 in Vaginal- und Rektalschleimhaut zeigt seine Entstehung an Schleimhautbarrieren auf. Ala-EPI-X4-Muse werden deshalb auf deren Durchlässigkeit untersucht: LPS-Konzentrationen als Marker für eindringende pathogene Bakterien wurden im Plasma untersucht. Hierbei zeigten sich keine Unterschiede zwischen den Gruppen, eine Störung scheint hier nicht vorzuliegen. Zusätzlich wurde die Zusammensetzung des Mikrobioms im Darm untersucht, da beschrieben wurde, dass sich Mikrobiom und die Integrität der Darmschleimhaut gegenseitig beeinflussen. Im Falle der EPI-X4-defizienten Mäuse liegt zwar keine offensichtliche pathologische Veränderung vor, dennoch konnte in männlichen HR-Ala-Mäusen die Abwesenheit des Proteobakteriums Parasutterella nachgewiesen werden. Um eine mögliche Defizienz der Barrierefunktion weiter zu testen, wurden zwei Stressmodelle gewählt: Zunächst wurde den Mäusen eine akute, sterile Peritonitis zugefügt, woraufhin die Anzahl und Zusammensetzung der ins Peritoneum einströmenden Leukozyten analysiert wird. Die Reaktion auf diesen Entzündungsprozess war nicht verändert. Ähnliche Ergebnisse zeigten sich auch in einem akuten Colitis-Stressmodell.
Insgesamt konnte in dieser Arbeit mithilfe zweier KO-Mausmodelle die Rolle von EPI-X4 in der Hämatopoese und der Immunologie von Mäusen beginnend charakterisiert werden. Die homöostatische Hämatopoese scheint kaum von EPI-X4 abhängig zu sein, lediglich die Zahl der B- und T-Zellen, insbesondere der regulatorischen T-Zellen, scheint beeinflusst. Damit einhergehend konnten Veränderungen in Zytokinlevels bei inflammatorischen Ereignissen gezeigt werden. Experimente zur beeinflussten, eventuell gestörten Barrierefunktion von Ala-EPI-X4-Mäusen zeigten vielversprechende Ansätze und sollten in Zukunft weiter analysiert werden.
Das Gehirn weist in mehreren Bereichen anatomische Asymmetrien zwischen beiden Hemisphären auf, so auch in Bereichen der Hörrinde. Zudem ist bereits langjährig bekannt, dass menschliche Sprache vorrangig in der linken Gehirnhälfte, d.h. linksseitig lateralisiert, verarbeitet wird. Daraus folgend stellt sich die Frage, ob dies eine besondere Spezialisierung ist, oder ob es noch weitere lateralisierte Hirnfunktionen gibt. Viele akustische Signale haben dabei frequenzmodulierte (FM) Komponenten, die im Hörsystem für die Erkennung nach Parametern wie Richtung und Dauer der Modulation analysiert werden müssen. Ob die Analyse von FM-Komponenten oder einzelner Reizparameter im Gehirn lateralisiert stattfindet, wurde in der Literatur meist mit bildgebenden Verfahren untersucht.
Für das Erkennen und Unterscheiden der Modulationsrichtung weist eine Vielzahl von Studien auf eine erhöhte Aktivität in der rechten Hörrinde hin. Für die Analyse von Stimulusdauern ist es bisher allerdings noch unklar bzw. umstritten, ob diese lateralisiert erfolgt. Für die Untersuchung der Lateralisierung einfacher Sprachkomponenten werden häufig Konsonant-Vokal-Silben (CV-Silben) verwendet. In einer Vielzahl von Studien konnte eine linkslastige Lateralisierung, wie bei der Spracherkennung, gezeigt werden.
In der vorliegenden Arbeit wurde nun untersucht, ob ein eindeutigeres Muster von Lateralisierung zu finden ist, wenn diese in Wahrnehmungsexperimenten, untersucht wird. Dabei wurde ein zu untersuchender Teststimulus (FM-/CV-Stimulus) auf einem Ohr mit einem kontralateralen breitbandigen Rauschen auf dem anderen Ohr gleichzeitig präsentiert. Durch die Struktur der Hörbahn kann dabei davon ausgegangen werden, dass in einer Hemisphäre des Vorderhirns vorrangig Informationen aus dem kontralateralen Ohr verarbeitet und Informationen aus dem ipsilateralen Ohr unterdrückt werden und sich somit Rückschlüsse auf die Funktion/Beteiligung einer Hemishpäre ziehen lassen. Das Rauschen diente dabei zur unspezifischen Aktivierung der gegenüberliegenden Hemisphäre.
Die Lateralisierung wurde systematisch für unterschiedlich komplexe Reize untersucht. Dazu wurden in zwei Versuchsreihen Unterscheidungsexperimente durchgeführt, die sich in mehrere Messungen (mit mehreren Durchläufen) mit unterschiedlichen Parametereinstellungen gliederten. Pro Durchlauf musste sich die Versuchsperson immer zwischen zwei Antwortmöglichkeiten entscheiden (2-AFC-Verfahren). Der Schalldruckpegel des Rauschens war dabei für alle Messungen konstant. Der Schalldruckpegel der Teststimuli blieb zwar während einer Messung konstant, wurde jedoch innerhalb eines Experimentes von Messung zu Messung reduziert.
In einer gemeinsamen Analyse wurden jeweils die Fehlerraten und Reaktionszeiten beider Ohren, getrennt nach Seite und FM-/ CV-Stimulus, miteinander verglichen, um so auf eine mögliche Lateralisierung schließen zu können. Damit die Daten der Versuchspersonen bei vergleichbarer Schwierigkeit analysiert werden konnten, wurde als Vergleichswert zwischen allen Versuchspersonen der Schalldruckpegel der ersten Messung mit einer Fehlerrate von mindestens 15,0 % gewählt (15 %-Kriterium). Um auszuschließen, dass das Hörvermögen der Versuchspersonen Unterschiede zwischen beiden Ohren aufweist, wurde vor jeder Messung der „Punkt subjektiver Gleichheit“ für die Lautstärke-wahrnehmung zwischen linkem und rechten Ohr bestimmt.
In der ersten Versuchsreihe wurde dabei die Verarbeitung der Modulationsrichtung und der Stimulusdauer von FM-Stimuli untersucht. Es zeigte sich für beide Experimente, dass ein sinkender Schalldruckpegel des FM-Stimulus zu einer steigenden Fehlerrate führte. Unter Anwendung des 15 %-Kriteriums waren die Fehlerraten für die Unterscheidung der Modulationsrichtung signifikant geringer, wenn der FM-Stimulus auf dem linken Ohr präsentiert wurde. Dies ist ein deutlicher Hinweis für eine rechtslastige Lateralisierung.
Für die Unterscheidung der Stimulusdauer gab es dagegen keinen signifikanten Unterschied zwischen den Fehlerraten beider Ohren. Somit muss davon ausgegangen werden, dass beide Hemisphären für diese Aufgabe benötigt werden und eine bilaterale Verarbeitung stattfindet. In den Reaktionszeiten konnten in beiden Experimente keine signifikanten Unterschiede gezeigt werden. Die Unterscheidung der Modulationsrichtung wurde dabei von allen Versuchspersonen als einfacher eingestuft als die Unterscheidung der Stimulusdauer, was sich auch in niedrigeren Antwortschnelligkeit und Fehlerraten bei vergleichbaren Schalldruckpegeln zeigte.
In der zweiten Versuchsreihe wurde als Referenzmessung nochmals die Unterscheidung der Modulationsrichtungen von FM-Stimuli durchgeführt. Anschließend wurde die Unterscheidung von „da“ und „ga“ untersucht. Diese CV-Silben differieren ausschließlich in der FM-Komponente. Die Untercheidung von CV-Silben ohne Unterschied in der FM-Komponente wurde mittels „ta“ und „ka“ getestet. Für alle drei Experimente zeigte sich, dass ein geringerer Schalldruckpegel des FM- oder CV-Stimulus zu einer steigenden Fehlerrate führte. Unter Anwendung des 15 %-Kriteriums zeigte sich für die Unterscheidung der Modulationsrichtung ein Trend zu niedrigeren Fehlerraten bei der Präsentation des FM-Stimulus auf dem linken im Vergleich mit dem rechten Ohr. In den Reaktionszeiten konnten keine signifikanten Unterschiede gezeigt werden.
Für die Unterscheidung von „da“ und „ga“ ließ sich unter Anwendung des 15 %-Kriteriums in den Fehlerraten und Reaktionszeiten kein Vorteil eines Ohres nachweisen. Dagegen zeigten sich klare Unterschiede bei einzelnen Versuchspersonen. So waren die Fehlerraten für Versuchspersonen, die vorwiegend „da“ erkannt bzw. gehört hatten signifikant höher, wenn der CV-Stimulus auf dem rechten Ohr präsentiert wurde, für „ga“-Hörer war das Gegenteil der Fall. In den Reaktionszeiten konnte kein signifikanter Zusammenhang nachgewiesen werden. Somit ließ sich zeigen, dass je nach Strategie der Versuchsperson bzw. deren individueller Wahrnehmung der CV-Silben, Unterschiede in der Lateralisierung erreicht werden können.
Für die Unterscheidung von „ta“ und „ka“ zeigten sich unter Anwendung des 15 %-Kriteriums signifikant niedrigere Fehlerraten und Reaktionszeiten, wenn der CV-Stimulus auf dem linken Ohr präsentiert wurde. Dies weist deutlich auf eine rechtslastige Lateralisierung hin. Vergleicht man alle drei Experimente ließ sich zudem zeigen, dass die Unterscheidung der Modulationsrichtung einfacher war als die Unterscheidung verschiedener CV-Stimuli. Dabei war die Unterscheidung von „da“ und „ga“ für die Versuchspersonen schwieriger als die Unterscheidung von „ta“ und „ka“. Allerdings konnte in den Lateralisierungsdaten kein direkter Zusammenhang zwischen den FM- und „da“-/„ga“-Stimuli gezeigt werden.
Zusammenfassend konnte in allen fünf Experimenten eine verschieden stark lateralisierte Verarbeitung von akustischen Stimuli bei gleichzeitigem kontralateralen Rauschen gezeigt werden. Der Vorteil eines Ohres (bzw. einer Hemisphäre) war sowohl von der Aufgabe als auch vom Stimulustyp abhängig. Dabei gab es zum Teil starke Unterschiede in der Effektstärke und dem Grad der Lateralisierung zwischen den einzelnen Versuchspersonen. Insgesamt konnte gezeigt werden, dass sich die hier angewendete psychophysische Methode gut eignet, um Ergebnisse zur Lateralisierung von akustischen Stimuli zu gewinnen und somit die Verhaltensrelevanz von Ergebnissen aus Studien mit bildgebenden Verfahren zu überprüfen.
Cardiovascular diseases are still regarded as the main cause of death in the modern world. However, the generic term "cardiovascular diseases" is not uniformly defined. It essentially describes diseases of the cardiovascular system and includes diseases such as hypertension, arteriosclerosis, myocardial infarctions, heart failure, coronary heart diseases, rheumatic heart diseases and heart valve defects. In addition to the well-known risk factors such as obesity, smoking, hypercholesterolemia and lack of exercise, age is a further risk factor that plays an important role in the development of cardiovascular diseases. As the modern societies age; this becomes an increasing problem.
But why does the prevalence of cardiovascular diseases increase with age? In gen-eral, age-dependent changes at the cellular level are assumed to be responsible for the pathological changes in the cardiac and vascular tissues. Important mechanisms such as autophagy, oxidative stress, mitochondrial dysfunctions, genomic instability, cellular senescence and disturbances in signaling pathways of growth factors play a decisive role. In old age, myocardial hypertrophy occurs, which results in cardiac wall thickening and an altered geometry of the ventricle. Chronic inflammations, paracrine and age-dependent cell-intrinsic factors further lead to activation of cardiac fibro-blasts with increase cell proliferation, collagen secretion and matrix cross-linking. The consequences are interstitial and perivascular fibrosis, which stiffen the heart and blood vessels. Oxidative stress and inflammations additionally attack the blood ves-sels and impair endothelial function, which is further aggravated by possible pre-existing conditions such as diabetes mellitus and hypertension.
In the past decades, the main focus has therefore been on researching these age-dependent changes in the hope of better understanding cardiovascular ageing and developing possible regenerative interventions. By studying the repair mechanisms of other organs such as the lungs and the bone marrow, the endothelium in particular showed a high regenerative capacity, which influences the proliferation and cell func-tion of the surrounding cells.
For a long time, the general opinion was that the endothelium is only the internal lin-ing of blood and lymphatic vessels, as well as the heart chambers, which as a single-layer barrier guarantees the integrity of the blood vessels. However, endothelial cells are very heterogeneous, depending on the type of blood vessel and the type of tis-sue they serve. In addition to their barrier function, endothelial cells also regulate the exchange of substances between blood and tissue, stimulate the formation of new blood vessels and re-model existing vascular networks. They are also able to re-structure the extracellular matrix that surrounds them. They release not only matrix proteins, but also cytokines and growth factors into the extracellular space. On de-mand, these factors are then released and stimulate angiogenesis or cell prolifera-tion. In addition, the secretion of various matrix proteins not only stabilizes the cellu-lar neighborhood, but also regulates various cell functions.
By modelling the endothelial environment - the so-called vascular niche - endothelial cells are able to communicate with the surrounding cells. As a result, a regenerative effect of the vascular niche has already been described in various organs. In the liv-er, for example, it has been shown that increased concentrations of endothelial Ang2 and decreased endothelial activin A after partial hepatectomy stimulate the prolifera-tion of hepatocytes and thus liver regeneration. In the bone marrow, endothelial cells mobilize stem cells via nitric oxide and in the lungs, endothelial MMP14 releases growth factors from the extracellular matrix, which stimulate epithelial cell prolifera-tion after partial pneumectomy. Whether such a regenerative effect of the vascular niche also plays a role in the heart is largely unknown.
Since both the regenerative capacity of the heart and endothelial function decrease with age, the aim of this dissertation was to investigate the role of the vascular niche and endothelial cell communication in the aged heart. Human cell lines as well as mouse and artificial rat models were used for these investigations. Since this thesis is a cumulative dissertation with partially published papers, it is divided into three parts.
In the first part of this thesis, the transcriptional signature of secretory genes in the aged cardiac endothelium was studied. Perfused endothelial cells from hearts of young (12-week-old animals) and old mice (20-month-old animals) were isolated and used for bulk RNA sequencing. The two matrix proteins laminin β1 and β2 were among the top-regulated genes. While laminin β2 was particularly expressed in the young cardiac endothelium, laminin β1 was predominantly found in the old endotheli-um. This change in laminin expression was confirmed histologically at protein level and its autocrine function was investigated in vitro. To mimic the in vivo situation in vitro, cell culture dishes were coated with human recombinant laminin 421 or laminin 411 and sutured with human endothelial cells from the umbilical vein (HUVEC). Di-verse functional investigations showed that endothelial cells migrated and adhered poorly in the presence of laminin 411, while in Matrigel tube formation assays HU-VEC formed reduced endothelial networks when cultured on LM 411.
...
Die klimatische Nische beschreibt die klimatischen Bedingungen, unter denen eine Art eine stabile Population aufrechterhalten kann. Die Quantifizierung von Klimanischen ist ein wichtiges Werkzeug, um tiefergehende Einsichten in individuelle Art-Umwelt Beziehungen zu erlangen, um den Effekt des Klimawandels effektiv zu bewerten, und um Arten- und Naturschutz zu unterstützen. Ein makroökologischer Ansatz ist von Vorteil um Ökosysteme über ein breites taxonomisches, geographisches und zeitliches Spektrum zu untersuchen, und damit die klimatischen Nischen vieler Arten auf eine konsistente Art und Weise zu quantifizieren und vergleichen.
Im Kontext des aktuellen Klimawandels ist es wichtig zu verstehen, ob Arten in der Lage sind ihre Klima-nische anzupassen. Viele bisherige Vorhersagen über klimawandelbedingte Veränderungen von Artverbreitungen beruhen auf der Annahme, dass die klimatische Nische einer Art konstant ist. Allerdings ist bekannt, dass Arten ihre klimatischen Präferenzen auf unterschiedlichen Zeitskalen verändern - sowohl über kurze (ökologische) als auch evolutionäre Zeiträume. Dies ist ein wichtiger, aber oft missachteter Faktor für die Nischenquantifizierung. Ein gutes Beispiel für solche ökologische Dynamiken sind Zugvögel, die etwa 20% aller Vogelarten ausmachen. Sie stellen eine interessante, aber auch herausfordernde Artengruppe für die Untersuchung klimatischer Nischen dar. Des Weiteren ist es wichtig klimatische Nischen über evolutionäre Zeiträume zu untersuchen, um die Prozesse zu verstehen, die Evolution, Diversifikation und Extinktion unterliegen, da sich Klimanischen mit der Anpassung einzelner Arten an neue klimatische Gegebenheiten ebenfalls wandeln. Bislang hat ein Mangel an geographisch expliziten Daten über terrestrische Umwelt-bedingungen durch evolutionäre Zeiträume eine explizite Überprüfung dieser Zusammenhänge verhindert.
Das übergeordnete Ziel dieser Dissertation war es, die ökologische (d.h. saisonale) und evolutionäre Dynamik klimatischer Nischen von Vögeln zu untersuchen. Dazu wurde ein Ansatz gewählt der makroökologische, und evolutionsbiologische Methoden vereint, um ein breites taxonomisches und zeitliches Spektrum abzudecken. Das erste Kapitel bearbeitet die Frage wie klimatische Nischen am besten zu quantifizieren sind, wenn man die Dynamik des Vogelzuges in Betracht zieht. Dazu wurde eine Datenbank erstellt, die das Zugverhalten aller 10.443 lebenden Vogelarten katalogisiert. Des Weiteren wurde eine Übersicht über die Methoden zur Quantifizierung klimatischer Nischen in der makroökologischen Literatur erstellt. Das Ergebnis derselben ist, dass die überwiegende Mehrzahl der Veröffentlichungen saisonalen Zugbewegungen nicht ausreichend berücksichtigt. Zuletzt habe ich anhand der Avifauna Australiens die Vor- und Nachteile der Verwendung von Verbreitungskarten gegenüber Punktverbreitungsdaten zur Erfassung saisonaler geographischer Muster der Artenvielfalt bewertet. Damit bietet dieses Kapitel Rahmenempfehlungen für die Datenanforderungen und Methoden, die je nach Zugverhalten einer Art, und dem geographischen, bzw. zeitlichen Fokus einer Studie für eine optimale Nischenquantifizierung notwendig sind.
Im zweiten Kapitel untersuchte ich die saisonale Dynamik klimatischer Nischen von Zugvögeln. Dabei überprüfte ich die Hypothese, dass Zugvögel in ihrem Jahreszyklus durch die Zugbewegung eine gewisse Klimanische verfolgen. Zu diesem Zweck habe ich mit Brut- und Überwinterungsarealkarten saisonale Klima-nischen für 437 Zug- und Standvogelarten aus acht Kladen der Sperlingsvögel (Passeriformes) charakterisiert. Mit Ordinationsmethoden wurde dann der innerartliche saisonale Nischenüberlapp quantifiziert. Der Beweis für die Verfolgung einer klimatischen Nische in einer Art war von mehreren Faktoren, z.B. der geographischen Verortung des Brutareals und der Zugrichtung, abhängig. Dies lässt darauf schließen, dass sich die Ursachen für den Vogelzug sowohl geographisch als auch saisonal (d.h. abhängig von der Zugrichtung) unterscheiden.
Im dritten Kapitel untersuchte ich die evolutionäre Dynamik klimatischer Nischen in Steinschmätzern (Gattung Oenanthe), um explizit zu untersuchen ob es einen Zusammenhang zwischen den Raten klimatischer Nischen-evolution und den Veränderungen paläoklimatischer Bedingungen gibt. Methoden der Klimanischen-quantifizierung wurden mit datierten molekularen Phylogenien verknüpft, um die Raten klimatischer Nischen-evolution mit einem variablen Ratenmodell abzuschätzen. Paläoklimatische Umweltbedingungen wurden mit paläobiologischen Methoden aus dem Fossilbericht altweltlicher Säugetiere der vergangenen 20 Millionen Jahre erschlossen. Die Fallstudie konnte keinen Zusammenhang zwischen Nischenevolution und Umwelt-bedingungen feststellen. Dies legt nahe, dass Vögel als überaus mobile Organismen, auf Klimaveränderungen eher durch Arealverschiebungen reagieren, als durch eine Anpassung ihrer klimatischen Nische. Die Klimanischen der Steinschmätzer waren allerdings an sich nicht statisch, so dass andere Faktoren wie z.B. biologische Wechselbeziehungen für die Nischenevolution dieser Gattung verantwortlich sein müssen.
Meine Dissertation beleuchtet die zentrale Bedeutung zeitlicher Dynamiken für den Nischenraum, den Arten über ökologische (d.h. saisonale) und evolutionäre Zeiträume einnehmen. Aus ihr ergeben sich methodische Konsequenzen für zukünftige Studien klimatischer Nischen. Der Befund, dass die klimatischen Nischen von Zugvögeln nicht saisonal konstant sind, zeigt dass es für mobile Kladen wie Vögel notwendig ist die klimatischen Bedingungen über den gesamten Jahreszyklus und das gesamte Verbreitungsgebiet in Betracht zu nehmen, um die jeweiligen klimatischen Nischen voll charakterisieren zu können.
Über diese methodischen Innovationen hinaus, hat meine Arbeit auch wichtige theoretische und praktische Schlussfolgerungen produziert. Zum einen zeigt die Betrachtung saisonaler Klimanischen, dass Zugvögel entgegen gängiger Annahmen nicht denselben Umweltbedingungen in ihren Brut- und Überwinterungsarealen ausgesetzt sind. Zum anderen zeigt meine Betrachtung von Klimanischen über evolutionäre Zeiträume, dass die Nischenevolution nicht von klimatischen Bedingungen angetrieben wird. Zusammengenommen zeigen diese Ergebnisse auf unterschiedlichen Zeitskalen, dass das Klima nicht der alleinige Faktor ist, der die Artverbreitung von Vögeln bestimmt. Während dieser Befund Raum für Optimismus schafft, was die Auswirkungen des aktuellen Klimawandels auf Vögel angeht, zeigt er auch auf, dass Faktoren wie wechselseitige Artbeziehungen und das Mobilitätspotential von Arten einen wichtigen Einfluss auf Artverbreitungen ausüben. Diese Faktoren könnten jedoch an sich vom Klimawandel beeinflusst sein, und Untersuchungen dieses Zusammenspiels zwischen Klima und anderen Faktoren und die daraus resultierenden Einflüsse auf Artareale bieten ein vielversprechendes Arbeitsfeld für zukünftige Studien.
Light is one of the most important abiotic factors for plant physiological processes. In addition to light intensity, the spectral quality of light can also influence the plant morphology and the content of secondary metabolites. In the horticultural industry, artificial light is used in to enable year-round production of herbs, ornamental plants and vegetables in winter terms.
Until today, discharge lamps like high-pressure sodium (HPS) lamps, emitting predominantly orange and red light and high amounts of infrared radiation, are the most common lamp systems in greenhouses. In the last decades, light-emitting diodes (LEDs) emerged as an efficient alternative light source. LEDs have the advantage of distinct adjustments to the light spectrum. For a usage in horticultural industry LEDs are often too expensive. Furthermore, reduced plant growth can occur due to incorrectly adjusted light spectra and lower leaf temperatures caused by the lack of infrared radiation.
In a research project (LOEWE, funding no. 487/15-29) funded by the Hessen State Ministry of Higher Education, Research and Arts, Microwave plasma lamps (MPL) were tested as new light sources for horticultural industry and plant research. The electrodeless lamp systems emit light in similar properties like sun light. The aim of the study was to determine the influence of artificial sunlight of the MPL on the accumulation of secondary metabolites, plant architecture and plant physiology of three different species (coleus, basil and potted roses). The MPL was compared with other light systems such as commercial HPS lamps, LEDs or ceramic metal halide lamps (CDM). In addition to morphological parameters such as plant height, internode length or fresh and dry weight, the phenolic content of leaves grown under the respective light sources were examined.
Overall an increased far-red light content in the emission spectra of the MPL showed high influence on the plant architecture which was observed in all three plant species. Artificial sunlight from MPL induced stem elongation in coleus and basil plants, compared to the other tested light sources. In potted roses a reduced branching degree was observed under MPL light compared to HPS grown plants.
In addition to the impact of far-red light also the blue light content of the emission spectra was found to be a strong influencing factor for plant physiological processes. A positive correlation between blue light content and leaf thickness was determined in coleus cultivated under MPL, LED, HPS and CDM lamps. Low blue light content in HPS emission spectra resulted in shade-adapted leaves with low photosynthetic capacity and susceptibility to high irradiances. Blue light was assumed to increase phenolic metabolites in basil and rose leaves. Furthermore, the different light treatments resulted in an alteration of the composition of essential oils of basil.
Experiments with coleus plants demonstrated that besides light color also the infrared radiation, had an influence on secondary metabolites by causing different leaf temperatures. Coleus plants grown with MPL showed the lowest content of phenolic compounds such as rosmarinic acid per dry weight. Infrared radiation resulted in a faster plant development indicated by increased biomass production and higher leaf formation rate as observed in coleus and basil plants.
The results obtained in this study show that the influence of leaf temperature should always be considered when comparing different lamp systems. Especially when LEDs are compared to discharge lamps an overestimation of light color can be a consequence since also infrared radiation influences the content of phenolic compounds and plant growth.
The early-diverging oomycetes contain a large number of holocarpic obligate parasites of diatoms, algae, aquatic phycomycetes, and invertebrate animals. These organisms are diverse and widespread. However, taxonomic placement most of the early-diverging oomycetes remains provisional and unresolved, since many have not been sequenced and studied for molecular phylogeny. Here, we report the taxonomy and phylogeny of several holocarpic oomycetes that we have rediscovered and newly classified, including several new species combinations. Phylogenetic reconstructions revealed that the type species of genus Ectrogella (E. bacillariacearum) is a member of the early-diverging Saprolegniales, while the type species of Olpidiopsis (O. saprolegniae) and Pontisma (P. lagenidioides) grouped within the early-diverging lineage of oomycetes forming distinct clades. Since the monophyletic red-algae parasitoids are unrelated to the Olpidiopsis, these were reclassified to the genus Pontisma, while genus Diatomophthora was introduced to accommodate all the diatom parasitoids that were previously assigned to Olpidiopsis. In addition, four new oomycete parasitoids, Miracula helgolandica, Miracula moenusica, Diatomophthora drebesii and Olpidiopsis parthenogenetica and a single rediscovered species, Diatomophthora gillii, are also classified here, including eight new species combinations of red-algae parasites (Pontisma bostrychiae, P. heterosiphoniae, P. muelleri, P. palmariae, P. porphyrae, P. pyropiae) and diatom parasitoids (Diatomophthora drebesii, D. gillii). The results obtained in this study have further improved the resolution and expanded the knowledge on the phylogeny of the earlydiverging oomycetes, leading to the establishment of three new orders (Miraculales, Diatomophthorales, Pontismatales) and one order (Anisolpidiales) being reintroduced.
Alternative splicing (AS) is a co- or post-transcriptional process by which one gene gives rise to multiple isoforms. This ‘split and combine’ step multiplies eukaryotic proteome diversity several fold and is implicated in several diseases given its pervasive impact. Control of alternative splicing is brought about by cis-regulatory elements, such as RNA sequence and structure, which recruit trans-acting RNA-binding proteins (RBPs). Although several of these interactions are already described in detail, we lack a comprehensive understanding of the regulatory code that underlies a splicing decision.
Here, we have established a high-throughput screen to comprehensively identify and characterise cis-regulatory elements that control a specific splicing decision. A cancer-relevant splicing event in proto-oncogene RON was picked as a minigene prototype for initialising the screening approach. Then, we transfected a library of thousands of randomly mutagenised minigene variants as a pool into human cells, and subsequently quantified the spliced isoforms by RNA sequencing. Importantly, we used a barcode sequence to tag the minigene variants and thereby linked mutations to their corresponding spliced products. By using a linear regression-based modelling approach, we were able to determine the effects of single mutations on RON AS. In total, more than 700 mutations were found to significantly affect the splicing regulation of the RON alternative exon. In addition, mutation effects quantified from the screening approach correlate with RON alternative splicing in cancer patients. We discovered numerous previously unknown cis-regulatory elements in both introns and exons, and found that the RBP heterogeneous nuclear ribonucleoprotein H (HNRNPH) extensively regulates RON AS at multiple levels in both cell lines and cancer. Furthermore, the large number of RBPs involved in the process, point to a complex splicing regulatory network involved in the control of RON splicing. iCLIP and synergy analysis between mutations and HNRNPH knockdown data pinpointed the most relevant HNRNPH binding sites across RON. Finally, cooperative HNRNPH binding was shown to mediate a splicing switch of RON alternative exon. In summary, our results provide an unprecedented view on the complexity of splicing regulation of an alternative exon. The novel screening approach introduces a tool to study the relationship of RNA sequence variants along with trans-acting regulators to their impact on the splicing outcome, offering insights on alternative splicing regulation and the relevance of mutations in human disease.
Die Rheumatoide Arthritis (RA) ist die häufigste chronisch-entzündliche Gelenkerkrankung, die inadäquat therapiert zu Gelenkzerstörung und resultierender Invalidität führen kann. Genetische Risikofaktoren sowie Lebensstileinflüsse führen in präklinischen Erkrankungsstadien zu posttranslationalen Modifikationen körpereigener Strukturen, die die immunologische Selbst-Toleranz brechen und zur immunologischen Fehlerkennung von Gelenkstrukturen durch B- und T-Lymphozyten führen.
Das Ziel der hier vorliegenden Arbeit war die Aufklärung von Wirkmechanismen eines für die immunmodulatorische Therapie der RA entwickelten innovativen Ansatzes zur Rekonstitution der immunologischen Autotoleranz mittels rekombinant hergestellter MHC-Klasse-II/Peptidkomplexe durch Induktion regulatorischer T-Zellen. Im Mittelpunkt der in vitro Studien steht hierbei eine über Speziesbarrieren hinweg evolutionär konservierte, von T-Lymphozyten auf dem Kollagen Typ-II (CII) erkannte, durch Glykosylierung posttranslational modifizierte, autoantigene Strukturdeterminante. Dieses T-Zellepitop (CII-Peptid) stellt sowohl in der humanen RA als auch in der murinen Experimentalerkrankung der CIA (Collagen induced arthritis) eine immunodominante Struktur der arthritogenen Autoimmunität dar. Für die modellhaften in vitro Studien zur Aufklärung der Wirkweise rekombinanter MHC-II/Peptidkomplexe auf humane T-Zellen, standen über eine Kooperation mit Prof. Rikard Holmdahl (Karolinska Institut, Stockholm) T-Zell-Hydridome mit transgener Expression des humanen MHC-II/Moleküls DR4 (DRA1/DRB1*04:01) mit unterschiedlicher Epitopspezifität (T-Zell-Hybridom 3H8, Spezifität: unmodifiziertes CII-Peptid und mDR1.1, Spezifität: galaktosyliertes CII-Peptid an Position K264) zur Verfügung. Das aus einer α- und β-Kette bestehende MHC-II/Molekül DR4 ist durch das DRA1-Gen und allelische Varianten des DRB1-Locus (stärkste RA-Assoziation: DRB1*04:01) kodiert und bildet die Form seiner Bindungstasche für die Präsentation antigener Peptide an den T-Zell-Rezeptor (TCR) auf der Oberfläche antigenpräsentierender Zellen (APC). In den Studien zur Stimulation der Hybridomzellen konnte gezeigt werden, dass die T-Zellstimulation und die daraus resultierende Zytokinausschüttung (IL-2 und IL-10) kontextabhängig ist. Je nach Stimulationsart, ob festphasengebunden- oder löslich, erfolgt die Stimulusperzeption über differente TCR-Anordnungen in Mikrodomänen der Zelloberfläche und resultiert in entsprechend modulierten Signalstärken. So führt die Zellaktivierung über die festphasengebundene Stimulation mittels MHC-II/Peptidkomplexen zur Ausbildung einer hohen TCR-Dichte, die über hohe Signalstärken zu einer spezifischen IL-2 Sekretion als Antwort führen. Die Stimulation mit monomeren DR4/CII-Peptidkomplexen in gelöster Form adressiert dagegen die auf der gesamten Zelloberfläche verteilten T-Zell-Rezeptoren, was in einer geringeren Aktivierungsdichte und einer attenuierten Gesamtsignalstärke sowie der Sekretion des immunsupressiv wirkenden IL-10 resultiert. Für den angestrebten pharmakologischen Einsatz der DR4/CII-Peptidkomplexe ist bedeutsam, dass die aktivierende TCR-Bindung der gelösten monomeren Komplexe nur partiell agonistisch wirkt und die Induktion immunregulatorischer IL-10 Zytokinantworten begünstigt. Neben der direkten T-Zellinteraktion konnte auch die Möglichkeit einer indirekten Aktivierung unter Vermittlung von APCs nach Endozytose der DR4/CII-Peptidkomplexe, ihrer lysosomalen Prozessierung und Präsentation auf endogenen neusynthetisierten DR4/Molekülen experimentell u.a. unter Verwendung der HLA-DR4- exprimierenden murinen Makrophagenlinie BL25 als APC-Modell belegt werden. Im Hinblick auf die intendierte Weiterentwicklung zu therapeutischen Anwendungen der MHC-II/CII-Peptidkomplexe unter Gesichtspunkten der Arzneimittelsicherheit ist wichtig, dass der aufgezeigte indirekte Weg der T-Zellaktivierung nach vorausgehender Prozessierung durch APCs ineffizient ist. Dieser Weg erfordert nämlich sehr hohe Konzentrationen an MHC-II/Peptidkomplexen, welche weit oberhalb der in tierexperimentellen Studien unter therapeutisch wirksamen Dosierungen erreichten Gewebespiegel liegen.
Darüber hinaus ist es uns gelungen, methodisch den Nachweis CII-spezifischer T-Zellen, die im Gesamtrepertoire der CD4+ T-Zellen im peripheren Blut von RA-Patienten (HLA-DRB1*04:01) nur in sehr niedriger Frequenz vorkommen, mittels T-Zellaktivierung und spezifischer Tetramerbindung als phänotypischen Marker zu verbessern. Für die Tetramerbindung wurden Monomere mit dem galaktosylierten CII-Peptid (CIIgal259-273) beladenen DR4/Moleküle über einen aminoterminal konjugierten Biotinrest mittels eines Fluorochromgekoppelten Streptavidins tetramerisiert. Unter Einsatz dieser Methoden ist es gelungen, aus den durchflusszytometrisch sortierten CII-spezifischen Zellen, mittels Nukleotidsequenzierung, ihr TCR-Repertoire zu analysieren und hinsichtlich präferentieller V-Genverwendung zu charakterisieren. Für zwei humane DR4-restringiert gal264CII-spezifische T-Zell-Rezeptoren aus RA-Patienten konnte die Funktionalität und Epitopspezifität durch rekombinante Expression demonstriert werden. Auf Basis der gemeinsamen Vorarbeiten mit Prof. Rikard Holmdahl im murinen CIA-Modell und den bekannten Daten zur Induktion regulatorischer T-Zellen (Tr1-Zellen) durch MHC-II/CII-Peptidkomplexe, wurden in vitro Differenzierungsexperimente an humanen PBMCs DR4-positiver RA-Patienten unter dem Einfluss von DR4/gal264CII-Peptidkomplexen durchgeführt. Die Studien belegen, dass die Komplexe mit den antigenspezifischen T-Zellen interagieren und zur Induktion von Markern eines Tr1-Phänotyps, darunter PD-1 und IL-10 führen. Zukünftige Kristallstrukturanalysen eines TCR/DR4/gal264CII-Komplexes sollen dem verbesserten molekularen Verständnis der TCR-Erkennung von CII als Autoantigen insbesondere bzgl. des flexibleren Galaktoserestes für Arthritogenität und Tolerogenität dienen. Fernziel ist die Entwicklung einer wirksamen und sicheren immunmodulatorischen Therapie der RA durch Induktion regulatorischer T-Zellen.
The existence of all living organisms depends on their multidimensional adjustment to the conditions of the environment in which they live. Organisms must constantly deal with not only abiotic stress factors (such as water availability or extreme temperatures), but also with various biotic interactions (the competition between different organisms, both intraspecific and interspecies). When there is a consensus between an organism and the environment it means that this organism is well adjusted and increases its probability of survival.
Symbiotic organisms possess the ability to establish an intimate interaction with another species (symbiont) that provides benefits for survival. Organisms that are involved in obligate symbiosis may adapt to a new environment by switching to another symbiotic partner that is locally better adapted; or by reshuffling symbiont communities present in the holobiont. This ability potentially gives them the opportunity to flexibly react to changing environmental conditions.
In this thesis I studied the genetic diversity and geographic distribution of symbiont lineages in a lichen symbiosis to better understand environmental adaptation in symbiotic systems. Lichens are symbiotic associations of photobionts (one or several green-algal species or cyanobacteria), filamentous mycobionts (lichen-forming fungi) and co-inhabiting symbiotic microorganisms (lichen-associated bacteria, endolichenic fungi, and basidiomycete yeast). The coccoid green algae of the genus Trebouxia are the most common and the most studied lichen photobionts. However, the lack of formal Trebouxia taxonomy impedes our understanding of this photobiont diversity.
Different species of mycobionts may share the same photobionts and a single species of mycobiont may associate with multiple, genetically different photobionts. Interactions among symbionts are not random and are constrained by evolutionary and environmental processes. The ability to associate with specific symbiotic partner is considered as a lichen strategy to facilitate adaptation to the constantly changing environments.
The objectives of this thesis were to 1. Elucidate the intraspecific diversity of fungal and algal symbionts in the lichen Umbilicaria pustulata, given a range-wide (Europe-wide) sampling; 2. Evaluate species delimitation in trebouxioid photobionts based on molecular data, and 3. Quantify the climatic niches of photobiont lineages within U. pustulata, to establish whether the association with particular photobionts may modify the range and ecological niche of this lichen.
The main findings of this thesis are:
1. The genetic diversity within trebouxoid photobiont of U. pustulata is higher than within the mycobiont. The most variable photobiont loci are nrITS rDNA, psbJ-L, and COX2. RbcL is the least variable photobiont locus. The most variable mycobiont loci are MCM7 and TSR1. This study shows a lack of genetic variability in the mycobiont loci EF1, nrITS rDNA, RPB1, and RPB2.
2. U. pustulata shows a low level of selectivity and is associated with numerous (most likely six) putative algal species. All photobiont haplotypes found in U. pustulata are shared between other lichen-forming fungi species, showing different patterns of species-to-species and species-to-community interactions.
3. The geographic distribution of U. pustulata symbionts associations is strongly connected to changes in the climatic niches. The mycobiont-photobiont interactions change along latitudinal temperature gradients (cold-adapted hotspot) and in Mediterranean climate zones (warm-adapted hotspot). U. pustulata broadens its distribution range by switching between photobionts that posses specific environmental preferences.
Overall, this thesis contributes to the understanding of the symbiont diversity, fungal-algal association patterns and local adaptation linked to symbiont-mediated niche expansion in lichens. While identifying intraspecific diversity of both lichen symbionts is a key predisposition to understand symbiont interactions, population dynamics or co-evolution, my comparative study of the sequence-based molecular markers is relevant to reveal cryptic diversity in other lichen-forming fungi and their photobionts.
The determination of species boundaries in lichen symbionts is essential for the study of selectivity and specificity, co-distribution, and co-evolution. Whereas the phylogenetic relationships of Trebouxiophyceae are poorly understood, the application of a novel multifaceted approach based on phylogenetic relationships, coalescence methods and morphological traits presented in this thesis is a promising tool to address species boundaries within this heterogeneous genus.
This thesis provides evidence for symbiont-mediated niche expansion in lichens and highlights the preferential photobiont association from a niche-modeling perspective. My results shed light on symbiont polymorphism and partner switching as potential mechanisms of environmental adaptation in the lichen symbiosis. The spatial genetic pattern found in U. pustulata symbionts supports the concept of ecological fitting and is consistent with patterns found in other lichen studies. Results presented here relate also to findings in different symbiotic systems, like reef-building corals, where different latitudinal patterns and symbiont switching has been reported as an adaptive response to severe bleaching events. Furthermore, this study is timely in light of global warming, because the identification of interaction hotspots among symbionts helps to understand how lichens or other symbiotic organisms adjust to the ongoing climate change. This knowledge will, in turn, facilitate the proper conservation of the most vulnerable lichen populations. My doctoral thesis provides a conceptual framework for analyzing symbiont diversity, interaction patterns, and symbiont-mediated niche expansion that could be applied to other types of lichen species as well as other organisms involved in facultative or obligate symbiosis.
Downy mildew of common sage (Salvia officinalis), caused by Peronospora salviae-officinalis, has become a serious problem in sage production worldwide. The causal agent of the disease belongs to the Pe. belbahrii species complex and was described as a species of its own in 2009. Nevertheless, very little is known about its infection biology and epidemiology. The aims of the current study were therefore to unravel the life cycle of this downy mildew and gain deeper insights into the epidemiology of the disease, as well as to clarify the species boundaries in the Pe. belbahrii species complex.
Infection studies showed that temperatures between 15 and 20 °C were most favourable for infection and disease progress. At 5 °C Pe. salviae-officinalis is still able to infect sage plants, but sporulation was only observed at higher temperatures. Furthermore, Pe. salviae-officinalis needs two events of leaf wetness or high humidity, a first one of at least three hours for conidial germination and penetration of the host, and a second one for sporulation. Additionally, contamination of sage seeds by Pe. salviae-officinalis was proven by seed washing and by PCR and DNA sequence comparisons, suggesting that infested seeds might play a major role in the fast spread of sage downy mildew, which is an important finding for phytosanitary or quarantine measures.
A protocol for fluorescence staining and confocal laser scanning microscopy was established and the whole life cycle of Pe. salviae-officinalis was tracked including oospore formation. The method was also used to examine samples of Pe. lamii on Lamium purpureum and Pe. belbahrii on Ocimum basilicum demonstrating the usefulness of this method for studying the infection process of downy mildews in general.
Peronospora species parasitizing S. sclarea, S. pratensis, O. basilicum, and Plectranthus scutellarioides were studied using light microscopy and molecular phylogenetic analyses based on six loci (ITS rDNA, cox1, cox2, ef1a, hsp90 and β-tubulin). The downy mildew on S. pratensis was shown to be distinct from Pe. salviae-officinalis and closely related to Pe. glechomae, and is herein described as a new taxon, Peronospora salviae-pratensis. The downy mildew on S. sclarea was found to be caused by Peronospora salviae-officinalis. The multi-gene phylogeny revealed that the causal agent of downy mildew on coleus is distinct from Pe. belbahrii on basil, and is herein described as a new taxon, Pe. choii.
Derzeit breiten sich gebietsfremde Stechmücken (Diptera: Culicidae) aufgrund von Globalisierung und Klimawandel auf der ganzen Welt aus und bilden neue, stabile Populationen. Wegen ihrer hämatophagen Ernährungsweise sind sie Überträger von Pathogenen, die teilweise schwere bis tödliche Krankheiten beim Menschen, seinen Haustieren oder auch Wildtieren auslösen können. Mit den Stechmücken treten daher auch Infektionskrankheiten vermehrt in Gebieten auf, in denen sie vorher nicht vorkamen oder als bereits ausgerottet galten. Da die meisten im Menschen wirksamen Pathogene nicht durch Impfungen kontrolliert werden können, bleibt als eine der wenigen Möglichkeit der Krankheitsprävention die Dezimierung der Stechmückenpopulation. Daher sind Stechmücken momentan im Fokus von biologischer und epidemiologischer Forschung. Diese hat zum Ziel epidemische Krankheitsausbrüche vektorübertragener Krankheiten in der menschlichen Population zu verhindern. Eine Verringerung der lokalen Stechmückenpopulation bis hin zum Aussterben kann durch die Verwendung von Insektiziden, die Vernichtung von Bruthabitaten oder anderen Kontrollmaßnahmen erreicht werden. Jedoch sind diese Maßnahmen unterschiedlich effektiv, haben zum Teil unerwünsch-te ökologische und gesundheitsschädigende Folgen und sind unterschiedlich aufwendig und kostenintensiv in der Anwendung. Für die Entwicklung eines integrierten, effektiven, zielgerichteten und kostengünstigen Vektormanagements fehlen bislang jedoch die populationsbiologischen Grundlagen.
Ziel dieser Arbeit ist daher die Schaffung der Datengrundlage eines Integrierten Stechmückenmanagements für die Asiatische Buschmücke (Aedes japonicus japonicus THEOBALD 1901), die am weitesten verbreitete exotische Stechmücke in Deutschland. Schwerpunkte dafür wurden auf das zeitliche und räumliche Vorkommen, die Temperaturabhängigkeit des Lebenszyklus, sowie die Wirksamkeit von Kontrollmethoden gelegt.
Die Kenntnis der räumlichen Verbreitung und saisonalen Häufigkeit der Stechmücken ist notwendig, um befallene Standorte und Zeitpunkte des größten Populationszuwachses definieren zu können. Die Verbreitung und die Häufigkeit der endothermen Stechmücken sind stark von der Umgebungstemperatur abhängig, die beispielsweise deren Entwicklungsdauer und Sterblichkeit beeinflusst. Dabei entwickeln sich die verschiedenen Stadien (Ei, Larven, Puppe, Imago), die eine Stechmücke während ihres Lebens durchläuft, in Abhängigkeit von der Umgebungstemperatur unterschiedlich und haben jeweils andere Temperaturpräferenzen. Lebenszyklustabellen geben die Entwicklungsdauer und Mortalität pro Stadium in Abhängigkeit von der Temperatur an. Mit ihrer Hilfe können somit die räumlichen und zeitlichen Vorkommen und Häufigkeiten einer Stechmückenart berechnet werden. Dies ist insbesondere für Stechmücken in Gebieten mit jahreszeitlichen Temperaturveränderungen wichtig. Um Daten für eine solche Lebenszyklustabelle aufnehmen zu können, ist es notwendig Laborexperimente bei festgelegten Temperaturen durchzuführen. Die Voraussetzung dafür ist, dass die Stechmückenart im Labor optimale Bedingungen erhält, um ihren Lebenszyklus abschließen zu können. In dieser Arbeit wurde daher ein Laborprotokoll entwickelt, mithilfe dessen der Lebenszyklus der Asiatischen Buschmücke im Labor untersucht werden kann. Dazu wurden systematisch die Fütterung, die innerartliche Konkurrenz und das Wasservolumen des Brutge-fäßes für die aquatischen Stadien erprobt. Auf Basis dieses Protokolls wurden anschließend die Temperatureinflüsse auf die Entwicklung aller Stadien aufgenommen. Diese Daten dienten der Parametrisierung eines populationsdynamischen Modells. Dieses wurde verwendet, um Standorte mehrjähriger Populationen zu definieren, saisonale Häufigkeiten für Deutschland zu berechnen, durch Temperaturveränderungen hervorgerufene zukünftige Verbreitungsgebiete vorherzusagen, sowie Effekte von Kontrollmaßnahmen auf die Häufigkeit der Asiatischen Buschmücke zu modellieren.
Um eine dauerhafte Kontrolle der Stechmückenvektoren zu gewährleisten, ist weiterhin die permanente Neuentwicklung von wirksamen Kontrollmethoden notwendig. Dazu gehört die präventive Vermeidung von Bruthabitaten der aquatischen Stadien von Stechmücken. Die exotischen Stechmücken, die in Deutschland etabliert sind, gehören mehrheitlich der Gattung Aedes an und sind sogenannte Gefäßbrüter. Ihre bevorzugten Bruthabitate sind kleine Was-seransammlungen wie sie in Baumhöhlen, Gesteinsauswaschungen, Gießkannen, Regentonnen und Blumenuntersetzern vorkommen. In dieser Arbeit wurde untersucht, welche Farben und Volumina von Plastikbechern die Asiatische Buschmücke zur Eiablage bevorzugt, um präferierte Bruthabitate gezielt zu identifizieren und verringern zu können. Auch die Bereitstellung von Insektiziden wird durch in Stechmücken auftretende Insektizidresistenzen erschwert. Insektizide sollen dabei umweltfreundlich, spezifisch für den Zielorganismus und nicht gesundheitsschädlich für den Menschen sein. Weiterhin sind eine gute Anwendbarkeit, geringe Kosten und eine hohe Effizienz wünschenswert. Eine Quelle für potentielle Insektizide sind pflanzliche Stoffe, zum Beispiel ätherische Öle. Diese sind leicht erhältlich, natürlichen Ursprungs und wirksame Vergrämungsmittel gegen stechbereite Stechmückenweibchen. In dieser Arbeit wurde nach einer Literaturrecherche Nelkenöl ausgewählt und als Insektizid gegen Larven der Asiatischen Buschmücke getestet. Dafür wurden die akute toxische Wirkung von Nelkenöl bei drei Temperaturen untersucht und zusätzlich die Wirkung von Nelkenöl auf die Eiablage im Freiland. Nelkenöl zeigte dabei sowohl eine larvizide als auch eine eiablagehemmende Wirkung. Weiterhin wurde Kupfer in Form von kupferhaltigen Euromünzen als Larvizid untersucht. Kupfer ist ein wirksamer Stoff gegen die aquatischen Stadien von Stechmücken. Allerdings wurde der Stoff noch nicht in Form der einfach zu handhabenden, leicht erhältlichen Kupfermünzen getestet. Dazu wurden Vorexperimente durchgeführt, um herauszufinden, wieviel Kupferionen sich aus den Münzen lösen lassen. Anschließend wurde der akut toxische Effekt auf Larven der Asiatischen Buschmücke untersucht.
Ein Integriertes Stechmückenmanagement hat zum Ziel, die lokale Stechmückenpopulation zu kontrollieren, um so Stichen und daraus resultierender Krankheitsübertragung vorzubeugen. Dies erfolgt über die Aufklärung von Betroffenen, der Überwachung der Stechmückenpopulation, dem Testen auf Pathogenbefall und der direkten Kontrolle von Stechmücken. Diese Arbeit leistet einen Beitrag zu den Kenntnissen über die Laborhaltung einer exotischen Stechmückenart, zur Identifizierung von Bruthabitaten, zur zeitlichen und räumlichen Festlegung von Kontrollmaßnahmen und zur Anwendung von Larviziden und eines Vergrämungsmittels. Mit dieser Arbeit wurde die Grundlage eines faktenbasierten Integrativen Stechmückenmanagements für die Asiatische Buschmücke entwickelt, das eventuell auch auf weitere Aedes-Arten übertragbar ist, und als Handlungsempfehlung für politische Entscheidungstragende dienen kann.
Durch natürliche Selektion werden Funktionen, die dem Überleben und dem Fortpflanzungserfolg eines Organismus dienen, optimiert. Da die Struktur eines Organs dessen Funktion und umgekehrt die Funktion eines Organs dessen Struktur bestimmt, kann durch das Studium der Morphologie die Funktionsweise von Organen verstanden werden. Trotz des umfangreichen Wissens über die Struktur von Nervensystemen sowohl auf mikro- als auch auf makroskopischer Ebene, ist es weiterhin unklar, wie Bewusstsein und ein kohärentes Abbild der Umwelt im Gehirn erzeugt werden. Der Grund hierfür ist vor allem die gewaltige Komplexität neuronaler Netzwerke, die unmöglich geistig erfasst werden können. Eine Möglichkeit, das Gehirn ohne das detaillierte Wissen über all seine Bestandteile zu verstehen, bietet das Studium von Optimierungsprinzipien und deren Anwendung in theoretischen Modellen. So wie eingangs erwähnt die Funktion von Organen durch natürliche Selektion optimiert wird, sollte auch die Funktion neuronaler Netzwerke optimiert werden und neuronale Netzwerke sollten entsprechend solcher Optimierungsprinzipien aufgebaut sein. Ein wichtiges Prinzip, das essenziell für die Effizienz neuronaler Netzwerke ist, ist die Minimierung der Verbindungslänge zwischen Neuronen. Basierend auf diesem Prinzip wurde im Rahmen dieser Dissertation eine algorithmische Methode etabliert, die es ermöglicht Vorhersagen der relativen Position von Neuronen anhand ihrer Verbindungen zu treffen. Diese neuronale Platzierungsmethode beruht darauf, dass Neuronen mit ähnlicher Verbindungsnachbarschaft näher zueinander platziert werden als zu Neuronen mit weniger ähnlichen Verbindungsnachbarn, wodurch die durchschnittliche Verbindungslänge minimiert wird. Nach der Etablierung dieser Methode, wurde diese benutzt um Modelle zu erstellen, die es ermöglichen die Entstehung neuronaler Karten und kortikaler Faltungen im Zusammenhang mit der Konnektivität und der Anzahl der Neuronen zu untersuchen.
Neuronale Karten sind geordnete Muster auf der Oberfläche des Kortex, die durch die präferierte Aktivität einzelner Neuronen in Antwort auf Stimuli einer Modalität beobachtet werden können. Im visuellen Kortex existieren sogar mehrere Karten, je nachdem welche Qualität visueller Stimuli man betrachtet. Abhängig von der Präferenz für einen Sehwinkel, ein stimuliertes Auge oder der Orientierung eines Balken-Stimulus, können retinotopische Karten, Karten mit streifenartigen Mustern oder Karten mit sogenannten „Pinwheel“-Strukturen beobachtet werden. Pinwheels sind periodische Strukturen, die sichtbar werden indem man die Orientierungspräferenz von Neuronen für die spezifische Orientierung eines Balken-Stimulus mit der entsprechenden Farbe des Farbkreises visualisiert. Da diese Strukturen eine Ähnlichkeit mit bunten Windrädern haben, werde sie als Pinwheels bezeichnet. Die in dieser Dissertation erstellten Modelle sagen vorher, dass die Entstehung strukturierter neuronaler Karten im Allgemeinen von der Anzahl der Neuronen abhängt. In der Tat könnte diese Abhängigkeit auch für neuronale Karten im Kortex gelten. Während strukturierte Karten im visuellen Kortex in verschiedenen Säugerordnungen wie Primaten, Karnivoren und Huftieren existieren, sind sie in kleinen Nagern mit weniger Neuronen nicht vorhanden, trotz ähnlicher Verbindungsspezifizität. Folglich müssen Unterschiede in der Struktur neuronaler Karten im Kortex nicht zwangsläufig mit einer unterschiedlichen Funktionsweise zusammenhängen, sondern könnten auch durch allgemeine Optimierungsprinzipien beim Aufbau neuronaler Netzwerke bedingt werden. Eine weitere Gemeinsamkeit zwischen verschiedenen Säugetierordnungen ist, dass die relative Dichte der Pinwheels ziemlich genau bei der Zahl Pi liegt. Entsprechend der Ergebnisse dieser Dissertation könnte dies dadurch erklärt werden, dass für neuronale Karten ähnlicher Struktur die Anzahl der Neuronen pro Pinwheel relativ konstant ist. Unterschiede in der räumlichen Dichte der Pinwheels könnten dann einfach durch Unterschiede in der Dichte der Neuronen erklärt werden.
Neben den Modellen für neuronale Karten wurde im Rahmen dieser Dissertation auch ein Modell kortikaler Faltungen mit derselben neuronalen Platzierungsmethode erstellt. Die Existenz kortikaler Faltungen wird gemeinhin damit erklärt, dass der Kortex ohne Faltungen wegen seiner verhältnismäßig großen Oberfläche nicht in den Schädel gepackt werden könnte. Allerdings haben Experimente gezeigt, dass die Faltungen nicht durch eine Restriktion des wachsenden Kortex an der Schädeloberfläche entstehen, da auch mit mehr Platz für die Expansion des Kortex die gleichen Faltungsmuster exprimiert werden. Interessanterweise entstehen die kortikalen Faltungen erst, wenn die Proliferation der Neuronen während der Entwicklung größtenteils abgeschlossen ist und die Neuronen anfangen ihre Verbindungen auszubilden. Um kortikale Faltungen basierend auf der Konnektivität zwischen Neuronen im Modell vorherzusagen, genügt es das allgemeine Muster einer starken lokalen, aber schwachen globalen Konnektivität zwischen Neuronen nachzubilden. Abhängig von Variationen dieser Konnektivität, der Anzahl der kortikalen Kolumnen und der Neuronenanzahl innerhalb dieser Kolumnen, können im Modell viele Eigenschaften kortikaler Faltungsmuster in Säugetieren vorhergesagt werden. Ähnlich wie in Säugetieren ist der Faltungsgrad der vom Modell vorhergesagt wird von dem Verhältnis zwischen Parametern, die die Größe und Dicke des Kortex beschreiben, abhängig. Dementsprechend werden mehr und mehr Faltungen mit steigender Anzahl der Kolumnen, aber gleicher Anzahl von Neuronen pro Kolumne vorhergesagt. Wie in Säugetieren entstehen dabei auch die größeren primären Faltungen zuerst bevor es innerhalb der größeren Faltungen zu kleineren Faltungen höherer Ordnung kommt. Neben der Abhängigkeit des Faltungsgrads von der Größe des Kortex können Variationen in der Konnektivität erklären, wie es einerseits zu stereotypischen Faltungsmustern kommen kann, aber andererseits auch warum der Faltungsgrad zwischen verschiedenen Säugerordnungen unterschiedlich mit der Größe des Kortex skaliert. Letztlich könnten pathologische Veränderungen der Konnektivität zu den entsprechenden Änderungen im Faltungsmuster führen.
Insgesamt wurde in dieser Arbeit gezeigt, dass mittels einfacher Prinzipien, die die Verbindung zwischen Neuronen und deren relative Position zueinander beschreiben, komplexe neuroanatomische Strukturen vorhergesagt werden können. Da mit derselben Methode zur neuronalen Platzierung sowohl neuronale Karten als auch kortikalen Faltungen, also sehr unterschiedliche Strukturen vorhergesagt werden konnten, stellt sich die Frage, ob diese Strukturen durch einen gemeinsamen biologischen Mechanismus entstehen. Neuronale Zugkräfte sind ein möglicher Mechanismus, der die Entstehung kortikaler Faltungen erklären könnte. Auch wenn es eher unwahrscheinlich ist, dass die Entstehung neuronaler Karten von Zugkräften zwischen Neuronen abhängt, kann es nicht vollständig ausgeschlossen werden. Ob solche Kräfte an der Selbstorganisation neuronaler Netzwerke beteiligt sein könnten, ist eine interessante Fragestellung für zukünftige empirische Studien.
Humans and other primates are highly visual animals. Our daily visual activities such as recognizing familiar faces, interacting with objects, or reading, are supported by an extensive system of interacting brain areas. The interactions between the many individual nerve cells both within and between brain areas need to be coordinated. One possible solution to achieve flexible coordination between cells in the network is rhythmic activity, or oscillations. The focus of the thesis will be activity in the largest visual area, V1, in non-human primates. In V1, high-frequency activity, so-called gamma-band activity (“gamma”, ca. 30-90 Hz) can be frequently observed and has been suggested to play a role in coordinating activity in the visual system. In Chapter 1, the coordination problem, the primate visual system and gamma-band oscillations are introduced in detail. The following chapters explore the dependence of gamma on contextual influences. Does V1 use contextual information to optimize co-ordination? In the first part, the short-term consequences of repeated encounters with visual stimuli on V1 responses are explored (Chapters 2 and 3). Inspired by results from colored, naturalistic images in the first part, the second part tests the dependence of gamma on spatial and chromatic stimulus aspects (Chapters 4 and 5).
Stimulus repetition is a simple yet powerful way to tap into our brains’ ability to learn and adapt to our environment. Repeated presentation of a visual stimulus tends to decrease responses to this stimulus. Is this accompanied by changes in the coordination of brain activity? In Chapter 2, the stimulus-specificity of repetition effects on gamma was tested using naturalistic stimuli. V1 is most typically studied using black-and-white, artificial stimuli that are very familiar to the animals. Here, colored natural images were repeatedly presented that were initially novel to the animals, to provide a wider and more naturalistic range of stimulation. Both multi-unit spiking activity (MUA) and gamma showed stimulus-specific repetition effects. MUA responses de-creased most strongly for initial repetitions and less for later repetitions. In contrast, gamma could increase or decrease for initial repetitions, but tended to increase for later repetitions. This points to the operation of multiple plasticity mechanisms. One process may rapidly decrease MUA and gamma and be related to initial novelty or adaptation. The other increases gamma, is active for more repetitions, and could constitute a form of refinement of coordination over time. Moreover, based on the spacing of stimulus repetitions, stimulus memory in V1 persisted for tens of seconds.
In the following Chapter 3, the stimulus location specificity and persistence of the repetition effects for longer timescales were tested. To this end, the observation that the increase in gamma with repetition was strongest for the first tens of repetitions was used to test for location specificity and memory. Using simple artificial stimuli that were repeated many times at two alternating locations, both location specificity and memory on the order of minutes was observed. Due to the structure of the primate visual system, location specificity suggests that the repetition effects involve early to mid-level visual areas such as V1. Memory for previous stimulus presentations on the order of minutes has not been previously reported for V1 gamma. Taken together, these experiments demonstrate short-term plasticity of gamma that is stimulus- and location specific and persists on the timescale of minutes.
In Chapter 2, the average gamma-band response to the large, naturalistic stimuli was highly stimulus dependent. Relative increases in gamma-band activity scaled between tens and thousands of percent change depending on the stimulus. Particularly the color of the stimuli appeared to play a strong role, although the stimulus set was too limited and uncontrolled to draw strong conclusions. In Chapters 4 and 5, underlying mechanisms for the stimulus specificity of gamma were explored using more well-controlled, artificial stimuli that varied in color and spatial structure.
Much of vision relies on the analysis of spatial structure. Each nerve cell in V1 only responds to visual stimuli in a particular, small part of the visual field, its so-called “receptive field” (RF). Compared to isolated RF stimulation, nearby cells that are stimulated by a similar structure from different parts of visual space can show response decreases, commonly known as “surround suppression”, and may show coordinated activity in the gamma band. In Chapter 3, responses to large, uniformly colored disks are contrasted with responses to black or white (achromatic) disks. A first experiment showed that gamma-band responses were stronger for colored than achromatic stimuli, whereas MUA responses could decrease below baseline for colored stimuli. To test whether these phenomena were related to surround suppression, stimulus size was manipulated in a second experiment. When stimuli were of sufficient size to induce surround suppression, clear gamma-band responses emerged. Surround suppression and gamma were stronger for chromatic stimuli. However, the change of stimulus size could have changed not only surround suppression but also stimulus saliency. Therefore, in a third experiment, the overall size of the stimulus was kept constant, and the spatial structure of the stimulus was manipulated. In comparison to uniform, predictable stimulus structure, mismatches between the center of the stimulus and the surrounding visual space led to strong increases in MUA responses and strong de-creases in gamma-band activity. These effects were restricted to the recording sites with RFs at the mismatch location. These experiments underpin the strong role of both spatial structure and color for gamma in V1.
In Chapter 4, responses to different color hues are studied in more detail. Gamma response strength depended on hue, being strongest for red compared to blue and green stimuli when measured with a gray background. To better understand the underlying mechanisms of the differential responses, the spatio-temporal context in the form of the background color was manipulated. Background color had a strong influence on gamma strength. Using differently colored backgrounds, different parts of the color signaling pathways could be adapted. Response differences to different color hues could be explained well with a model that incorporates differences in adaptation between pathways involving long- compared to medium-wavelength cone signals.
Taken together, these experiments indicate a strong role of both spatial context (stimulus size and structure) and temporal context and drive (repetition, adaptation) for the generation of gamma-band activity in V1. Functional implications of these dependencies are considered in the final Chapter 6, and a role for gamma-band syn-chronization in a coding regime for visual inputs that generate strong drive and high predictability is suggested.
Eine qualitative und quantitative Studie zum Einsatz der virtuellen Mikroskopie in der Schule
(2019)
Das Mikroskop stellt in der Alltagswelt ein Sinnbild für naturwissenschaftliches Arbeiten dar (Coleman 2009, Paulsen 2010). Im Bereich der Lehre eröffnet dieses Laborgerät das Eintauchen in die mikroskopische Dimension und besitzt eine wesentliche Rolle bei der damit verbundenen Erkenntnisgewinnung, insbesondere von funktionsmorphologischen Konzepten (Gropengießer & Kattmann 2008, Kremer 2002). Jedoch wird die Durchführung der klassischen Mikroskopie und damit die aktive Auseinandersetzung mit mikroskopischen Präparaten im schulischen (Biologie-)Unterricht durch verschiedene Faktoren erschwert. Zu den Limitierungen gehören beispielsweise die Verfügbarkeit geeigneter Mikroskope und Dauerpräparate, die aufwendige Vor- und Nachbereitungszeit sowie der zeitliche Aufwand bei der Herstellung hochwertiger mikroskopischer Frischpräparate. Die virtuelle Mikroskopie könnte diese Schwierigkeiten umgehen. Das virtuelle Mikroskop kann als eine Simulation verstanden werden, bei der die bildanalytischen Vorgehensweisen bei mikroskopischen Präparaten analog zur klassischen Mikroskopie nachvollzogen werden können (Gu & Oglivie 2005, Hentschel 2009). Hierbei umfasst das virtuelle Mikroskop ein Akquisitionssystem zum Einscannen und Digitalisieren mikroskopischer Präparate, einen Server zum Speichern und Bereitstellen der entstandenen virtuellen hochauflösenden Aufnahmen (WSI) sowie eine Bildbetrachtungssoftware auf einem Anwendungsrechner (Kalinski et al. 2006). Basierend auf einer Nutzerbefragung wurde eine Betrachtungssoftware programmiert, die hinsicht¬lich ihrer Benutzerfreundlichkeit und ihren Eigenschaften auf den schulischen Einsatz angepasst wurde. Um die Relevanz in diesem Anwendungsfeld zu testen, wurden die Untersuchungen der vorliegenden Arbeit sowohl im Schülerlabor Goethe BioLab als auch in der universitären Lehre der Abteilung für Didaktik der Biowissen¬schaften der Goethe–Universität Frankfurt am Main durchgeführt. Der Schülerlabortag „Blut und das virtuelle Mikroskop“ wurde entwickelt, um die computerbasierte virtuelle Mikroskopie mit Schülern ergänzend zur klassischen Mikroskopie in einem fachlichen Kontext anzuwenden und zu erforschen.
Beruhend auf der Vergleichbarkeit beider Mikroskopiemethoden (Paulsen et al. 2010) lagen die Forschungsschwerpunkte neben der Nutzung der Software durch Schülerinnen und Schülern auf einer gegenüberstellenden Beurteilung beider mikroskopischer Verfahren von Schülern und Lehramtsstudierenden. Es wurden in diesem Zusammenhang drei zentrale Forschungsfragen formuliert.
Die erste Forschungsfrage untersucht das Nutzerverhalten der Schüler (n = 123) bei der virtuellen Mikroskopie mittels automatisch generierter Datensätze während der Anwendung der Bildbetrachtungssoftware. Die Analyse der Anwendungsdaten zeigt, dass das mikroskopische Sehen, insbesondere das Fokussieren auf relevante Bildbereiche, im virtuellen Humanblutausstrich angewandt wurde.
Die zweite Forschungsfrage untersuchte das aktuelle Interesses bei Schülern (n = 293) im direkten Vergleich zwischen virtueller und klassischer Mikroskopie. Dabei wurde das aktuelle Interesse aufgrund des engen Zusammenhangs zum Lernen (vgl. Krapp 1992a) als Indikator der Lernwirksamkeit gewählt. Die Erhebung erfolgte mittels eines Fragebogens. Die Ergebnisse dieser Untersuchung zeigen, dass der Einsatz beider mikroskopischer Verfahren das aktuelle Interesse fördert, das emotionale und das wertbezogene Merkmal sich jedoch zugunsten der klassischen Mikroskopie signifikant unterscheiden.
Im Rahmen der dritten Forschungsfrage erfolgte eine Beurteilung der Vorteile virtueller Mikroskopie gegenüber der klassischen Mikroskopie von Schülern (n = 504) sowie Lehramtsstudierenden (n = 247). Hierbei diente ebenfalls ein Fragebogen als Grundlage der Erhebung. Die Auswertung zeigt, dass sowohl die Schüler als auch die Studierenden die Vorteile der virtuellen Mikroskopie klar erkennen. Es liegen jedoch signifikante Unterschiede zwischen den Versuchsgruppen vor. Die Schüler bewerten die Vorteile betreffend der Förderung von Lernprozessen, des Erkennens von Strukturen und des mikroskopischen Zeichnens höher.
Zusammenfassend bestärken die Ergebnisse dieser Studie die Ansicht, dass das virtuelle Mikroskop nicht als Ersatz, sondern als sinnvolle Ergänzung zu der klassischen Lichtmikroskopie angesehen werden sollte (Bloodgood et al. 2006, Berg et al. 2016, Braun & Kearns 2008, Hufnagl et al. 2012, Mione et al. 2013, Santiago 2018, Scoville & Buskirk 2007). Dabei sollte die vorliegende Arbeit als Einstieg verstanden werden, um bestehende Forschungslücken zu verkleinern, damit ein Transfer der virtuellen Mikroskopie in den schulischen Kontext möglichst lernwirksam erfolgen kann.
Die Neurowissenschaften sind in Forschungsarbeiten für Schüler und Studierende immer wieder als eines der schwierigsten Teilgebiete der Biologie angeführt. Die Inhalte werden überwiegend nicht verstanden. Als mögliche Ursache gelten die seltenen praktischen Zugänge für die Lernenden aufgrund limitierter Ressourcen. Diese Ursache konnte in der vorliegenden Arbeit durch eine Befragung der Lehrkräfte zu ihren Praxisumsetzungen bestätigt werden. 70 % der Lehrkräfte gaben an, dass sie keine Experimente in der Schule zum Thema Nervenzellen anbieten. Experimente zur Verhaltensbiologie führen 65 % der Lehrkräfte nicht durch.
Um Schülern die Möglichkeit zu geben, sich experimentell mit den Themenfeldern der Neuro- und Verhaltensbiologie auseinanderzusetzen, wurden im Rahmen der vorliegenden Arbeit Schülerlabortage auf dem Feld der Neurowissenschaften konzipiert. Die Konzepte wurden schülerorientiert umgesetzt und neurowissenschaftliche Forschung durch den eigenen Umgang mit modernen Forschungsapparaturen erfahrbar gemacht. Die drei Labortage für die Sekundarstufe II wurden wissenschaftlich begleitet: 1) Verhaltensbiologie, 2) systemische Ebene der Elektrophysiologie, 3) elektrophysiologische Forschungsmethoden. Um die Qualität und Wirksamkeit der Labortage beurteilen zu können, wurden sie mit Feedbackerhebungen begleitet. Die drei Labortage wurden sowohl von den Lehrkräften als auch von den Schülern bezüglich ihrer Qualität positiv bewertet. Für die Schüler konnte gezeigt werden, dass die Beurteilung weitgehend unabhängig von einem zugrunde liegenden Interesse an Biologie und Forschung ausfällt. Anhand einer retrospektiven Erhebung wird außerdem gezeigt, dass alle drei Labortage eine höchst signifikante, selbsteingeschätzte Steigerung des „Wissens“, der „Anwendungszuversicht“ und des „Interesses“ bewirken. Schüler mit niedrigen Ausgangswerten zeigen einen besonders hohen Anstieg. Für das Interesse kann weiter gezeigt werden, dass auch Schüler mit hohem Ausgangswert eine große Interessenssteigerung durch den Labortag aufweisen. Das Interesse für den verhaltensbiologischen Labortag liegt etwas niedriger – die Labortage mit elektrophysiologischen Inhalten zeigen dagegen für die Anwendungszuversicht etwas niedrigere Werte.
Der Fokus der fachdidaktischen Forschung lag auf der Betrachtung des experimentellen Zugangs zur Elektrophysiologie über ein entwickeltes „EPhys-Setup“. Dabei handelt es sich um einen quasi-realen Messaufbau. Die Umsetzung kombiniert dazu Komponenten eines realen Elektrophysiologie-Setups (Hands-on Komponenten) mit einer speziell entwickelten schülerfreundlichen Software (Neurosimulation) und einem virtuellen Nervensystem in Form einer Platine. Als Modellnervensystem werden für diese Umsetzung Ganglien von Hirudo medicinalis verwendet – der Neurosimulation liegen originale elektrophysiologische Messspuren des Ganglions zugrunde. Experimentelle Vermittlungsansätze für die Elektrophysiologie finden sich kaum für den Schulbereich. Dem Bedarf einer entsprechenden Beforschung wurde mit verschiedenen Testinstrumenten nachgegangen, um den Vermittlungsansatz mit dem EPhys-Setup bewerten zu können. Dafür fand eine Wirksamkeitsanalyse über die Erhebung der Motivation der Schüler statt (Lab Motivation Scale; Dohn et al. 2016). Von Bedeutung war auch, inwiefern gegenüber der Umsetzung eine Technologieakzeptanz vorliegt (Technology Acceptance Model; Davis 1989), die im Schulkontext ausgehend von der steigenden Einbindung von Technologien einen entsprechenden Forschungsbedarf aufweist. Weiter wurde untersucht, ob sich die Bewertung des EPhys-Setups von der Bewertung einer Kontrollgruppe unterscheidet. Für die Kontrollgruppe wurde die Neurosimulation von den Hands-on Komponenten gelöst und die Schüler arbeiteten ausschließlich PC-basiert. Die Ergebnisse zeigen, dass beide Umsetzungen die Motivation förderten und eine Technologieakzeptanz bei den Schülern aufwiesen. Der Unterschied der Untersuchungsgruppen fällt gering aus. Die Abhängigkeiten, die für die verwendete Simulationsumsetzung gefunden wurden, beziehen sich ausschließlich auf Komponenten der „Freude“. Somit wird der intrinsische Bereich von den Schülern die am EPhys-Setup gearbeitet haben höher bewertet. Zur weiteren Analyse der Testinstrumente wurde auch eine Abhängigkeit der Bewertung vom zugrunde liegenden Biologieinteresse sowie von den Computerfähigkeiten vergleichend betrachtet. Der Einfluss auf die Bewertungen der drei Testskalen ist in vielen Fällen höher als der Einfluss der verwendeten Simulation. Vom individuellen Biologieinteresse der Schüler zeigen alle untersuchten Komponenten eine Abhängigkeit. Die größeren Effekte beziehen sich auf die Komponenten der „Lernwirksamkeit“ oder der „Freude“. Von den individuellen Computerfähigkeiten der Schüler zeigen Komponenten zur „Zuversicht bezüglich der Methoden und der Inhalte“ eine Abhängigkeit.
Die Differenzierung zwischen Teilpopulationen hin zu unterschiedlichen Arten kann nur erfolgen, wenn zwischen diesen Teilpopulationen reproduktive Isolation besteht. Wie die unterschiedlichen Arten von reproduktiver Isolation zusammenwirken und welche Voraussetzungen bestehen müssen, um neue Arten zu bilden, muss in jedem Studiensystem untersucht werden. Ein idealer Ansatzpunkt sind Arten, die sich mehrfach an anspruchsvolle Habitate angepasst haben, deren Artbildung also von ökologischen Habitatparametern bestimmt wird. Dieser Vorgang wird als Ökologische Artbildung bezeichnet. Im Artkomplex Poecilia spec., der im Süden Mexikos mehrere schwefelangepasste Ökotypen ausgebildet hat, wurden erste Hinweise auf eine Korrelation zwischen der Selektionsstärke von natürlicher und sexueller Selektion gefunden, deren Einfluss zusammen die bestehenden reproduktiven Barrieren zwischen Klarwasser- und Schwefelökotyp formen. Wie diese Reproduktionsbarrieren beschaffen sind und wie die Umweltvariable Schwefel auf die Morphologie und das Verhalten der Poeciliiden Einfluss nimmt, wurde in der vorliegenden Arbeit anhand von fünf Fragestellungen untersucht. (1) Die Körperfärbung kann ein aussagekräftiges Signal für die Qualität des potentiellen Partners bei der Fortpflanzung sein. Wie beeinflusst die extreme Umweltvariable Schwefel die Ausbildung von Färbung? (2) Sind die gefundenen Anpassungen der Färbung erblich oder werden sie plastisch entsprechend des Nahrungsangebots ausgebildet? (3) In einem der untersuchten Flusssysteme konnte unvollständige reproduktive Isolation zwischen der Klarwasser- und Schwefelpopulation nachgewiesen werden. Sind in den Mischzonen zwischen diesen beiden Habitaten Hybriden genetisch nachweisbar und bilden diese die Färbungsanpassungen der Klarwasser-, der Schwefelpopulation oder eine intermediäre Form aus? (4) Die Gelbfärbung der Flossen bei Männchen scheint ein geeignetes Merkmal für die Anzeige der Qualität zu sein, da es möglicherweise unabhängig vom Nahrungsangebot ausgebildet wird. Besteht eine weibliche Präferenz für dieses Merkmal? (5) Auch die weibliche Partnerwahlpräferenz wird vom Habitat und dem eigenen Zustand beeinflusst. Wie verändert sich die Präferenz für Männchen mit gutem Ernährungszustand bei Weibchen, die hungrig sind?
Um diese Fragen zu beantworten, wurden in mehreren Jahren Männchen und Weibchen der Arten Poecilia mexicana und Poecilia sulphuraria aus sieben Populationen im Studiengebiet in Südmexiko gefangen und auf ihre Färbung untersucht sowie Laborpopulationen getestet. Es konnten generelle Anpassungen der Färbung an die Umweltvariable Schwefel nachgewiesen werden. Dazu gehören die Aufhellung der Körperregionen, die durch Tarnung (konkret: countershading und background matching) vor Entdeckung durch Prädatoren schützen, und die Reduktion von Gelb- und Rottönen. Diese Anpassung ist vermutlich auf das geringe Angebot an Karotinoiden in den schwefelbelasteten Extremhabitaten zurückzuführen. Außerdem konnten zahlreiche flusssystem¬spezifische Anpassungen beschrieben werden, deren Ursachen in den Unterschieden zwischen den Schwefelhabitaten untereinander begründet sind. Das Flusssystem des Río Tacotalpa stellt hier eine Besonderheit dar, da Männchen eine besonders starke Gelbfärbung der Flossen aufweisen. Wildgefangene und laborgeborene Männchen dieses Flusssystems wurden verglichen, um einen Hinweis auf den Einfluss des Nahrungsangebots auf dieses Merkmal zu untersuchen. Tatsächlich ist die Ausprägung dieses Merkmals, die Gelbfärbung der Flossen, unabhängig vom Angebot an Karotinoiden. Während die hier verwendeten genetischen Analysen nicht geeignet waren, Hybriden aus den Mischzonen zwischen Schwefel- und Klarwasserhabitat nachzuweisen, ergaben die Untersuchungen von Individuen aus den Mischzonen keine eindeutigen Ergebnisse über eine etwaige intermediäre Ausbildung der Färbung. Die Präsentation von Männchen, deren Gelbintensität an den Flossenspitzen künstlich verändert wurde, konnte bei Weibchen keine eindeutige Präferenz für stärker gefärbte Männchen aufzeigen. Vielmehr weist dieses Ergebnis auf eine starke Korrelation zwischen mehreren Merkmalen (z. B. weitere morphologische Merkmale, Verhalten) hin, die für die Beurteilung der männlichen Qualität herangezogen werden. Die weibliche Präferenz für konditionsabhängige Merkmale wird bei schwefelangepassten Weibchen leicht verstärkt, wenn diese hungrig sind. Eine solche flexible Präferenz sollte gerade in Habitaten mit starken Fluktuationen im Nährstoffangebot existieren. Dabei waren Weibchen, denen Videoaufnahmen präsentiert wurden, eher in der Lage, das qualitativ hochwertigere Männchen zu identifizieren, als Weibchen, denen animierte Bilder präsentiert wurden. Auch hier wird davon ausgegangen, dass die Reduktion auf eines oder wenige Merkmale, die für die Partnerwahl zur Verfügung stehen, keine ausreichend starke Reaktion auslösen können. Vielmehr ist der Zugriff auf alle Aspekte der männlichen Erscheinung wichtig, um die Qualität des potentiellen Partners zu beurteilen.
Färbung ist also generell geeignet, den Ökotyp eines Individuums zu bestimmen und ein solches Merkmal kann der Artbestimmung im ersten Schritt der Partnerwahl dienen. Dasjenige männliche Färbungsmerkmal, das über mehrere Generationen gleichbleibend ausgeprägt wurde – die Gelbfärbung der Flossen – reicht jedoch nicht aus, um bei der weiblichen Partnerwahl eine Reaktion auszulösen. Vielmehr deuten die Ergebnisse auf eine enge Korrelation der Färbung mit weiteren Merkmalen in Morphologie und Verhalten eines Individuums hin, die vom wählenden Weibchen stets gemeinsam entsprechend der Multiple-message-Theorie betrachtet werden. Auch der Vergleich zwischen Videoaufnahmen und animierten Fotografien als Stimuli bei der Partnerwahl ergab, dass der Aspekt Verhalten (nur verfügbar mit Videoaufnahmen) für eine Partnerwahlentscheidung von Bedeutung ist.
Meine Arbeit konnte den bestehenden Wissensschatz um die bestehenden reproduktiven Barrieren im Studiensystem um den Aspekt der Färbung erweitern. Meine Ergebnisse zeigen weitere spannende Fragestellungen auf. Je größer das Verständnis der vorliegenden Selektionskräfte und Mechanismen reproduktiver Isolation ist, desto besser kann die Wissenschaft verstehen, welche Umgebungsvariablen welchen Einfluss auf den Prozess der Artbildung haben.
Cerebellar ataxias are a group of neurodegenerative disorders primarily affecting the cerebellum. Although causative mutations in several genes have been identified there is currently no cure for ataxias.
The first part of this dissertation is focused on Spinocerebellar ataxia type 2 (SCA2). SCA2 is a dominant ataxia caused by repeat expansion mutations in the ATXN2 gene, which encodes the protein Ataxin2 (ATXN2). A polyglutamine (polyQ) tract consisting of CAG repeats interrupted by CAA was identified at exon 1 of ATXN2. Healthy individuals have between 22 and 23 glutamines, while expansions longer than 33 CAG repeats cause SCA2. The most noticeable symptom that SCA2 patients show is ataxic gait; however, they also show cerebellar dysarthria, dysdiadochokinesia, and ocular dysmetria caused by the progressive cerebellar degeneration.
To model the SCA2 disease, we generated a new mouse model where 100 CAG repeats were introduced in the mouse Atxn2 gene via homologous recombination. The characterization of this mouse model, Atxn2-CAG100-KIN, demonstrated that it reproduces the symptomatology observed in SCA2 patients. These animals showed significant loss of weight over time, brain atrophy, and motor deficits.
In addition, ATXN2 intermediate expansions have been linked to the pathology of Amyotrophic lateral sclerosis (ALS) as a risk factor. ALS is a fatal neurodegenerative disease where the motor neurons in the brain and spinal cord degenerate. A hallmark of ALS is the presence of TDP43-positive inclusions in neurons and glia. Further studies of post mortem spinal cord samples from SCA2 patients showed severe and widespread neurodegeneration of the central somatosensory system. Therefore, it was of interest to further investigate the pathology affection of this tissue in the Atxn2-CAG100-KIN line and the relationship between ATXN2 and TDP43. The characterization of the spinal cord pathology via protein quantification, transcript quantification, and immunohistochemistry showed a preferential affection of RNA binding proteins (RBP) in the spinal cord rather than the cerebellum. The ALS-linked factors TDP43 and TIA1 showed time-dependent co-aggregation with ATXN2 in spinal cord sections together with an increase of CASP3 levels. Therefore, this mouse model can help develop new therapies and evaluate their effect in differently affected areas.
A transcriptome data set from Atxn2-CAG100-KIN spinal cord samples at the final disease stage of this mouse model showed a strong up-regulation of RNA toxicity-, immune- and lysosome-implicated factors. These data pointed to a pathological reactivation of the synaptic pruning and phagocytosis in microglia. ATXN2-positive aggregates were found in microglia from spinal cord sections of 14-month-old Atxn2-CAG100-KIN via immunohistochemistry. The characterization of microglial response and the potentially deleterious effects of the expanded ATXN2 in this cell type could lead to therapies to improve patients’ living standards or delay the symptoms’ onset.
The second part of this thesis was focused on an autosomal recessive form of cerebellar ataxia, Ataxia Telangiectasia (A-T), with childhood onset. A-T patients show severe cerebellar atrophy manifesting as ataxia when the child starts to walk. The genetic cause of A-T is loss-of-function-mutations in the Ataxia Telangiectasia Mutated gene (ATM). ATM is a kinase involved in DNA damage response, oxidative stress, insulin resistance, autophagy via mTOR signaling, and synaptic function.
Working with proteome data from cerebrospinal fluid of 12 A-T patients and 12 healthy controls, we aimed to define novel biomarkers that would allow following the neurodegeneration in extracellular fluid. Additional validation efforts with ~2-month-old Atm-knock-out (Atm-/-) cerebellar samples helped us to define a scenario were the deficit of vesicle-associated ATM alters the secretion of ApoB, reelin, and glutamate. As extracellular factors, apolipoproteins and their cargo such as vitamin E may be useful for neuroprotective interventions.
ADAM15, which belongs to the family of the disintegrin and metalloproteinases, is a multi-domain transmembrane protein. A strongly upregulated expression of ADAM15 is found in inflamed synovial membranes from articular joints affected by osteoarthritis and especially rheumatoid arthritis (RA). During the chronic inflammatory process in RA the synovial membrane gets hyperplastic, resulting eventually in the formation of a pannus tissue, which can invade into the adjacent cartilage and bone thereby destroying their integrity. Previously, the expression of ADAM15 in fibroblasts of the RA synovial membrane was found to confer a significant anti-apoptotic response upon triggering of the Fas receptor, which resulted in the activation of two survival kinases, focal adhesion kinase (FAK) and Src. The Fas receptor, also named CD95, belongs to the death receptor family of the tumor necrosis factor receptors and stimulation of Fas/CD95 by its ligand FasL results in the execution of apoptotic cell death in synovial membranes of RA patients. However, the occurrence of apoptotic cell death in vivo in RA synovial tissues is considerably low despite the presence of FasL at high concentrations in the chronically inflamed joint. Accordingly, a general apoptosis resistance is a characteristic of RA-synovial fibroblasts that contributes considerably to the formation the hyperplastic aggressive pannus tissue. The objective of this study was to investigate the mechanisms underlying the capability of ADAM15 to transform FasL-mediated death- inducing signals into pro-survival activation of Src and FAK in rheumatoid arthritis fibroblasts (RASFs).
In the present study, the down-regulation of ADAM15 by RNA interference resulted in a significant increase of caspase 3/7 activity upon stimulation of the Fas receptor in RASFs. Likewise, chondrocytes expressing a deletion mutant of ADAM15 (ΔC), lacking the cytoplasmic domain, revealed increased caspase activities upon Fas ligation in comparison to cells transfected with full-length ADAM15, clearly demonstrating the importance of the cytoplasmic domain for an increased apoptosis resistance. Furthermore, activation of the Fas receptor triggered the phosphorylation of Src at Y416, which results in the active conformation of Src, as well as the phosphorylation of FAK at Y576/577 and Y861 – the target tyrosines phosphorylated by Src - in full-length ADAM15-transfected chondrocytes. However, cells transfected with ADAM15 mutant (ΔC) or with vector control did not exhibit any activation of Src and FAK upon Fas ligation. This suggested the presence of an as yet unknown protein interaction mediating the Fas triggered activation of the two kinases.
In order to identify this mechanism, the application of signal transduction inhibitors interfering with Calcium signaling either by inhibiting calmodulin with trifluoperazine (TFP) or the Calcium release-activated channel (CRAC/Orai1) with BTP-2 efficiently inhibited the phosphorylation of FAK and Src, revealing a role of calmodulin, the major Ca2+ sensor in cells, in ADAM15-dependent and Fas-elicited activation of the two survival kinases. Also, a direct Ca2+ -dependent binding of calmodulin to ADAM15 could be demonstrated by pull-down assays using calmodulin-conjugated sepharose and by protein binding assays using the recombinant cytoplasmic domain of ADAM15 and calmodulin.
Furthermore, it could be demonstrated in living synovial fibroblasts by double immunofluorescence stainings that triggering the Fas receptor by its ligand FasL or a Fas-activating antibody resulted in the recruitment of calmodulin to ADAM15 as well as to the Fas receptor in patch-like structures at the cell membrane. Simultaneously, Src associated with calmodulin was shown to become engaged in an ADAM15 complex, also containing cytoplasmic-bound FAK, by co-immunoprecipitations.
Additional studies were performed to analyze the efficacy of TFP and BTP-2 on apoptosis induction in synovial fibroblasts from 10 RA patients. Using caspase 3/7 and annexin V stainings for determining apoptosis, it could be shown that both inhibitors did not possess any apoptosis inducing capacity. However, when co-incubated with FasL both compounds synergistically enhanced apoptosis rates in the RASFs. Moreover, an additional silencing of ADAM15 revealed a further significant rise in apoptosis rates upon incubation with FasL/TFP or FasL/BTP-2, providing unequivocal evidence for an involvement of ADAM15 in facilitating apoptosis resistance in RASFs.
Taken together, these results demonstrate that ADAM15 provides a scaffold for the formation of calmodulin-dependent pro-survival signaling complexes upon CRAC/Orai1 coactivation by Fas ligation, which provides a new potential therapeutic target to break the apoptosis resistance in RASFs that critically contributes to joint destruction in RA.
Understanding global biodiversity patterns is one of the main objectives of ecology. Spatial variation in species richness can be explained by several environmental factors. The relationships between species richness and environmental factors have been associated with latitudinal, longitudinal and elevational gradients. The number of species is determined by birth, death and migration rates of species in a given area. These rates are affected by abiotic and biotic factors acting at local and regional scales. Climatic seasonal variation may also influence biodiversity, directly through physiological limitations and indirectly through biotic interactions, vegetation structure and food availability. Climate and land use change are the main factors for landscape simplification and biotic homogenization. Thus, the study of community patterns across environmental gradients may help to predict the effect of projected environmental change.
I investigated how abiotic and biotic factors influence different facets of bird diversity across an elevational gradient. My study was conducted along an elevational gradient spanning 2000 m within and around Podocarpus National Park and San Francisco reserve on the southeastern slope of the Andes in Ecuador. The climate is humid tropical montane with a bimodal rain regime. The region is characterized by evergreen premontane forest at low elevations, evergreen lower montane forest at mid elevations and upper montane forest at high elevations. The elevational gradient has natural continuous forests within the protected reserves and fragmented forests surrounding the reserves in a matrix of cattle pastures. To monitor bird diversity, I placed nine 20-m radius point counts within 18 one-hectare plots, in continuous and fragmented forest at 1000, 2000 and 3000 m a.s.l. I recorded and identified all birds for 10 minutes within each point count. Bird communities were sampled eight times per plot, in the most humid season and in the least humid season of 2014 and 2015. To estimate flower and fruit availability, I recorded all plants with open flowers and ripe fruits within each point count. To obtain the relative invertebrate availability, I assessed understory invertebrate fresh biomass using a standardized sweep-netting design along 100-metre borders of each plot. Vertical vegetation heterogeneity was estimated at eight layers above the ground within each point count. Temperature for each plot was obtained using an air temperature regionalization tool and precipitation through remote sensing techniques and meteorological data.
In the first chapter of this thesis, I explored the effects of elevation, climate and vegetation structure on overall bird communities as well as on frugivorous and insectivorous birds. I found that elevation was mostly indirectly associated with bird diversity, jointly mediated via temperature, precipitation and vegetation structure. Additionally, elevation was directly and positively associated with both the overall bird community and with insectivores, but not with frugivores. My findings indicate a reduction of bird diversity due to climatic factors and vegetation structure with increasing elevation. However, the direct, positive effect of elevation suggests that bird diversity was higher than expected towards high elevations, probably due to spatial, biotic and evolutionary settings.
In the second chapter, I analysed the influence of climate and resource availability on temporal variation of bird communities. I found a higher bird diversity in the least humid season than in the most humid season. The seasonality of the bird communities was mainly driven by temperature and precipitation. While temperature had a significant positive effect at high elevations, precipitation had a significant negative effect at low elevations. Resource availability had no significant effect. My findings suggest that the temporal fluctuations in bird communities likely occur due to climate
constraints rather than due to resource limitations.
In the third chapter, I studied the effect of forest fragmentation on taxonomic and functional bird diversity. I found that taxonomic diversity was higher in fragmented compared to continuous forests, while functional diversity was negatively affected by fragmentation, but only at low elevations. The increase of taxonomic diversity in disturbed habitats suggests an increase of habitat generalists, which may compensate the loss of forest specialists. My findings suggest that taxonomic diversity can be uncoupled from functional diversity in diverse communities at low elevations.
My results show the effects of environmental factors on the spatio-temporal patterns of bird communities and the potentially uncoupled responses of taxonomic and functional diversity to forest fragmentation. My findings highlight that bird communities respond differently to abiotic and biotic factors across elevational gradients. Overall, my study helps to better understand the mechanisms that drive species communities in response to complex environmental conditions, which could be an essential contribution for the conservation of bird communities in the tropical Andes.
Investigating the influence of truffle´s microbiome and genotype on the aroma of truffle fungi
(2019)
Truffles (Tuber spp.) are belowground forming fungi that develop in association with roots of various host trees and shrubs. Their fruiting bodies are renowned for their enticing aromas which vary considerably, even within truffles of the same species. This aroma variability might be attributed to factors such as geographical origin, degree of fruiting body maturation, truffle genotype and microbiome (microbial communities that colonise truffle fruiting bodies) which often co-vary. Although the influence of specific factors is highlighted by several studies, discerning the contribution of each factor remains a challenge since it requires an appropriate experimental design. The primary purpose of this thesis was to gain insight into the influence of truffle’s genotype and microbiome on truffle aroma.
This doctoral thesis is comprised of four chapters. Chapter1 (Vahdatzadeh et al., 2018) aimed to exclusively elucidate the influence of truffle genotype on truffle aroma by investigating the aroma of nine mycelial strains of the white truffle Tuber borchii. We also assessed whether strain selection could be employed to improve the human- perceived truffle aroma. Quantitative differences in aroma profiles among strains could be observed upon feeding of amino acids. Considerable aroma variabilities among strains were attributed to important truffle volatiles, many of which might be derived from amino acid catabolism through the Ehrlich pathway. 13 C-labelling experiments confirmed the existence of the Ehrlich pathway in truffles for leucine, isoleucine, methionine, and phenylalanine. Sensory analyses further demonstrated that the human nose can differentiate among strains. Our results illustrated the influence of truffle genotype on truffle aroma and showed how strain selection could be used to improve the human-perceived truffle aroma.
In chapter 2 the existing knowledge on the composition of bacterial community of four truffle species was compiled using meta-analysis approach (Vahdatzadeh et al., 2015). We highlighted the endemic microbiome of truffle as well as similarities and differences in the composition of microbial community within species at various phases of their life cycle. Furthermore, the potential contribution of truffle microbiome in the formation of truffle odorants was studied. Our findings showed that truffle fruiting bodies harbour complex microbial community composed of bacteria, yeasts, filamentous fungi, and viruses with bacteria being the dominant group. Regardless of truffle species, the composition of endemic microbiome of fruiting bodies appeared very similar and was dominated by α-Proteobacteria class. However, striking differences were observed in the bacterial community composition at various stages of the life cycle of truffle.Our analyses further suggested that odorants common to many truffle species might be produced by both truffle fungi and microbes, whereas specific truffle odorants might be derived from microbes only. Nevertheless, disentangling the origin of truffle odorants is very challenging, since acquiring microbe-free fruiting bodies are currently not possible.
Chapter 3 (Splivallo et al., 2019) further characterises truffle-associated bacterial communities of fruiting bodies of the black truffle T. aestivum from two different orchards. It aimed at defining the native microbiome in this truffle species, evaluating the variability of their microbiome across orchards, and assessing factors that shape assemblages of the bacterial communities. The dominant bacterial communities in T. aestivum revealed to be similar in both orchards: although a large portion of fruiting bodies were dominated by the α-Proteobacteria class (Bradyrhizobium genus) similar to other so far-assessed truffle species, in few cases β-Proteobacteria (Polaromonas genus), or Sphingobacteria (Pedobacter genus) were found to be predominant classes. Moreover, factors shaping bacterial communities influenced the two orchards differently, with spatial location within the orchard being the main driver in Swiss orchard and collection season in the French one. Surprisingly, in contrast to other fungi, truffle genotype and the degree of fruiting body maturity seemed not to contribute in shaping the assembly of truffle microbiome. Altogether, our data highlighted the existence of heterogeneous bacterial communities in T. aestivum fruiting bodies which are dominated by either of the three bacterial classes and mainly by the α-Proteobacteria class, irrespective of geographical origin. They further illustrated that determinants driving the assembly of various bacterial communities within truffle fruiting bodies are site-specific. Truffles are highly perishable delicacies with a short shelf life (1-2 weeks), and their aroma changes profoundly upon storage. Since truffle aroma might be at least partially produced by the truffle microbiome, chapter 4 (Vahdatzadeh et al., 2019) focuses on assessing the influence of the truffle microbiome on aroma deterioration of T.aestivum during post harvest storage. Specifically, volatile profile and bacterial communities of fruiting bodies collected from four different regions (three in France and one in Switzerland) were studied over nine days of storage. Our findings demonstrated the gradual replacement of dominant bacterial classes in fresh truffles (α-Proteobacteria, β-Proteobacteria, and Sphingobacteria) by food spoilage bacteria (members of γ- Proteobacteria and Bacilli classes), regardless of the initial diversity of the bacterial classes. This shift in the bacterial community also correlated with changes in volatile profiles, and markers for truffle freshness and spoilage could be identified. Ultimately, network analysis illustrated possible links among those volatile markers and specific bacterial classes. Our data showed that storage deeply influenced the composition of bacterial community as well as aroma of truffle fruiting bodies. They also illustrated the correlation between the shift in truffle microbiome, from commensal to detrimental, and the change of aroma profile, possibly leading to the loss of fresh truffle aroma. Overall, the work undertaken in this thesis demonstrated that truffle genotype and microbiome had a stronger influence on truffle aroma than previously believed.
Biodiversity is threatened worldwide because of ongoing habitat loss and fragmentation, overexploitation, pollution, biological invasions and a changing global climate. Due to the major importance of biological diversity for modern human living, efficient conservation and management strategies are required to protect endangered habitats and species. For this purpose, ambitious multilateral agreements on regional and global scale were declared to prevent biodiversity loss.
Efficient biomonitoring methods are required to adequately implement these biodiversity conventions. Species monitoring as a core activity in biodiversity research is an effective tool to assess the status of species and trends within habitats. Data collection can be obtained with visual, electronic or genetic surveys. Still, these monitoring programs can be expensive, laborious and inefficient for accurate species assessments. New techniques based on environmental DNA (eDNA) allows for the detection of DNA traces in environmental samples (soil, sediment, water and air samples) and open up new possibilities for species monitoring. The eDNA methodology enables detection of single species in a qualitative (presence/absence) or (semi-) quantitative way. eDNA metabarcoding approaches can be an effective community structure assessment method.
This thesis, located at the interface between experimental and applied research, illustrates the suitability of the eDNA methodology in applied biomonitoring using the example of the water-borne crayfish plague pathogen Aphanomyces astaci (Schikora 1906). The obtained results provide new insights into A. astaci sporulation dynamics in natural water courses. A. astaci sporulation is influenced by seasonal variation of water temperatures and life history traits (molting, activity, mating) of infected crayfish. The results also imply a high transmission risk of A. astaci spores during the complete year. This thesis compares two eDNA methods, which are successfully and consistently detecting A. astaci spores. Each approach is suitable for different biomonitoring tasks due to the method-specific requirements. The obtained results also reveal spatial variation in A. astaci occurance in the tested water bodies. A. astaci spore estimates are positively correlated with population density and pathogen loads of captured A. astaci- positive crayfish. eDNA results show a downstream zoospore transport of up to three kilometres distance from a distribution hot spot area of A. astaci-infected crayfish. The eDNA methodology is helpful in gaining reliable information on A. astaci occurrence in large water bodies. This information is urgently needed to initiate efficient management decisions for the conservation of European crayfish species.
eDNA-based methods such as for A. astaci detection are a useful complement for conventional monitoring and should have a strong impact on conservation policy. eDNA methodology will be helpful for the practical implementation of the main aims of key conservation agreements and thus will make important contributions to biodiversity protection.
Cardiac trabeculation is one of the essential processes required for the formation of a competent ventricular wall, whereby clusters of ventricular cardiomyocytes (CMs) from a single layer delaminate and expand into the cardiac jelly to form sheet-like projections in the developing heart (Samsa et al., 2013). Several congenital heart diseases are associated with defects in the formation of these trabeculae and lead to embryonic lethality (Jenni et al., 1999; Zhang et al., 2013, Jenni et al., 2001; Towbin 2010). It has been experimentally shown that lack of Nrg1/ErbB2/ErbB4, Angipoetin1/Tie2, EphrinB2/B4, BMP10, or any component of the Notch signaling pathway can cause defective trabeculation. Moreover, changes in blood flow and/or contractility can also affect trabeculation (Samsa et al., 2013). Together, these observations demonstrate that cardiac trabeculation is a highly dynamic and regulated process.
Trabeculation is a morphogenetic process that requires control over cell shape changes and rearrangements, similar to those observed during EMT. Epithelial cells within an epithelium are polarized and establish cell-cell junctions with the neighboring cells (Ikenouchi et al., 2003; Ferrer-vaquer et al., 2010), thus epithelial cell polarity is an important feature to maintain cell shape and tissue structure. During developmental processes such as cell migration and cell division or in disease states epithelial polarity might be disrupted. As a consequence of this alteration, cells lose their tight cell-cell adhesions, undergo cytoskeletal rearrangements, change their shape and gain migratory properties becoming mesenchymal cells (Micalizzi et al., 2010). In epithelial cells, apicobasal polarity is regulated by a conserved set of core complexes, including the PAR, Scribble and Crumbs complexes (Kemphues et al., 1988; Bilder and Perrimon, 2000; Teppas et al., 1984). The polarity proteins composing these complexes interact in a well organized and coordinated-manner creating molecular asymmetry along the apicobasal axis of the cell. In turn, this crosstalk regulates the maturation and stabilization of the junctions between cells and cytoskeleton in order to strengthen cell polarization (Roignot et al., 2013). Amongst the different polarity complex, Crumbs has been shown to be a key regulator of apicobasal polarity during development in both vertebrates and invertebrates (Tepass et al., 1990; Fan et al., 2004).
Here, taking advantage of zebrafish as a model organism, I study in vivo at single cell resolution changes in CM apicobasal polarity during cardiac trabeculation. Moreover, I show which factors regulate CM apicobasal polarity during this process. In addition, I dissect the role of the polarity complex Crumbs in regulating CM junctional rearrangements and the formation of the trabecular network.
In the 'Golden Age of Antibiotics', between 1940 and 1970, the global pharmaceutical companies discovered many antibiotics, such as cephalosporins, tetracyclines, aminoglycosides, glycopeptides, etc., as well as antifungal and antiparisitic agents. Due to several reasons, e.g. the steady re-discovery of already known NPs and the associated high costs, many pharmaceutical companies have significantly scaled back or totally abandoned their NP discovery programs since the late 20th century. Instead those companies started to focus on drug discovery based on combinatorial synthesis and thereby on the creation of enormous synthetic libraries containing small molecules. Unfortunately, this synthetic approach dealing with the optimization of existing NP or antibiotic has its limitations. As a result, leading pharmaceutical companies are re-conducting NPs research to discover new antimicrobials for the upcoming antimicrobial resistance threat. The Natural Product Center of Excellence, a collaboration between Sanofi-Aventis and Fraunhofer IME, is advancing in this context the discovery and development of novel antimicrobial agents for the treatment of infectious diseases through the testing of Sanofi's microbial extract library and strain collection. The aim of the present PhD thesis was the discovery and isolation of novel antimicrobial compounds with improved activities and/or novel MOAs as potential lead compound for a further drug discovery.
Der DNA-Translokator von T. thermophilus HB27, ebenso wie Typ-IV-Pili (T4P), sind Multiproteinkomplexe, die die Membranen und das Periplasma durchspannen. Sie sind ähnlich aufgebaut und enthalten identische Proteine. Der DNA-Translokator vermittelt Transport von DNA in das Zellinnere während der natürlichen Transformation. T4P sind filamentöse Zellorganellen, die an der inneren Membran assembliert werden und bis zu mehrere Mikrometer aus der Zelle hinausragen. Sie dienen der Anhaftung und Fortbewegung der Zellen auf Oberflächen.
Das Ziel dieser Arbeit war es, die Funktionen einzelner Komponenten der Komplexe und ihrer Proteindomänen bei der natürlichen Transformation, der T4P-Assemblierung und den durch T4P vermittelten Funktionen Adhäsion und „twitching motility“ aufzuklären.
Es sind neun Proteine bekannt, die eine duale Rolle als Komponenten des DNA-Translokators und des T4P spielen. Eines dieser Proteine ist die Assemblierungs-ATPase PilF, die Hexamere bildet. Diese cytoplasmatischen ATPase-Komplexe stellen die Energie für die Assemblierung der T4P bereit, ebenso wie für die Aufnahme freier DNA. Es ist jedoch bisher nicht geklärt, wie die durch PilF bereitgestellte Energie auf die anderen Komponenten des DNA-Translokators/T4P übertragen wird.
In dieser Arbeit konnte gezeigt werden, dass PilF an das cytoplasmatische Protein PilM des T4P und DNA-Translokators bindet. Zudem konnten Proteinkomplexe bestehend aus den Proteinen PilM, PilN und PilO heterolog produziert und aus Zellmembranen koisoliert werden. PilF interagierte mit diesen PilMNO-Komplexen via PilM. Diese Interaktionen führt zur Stimulierung der ATPase-Aktivität von PilF. Dies deutet an, dass PilM ein Kupplungsprotein ist, welches die Assemblierungs-ATPase PilF physisch und funktionell mit dem T4P/DNA-Translokator über den PilMNO-Komplex verbindet.
Neben PilF standen Präpiline von T. thermophilus im Fokus dieser Arbeit. Präpiline sind Vorläuferproteine, die zu Pilinen prozessiert werden und als solche dann die Untereinheiten der Pilus-Strukturen bilden.
Zusammenfassend konnten die Rollen einzelner Präpilin-ähnlicher Proteine bei T4P-assoziierten Funktionen geklärt werden und es konnten erste Analysen zur Charakterisierung des weitestgehend unbekannten Proteins ComZ durchgeführt werden. Desweiteren liefert diese Arbeit Hinweise darauf, dass die membranassoziierten Proteine PilM, PilN und PilO Kupplungsproteine sind, die PilF mit den periplasmatischen Komponenten des T4P/DNA-Translokators verbinden und dadurch die ATPase-Aktivität von PilF stimulieren. Die Rollen einzelner Proteindomänen von PilF und PilM bei der Protein-Protein-Interaktion und der Bindung von Liganden wurden aufgeklärt, sowie ihre Funktionen bei den T4P-vermittelten Funktionen und der natürlichen Transformation.
Autophagy, meaning “self-eating”, is an important cellular waste disposal mechanism. Thereby, damaged proteins, lipids and organelles are enclosed by autophagosomes and subsequently transported to the lysosomes for degradation into basic, cellular building blocks. Under basal conditions autophagy prevents the accumulation of defective and harmful material and generally promotes cell survival. However, several studies reported that hyperactivated autophagy, e.g. during developmental processes in lower eukaryotes, or during chemotherapeutic treatment of cancer cells, can also trigger cell death.
In recent years, autophagic cell death (ACD) has been considered as an alternative cell death pathway for tumor therapy, especially for solid tumors with high apoptosis resistance such as glioblastoma. Glioblastoma (GBM) is a very aggressive, malignant primary brain tumor with a median survival of ~ 15 months despite surgery and chemoradiotherapy. Accordingly, there is a great interest in improving GBM therapy through alternative cell death mechanisms. Interestingly, it has been shown that various substances, e.g. AT 101, cannabinoids and the combination of imipramine and ticlopidine (IM+TIC), induce ACD in GBM cells.
The aim of this project was to identify the underlying mechanisms of stress- and drug-induced ACD and its therapeutic potential for glioblastoma treatment. For detailed investigation of ACD, a CRISPR/Cas9-based approach was used to generate ATG5 and ATG7 knockouts as genetic models of autophagy deficiency. In a previous study of our lab it was demonstrated that administration of AT 101 triggers ACD in glioblastoma cells, which was associated with early mitochondrial fragmentation but no signs of apoptosis. Since mitochondrial fragmentation often precedes mitophagy, the first part of this thesis explored the potential role of mitophagy in AT 101-induced cell death.
ATG5-depleted cells confirmed that AT 101 induces ACD. In addition, treatment with AT 101 resulted in a pronounced mitochondrial depolarization, which was at least partly caused by the opening of the mitochondrial permeability pore. Global proteome analysis of AT 101-treated GBM cells revealed a robust decrease in mitochondrial protein clusters as well as a strong increase in the enzyme heme oxygenase-1 (HMOX1). Subsequent experiments for detailed investigation of mitophagy following AT 101 treatment (western blot, flow cytometric MTG and mt-mKeima, qRT-PCR of mitochondrial vs nuclear DNA) consistently indicated strong mitophagy induction by AT 101, which could be reduced by genetic or pharmacological inhibition of autophagy. Furthermore, siRNA-mediated knockdown experiments revealed that the selective mitophagy receptors BNIP3 and BNIP3L and the HMOX1 enzyme play an essential role in AT 101-induced mitophagy and subsequent cell death. Taken together, these data demonstrate that AT 101-induced mitochondrial dysfunction and HMOX1 induction synergize to promote excessive mitophagy with a lethal outcome in glioma cells.
The second part of this thesis focused on the identification of new substances that cause ACD and the investigation of the underlying cell death pathways. Using a cell death screen of the ENZO Screen-Well™ autophagy library in MZ-54 wild-type vs ATG5 and ATG7-depleted cells, loperamide, pimozide, and STF-62247 were identified as ACD-inducing agents. The increase of the autophagic flux and the induction of ACD by these substances was confirmed by using different ATG5 and ATG7 knockout cell lines and the already established positive control IM+TIC.
In contrast to AT 101, IM+TIC, STF-62247, loperamide and pimozide produced neither mitochondrial dysfunction nor mitophagy. Interestingly, it has been described that imipramine, loperamide and pimozide inhibit the lysosomal enzyme acid sphingomyelinase, which is associated with impaired lipid transport. Global proteome analysis and cholesterol staining confirmed that all four substances, but especially loperamide and pimozide, inhibit cellular lipid transport, leading to massive lipid accumulation in the lysosomes. In the further course of the experiments, the connection between defective lipid transport and autophagy was investigated in more detail. On the one hand, the defective lipid transport contributed to the induction of autophagy, on the other hand the massive accumulation of lipids led to lysosomal membrane damage, inhibition of lysosomal degradation at later time points and finally to a lysosomal cell death. Remarkably, it has been shown that hyperactivated autophagy by IM+TIC, loperamide and pimozide massively promotes lysosomal membrane damage. This result highlights the difficulties of a clear distinction between autophagic and lysosomal cell death.
In summary, two new signaling pathways that induce autophagic cell death in GBM cells and may be relevant for glioblastoma therapy were investigated in this study.
Structured illumination microscopy (SIM) is part of the super-resolution methods developed at the beginning of this century. To produce a super-resolution image SIM requires three things: 1) illumination of the sample with a periodic pattern, 2) acquisition of multiple images per plane under different pattern’s phases and orientations and 3) the processing of these images has to be carried with a reconstruction algorithm. The result of the reconstruction is an image with a resolution gain that is proportional to the frequency of the pattern (po). The typical SIM set-up uses an epi-fluorescence configuration, thus the interference angle of the beams that create the pattern is restricted by the angular aperture of the objective. Under this restriction the maximum value of po is given by the cut-off frequency of the objective lens and sets at 2 the maximum resolution gain of SIM under linear illumination.
In the first part of this thesis we present the implementation and characterization of the 2D-SIM set-up designed by Dr. Bo-Jui Chang (B-J. Chang et al., PNAS 2017), this design exploits the concept introduced by light-sheet microscopy, i.e. separation of illumination and detection paths to obtain resolution gains larger than the usual two-fold (Chapter 3). The set-up is named coherent structured illumination light-sheet based fluorescence microscopy (csiLSFM) and it consists of a triangular array of three objectives, such that two are used for illumination and one for detection. With the independent illumination arms is possible to interfere two coherent light-sheets at angles beyond the angular aperture of the detection lens, attaining the maximum interference angle of 180° when the light-sheets counter-propagate. This condition delivers a pattern with a po 1.4 times larger than the cut-off frequency (ωo), hence our set-up provides generic resolution gains of 2.4.
The extraction of the high spatial frequencies that produce the resolution gain in the csiLSFM is a challenge due to a low pattern modulation. The low modulation inherently arises because the frequency associated to the pattern period lies beyond the cut-off frequency of the detection lens. To overcome this challenge we developed a filtering strategy that facilitates the withdrawal of information from a SIM data set, simultaneously the proposed filtering process optimizes the reconstruction algorithm by reducing the periodic artifacts that are recurrent in SIM images. In this same chapter we also performed an spectral analysis of the artifacts and determined that they originate from irregularities in the power spectrum that occur due to the partial or total lack of certain spatial frequencies (fig.4.2 and 4.3), our reconstruction reduces this information drops and diminishes the artifact occurrence. The relevance of our reconstruction pipeline is that it delivers a standardized process to enhance the SIM image in a current context in which the commonly used reconstruction algorithms employ empirical tuning to improve it (fig.4.13). Moreover, the pipeline is applicable to the csiLSFM data and also to images acquired with any other 2D-/3D-SIM set-up (fig.4.10 and 4.11).
The processing of various image data sets acquired with the csiLSFM exposed us to the question of how low the modulation of the illumination pattern can be before no super-resolution frequencies can be extracted. Answering this question is important to guarantee that the SIM data contains enough spatial frequencies to provide significant resolution gains. Thus in chapter 5 we developed a quantitative metric to indirectly determine the pattern modulation from the SIM data and find its critical value to use it as evaluation criterion. We called this metric the quality factor (Q-factor) and it represents the normalized strength (amplitude) of the extracted frequencies respect to the Gaussian noise contained in the images. Through simulations we estimated that Q=0.11 is a critical value and a SIM data set requires this as minimum value is to deliver a significant resolution gain. Q works then as an assessment tool for classifying SIM data as optimal or sub-optimal, i.e. Q≥0.11 or Q<0.11. We demonstrated such application with data acquired in various SIM commercial set-ups to prove its feasibility in the field (fig.5.6-5.11)
As mentioned at the beginning of this abstract SIM requires a specialized set-up and a processing algorithm to produce super-resolution images. This thesis contributes to these two areas in the following aspects: first, in its linear version a structured illumination microscope is highly associated to a 2-fold resolution gain. Here we demonstrated the possibility of extending this gain to 2.4 using our custom set-up the csiLSFM. Second, a reconstructed SIM image is prone to artifacts due to the mathematical process it undergoes, here we analyzed the artifact sources and identified them with drops of spatial information in the reconstructed spectrum, based on these conclusions we designed a processing pipeline to facilitate the extraction of spatial frequencies and directly reduce artifacts. A third and final outcome of this thesis is the development and practical implementation of a quantitative index to evaluate the quality of SIM data in terms of its relevant information content (Q-factor). Accordingly, the overall contributions of this work were done in the areas of SIM set-up, SIM reconstruction procedure and SIM data evaluation.
Die Analyse von DNA-Sequenzen steht spätestens seit der Feststellung ihrer tragenden Rolle in der Vererbung organismischer Eigenschaften im Fokus biologischer Fragestellungen. Seit Kurzem wird mit modernsten Methoden die Untersuchung von kompletten Genomen ermöglicht. Dies eröffnet den Zugang zu genomweiten Informationen gegenüber begrenzt aussagekräftigen markerbasierten Analysen. Eine Genomsequenz ist die ultimative Quelle an organismischer Information. Allerdings sind diese Informationen oft aufgrund technischer und biologischer Gründe komplex und werfen meist mehr Fragen auf, als sie beantworten.
Die Rekonstruktion einer bislang unbekannten Genomsequenz aus kurzen Sequenzen stellt eine technische Herausforderung dar, die mit grundlegenden, aber in der Realität nicht zwingend zutreffenden Annahmen verbunden ist. Außerdem können biologische Faktoren, wie Repeatgehalt oder Heterozygotie, die Fehlerrate einer Assemblierung stark beeinflussen. Die Beurteilung der Qualität einer de novo Assemblierung ist herausfordernd, aber zugleich äußerst notwendig. Anschließend ist eine strukturelle und funktionale Annotation von Genen, kodierenden Bereichen und repeats nötig, um umfangreiche biologische Fragestellungen beantworten zu können. Ein qualitativ hochwertiges und annotiertes assembly ermöglicht genomweite Analysen von Individuen und Populationen. Diese Arbeit beinhaltet die Assemblierung und Annotation des Genoms der Süßwasserschnecke Radix auricularia und eine Studie vergleichender Genomik von fünf Individuen aus verschiedenen molekularen Gruppen (MOTUs).
Mollusken beherbergen nach den Insekten die größte Artenvielfalt innerhalb der Tierstämme und besiedeln verschiedenste, teils extreme, Habitate. Trotz der großen Bedeutung für die Biodiversitätsforschung sind verhältnismäßig wenige genomische Daten öffentlich verfügbar. Zudem sind Arten der Gattung Radix auch aufgrund ihrer großen geografischen Verbreitung in diversen biologischen Disziplinen als Modellorganismen etabliert. Eine annotierte Genomsequenz ermöglicht über bereits untersuchte Felder hinaus die Forschung an grundlegenden biologischen Fragestellungen, wie z.B. die Funktionsweise von Hybridisierung und Artbildung. Durch Assemblierung und scaffolding von sechs whole genome shotgun Bibliotheken verschiedener insert sizes und einem transkriptbasiertem scaffolding konnte trotz des hohen Repeatgehalts ein vergleichsweise kontinuierliches assembly erhalten werden. Die erhebliche Differenz zwischen der Gesamtlänge der Assemblierung und der geschätzten Genomgröße konnte zum Großteil auf kollabierte repeats zurückgeführt werden.
Die strukturelle Annotation basierend auf Transkriptomen, Proteinen einer Datenbank und artspezifisch trainierten Genvorhersagemodellen resultierte in 17.338 proteinkodierenden Genen, die etwa 12,5% der geschätzten Genomgröße abdecken. Der Annotation wird u.a. aufgrund beinhaltender Kernrthologen, konservierter Proteindomänenarrangements und der Übereinstimmung mit de novo sequenzierten Peptiden eine hohe Qualität zugesprochen.
Das mapping der Sequenzen von fünf Radix MOTUs gegen die R. auricularia Assemblierung zeigte stark verringerte coverage außerhalb kodierender Bereiche der nicht-Referenz MOTUs aufgrund hoher Nukleotiddiversität. Für 16.039 Gene konnten Topologien berechnet werden und ein Test auf positive Selektion ausgeführt werden. Insgesamt konnte über alle MOTUs hinweg in 678 verschiedenen Genen positive Selektion detektiert werden, wobei jede MOTU ein nahezu einzigartiges Set positiv selektierter Gene beinhaltet. Von allen 16.039 untersuchten Genen konnten 56,4% funktional annotiert werden. Diese niedrige Rate wird vermutlich durch Mangel an genomischer Information in Mollusken verursacht. Anschließende Analysen auf Anreicherungen von Funktionen sind deshalb nur bedingt repräsentativ.
Neben den biologischen Ergebnissen wurden Methoden und Optimierungen genomischer Analysen von Nichtmodellorganismen entwickelt. Dazu zählen eigens angefertigte Skripte, um beispielsweise Transkriptomalignments zu filtern, Trainings eines Genvorhersagemodells automatisiert und parallelisiert auszuführen und Orthogruppen bestimmter Arten aus einer Orthologievorhersage zu extrahieren. Zusätzlich wurden Abläufe entwickelt, um möglichst viele vorhandene Daten in die Assemblierung und Annotation zu integrieren. Etwa wurde ein zusätzliches scaffolding mit eigens assemblierten Transkripten mehrerer MOTUs sequenziell und phylogenetisch begründet ausgeführt.
Insgesamt wird eine umfassende und qualitativ hochwertige Genomsequenz eines Süßwassermollusken präsentiert, welche eine Grundlage für zukünftige Forschungsprojekte z.B. im Bereich der Biodiversität, Populationsgenomik und molekularen Ökologie bietet. Die Ergebnisse dieser Arbeit stellen einen Wissenszuwachs in der Genomik von Mollusken dar, welche bisher trotz ihrer Artenvielfalt deutlich unterrepräsentiert bezüglich assemblierter und annotierter Genome auffallen.
In times of a growing world population and the associated demand for high crop yield, the understanding and improvement of plant reproduction is of central importance. One key step of plant reproduction is the development of the male gametophyte, which is better known as pollen. In addition, the development of pollen was shown to be very sensitive to abiotic stresses, such as heat, which can cause crop damage and yield loss. To obtain new insights in the development and heat stress response of pollen, a combined transcriptome and proteome analysis was performed for three pollen developmental stages of non- and heat-stressed tomato plants.
The analysis of the transcriptomes of non-stressed pollen developmental stages enabled the determination of mRNAs accumulated in certain developmental stages. The functional analysis of these mRNAs led to the identification of protein families and functional processes that are important at different times of pollen development. A subsequent comparison of the transcriptomes of non- and heat-stressed pollen revealed a core set of 49 mRNAs, which are upregulated in all three developmental stages. The encoded proteins include among other things different heat stress transcription factors and heat shock proteins, which are known key players of the plant heat stress response.
Furthermore, 793 potential miRNAs could be identified in the transcriptome of non- and heat-stressed pollen. Interestingly, 38 out of the 793 miRNAs have already been identified in plants. For more than half of these miRNAs potential target mRNAs were identified and the interactions between miRNAs and mRNAs linked to the development and heat stress response of pollen. In total, 207 developmentally relevant interactions could be determined, out of which 34 have an effect on transcriptional-networks. In addition, 24 of the interactions contribute the heat stress response of pollen, whereby this mainly affects post-meiotic pollen.
An initial correlation of the proteome and transcriptome of the developmental stages revealed that transcriptome analyses are not sufficient to draw exact conclusions about the state of the proteome. A closer look on the relationship of the transcriptome and proteome during pollen development revealed two translational modes that are active during the development of pollen. One mode leads to a direct translation of mRNAs, while the second mode leads a delayed translation at a later point in time. Regarding the delayed translation, it could be shown that this is likely due to a short-term storage of mRNAs in so-called EPPs. The comparison of the proteome and transcriptome response to heat stress revealed that the proteome reacts much stronger and that the reaction is mainly independent from the transcriptome. Finally, the comparison of the proteome of non- and heat-stressed pollen provided first indications for changes in the ribosome composition in response to heat stress, as 57 ribosomal proteins are differentially regulated in at least one developmental stage.
Heat stress transcription factors (Hsfs) have an essential role in heat stress response (HSR) and thermotolerance by controlling the expression of hundreds of genes including heat shock proteins (Hsps) with molecular chaperone functions. Hsf family in plants shows a striking multiplicity, with more than 20 members in many species. In Solanum lycopersicum HsfA1a was reported to act as the master regulator of the onset of HSR and therefore is essential for basal thermotolerance. Evidence for this was provided by the analysis of HsfA1a co-suppression (A1CS) transgenic plants, which exhibited hypersensitivity upon exposure to heat stress (HS) due to the inability of the plants to induce the expression of many HS-genes including HsfA2, HsfB1 and several Hsps. Completion of tomato genome sequencing allowed the completion of the Hsf inventory, which is consisted of 27 members, including another three HsfA1 genes, namely HsfA1b, HsfA1c and HsfA1e.
Consequently, the suppression effect of the short interference RNA in A1CS lin e was re-evaluated for all HsfA1 genes. We found that expression of all HsfA1 proteins was suppressed in A1CS protoplasts. This result suggested that the model of single master regulator needs to be re-examined.
Expression analysis revealed that HsfA1a is constitutively expressed in different tissues and in response to HS, while HsfA1c and HsfA1e are minimally expressed in general, and show an induction during fruit ripening and a weak upregulation in late HSR. Instead HsfA1b shows preferential expression in specific tissues and is strongly and rapidly induced in response to HS. At the protein level HsfA1b and HsfA1e are rapidly degraded while HsfA1a and HsfA1c show a higher stability. In addition, HsfA1a and HsfA1c show a nucleocytosolic distribution, while HsfA1b and HsfA1e a strong nuclear retention.
A major property of a master regulator in HSR is thought to be its ability to cause a strong transactivation of a wide range of genes required for the initial activation of protective mechanisms. GUS reporter assays as well as analysis of transcript levels of several endogenous transcripts in protoplasts transiently expressing HsfA1 proteins revealed that HsfA1a can stimulate the transcription of many genes, while the other Hsfs have weaker activity and only on limited set of target genes. The low activity of HsfA1c and HsfA1e can be attributed to the lower DNA capacity of the two factors as judged by a GUS reporter repressor assay.
HsfA1a has been shown to have synergistic activity with the stress induced HsfA2 and HsfB1. The formation of such complexes is considered as important for stimulation of transcription and long term stress adaptation. All HsfA1 members show synergistic activity with HsfA2, while only HsfA1a act as co-activator of HsfB1 and HsfA7. Interestingly, HsfA1b shows an exceptional synergistic activity with HsfA3, suggesting that different Hsf complexes might regulate different HS-related gene networks. Altogether these results suggest that HsfA1a has unique characteristics within HsfA1 subfamily. This result is interesting considering the very high sequencing similarity among HsfA1s, and particularly among HsfA1a and HsfA1c.
To understand the molecular basis of this discrepancy, a series of domain swapping mutants between HsfA1a and HsfA1c were generated. Oligomerization domain and C-terminal swaps did not affect the basal activity or co-activity of the proteins. Remarkably, an HsfA1a mutant harbouring the N-terminus of HsfA1c shows reduced activity and co-activity, while the reciprocal HsfA1c with the N-terminus of HsfA1a cause a gain of activity and enhanced DNA binding capacity.
Sequence analysis of the DBD of HsfA1 proteins revealed a divergence in the highly conserved C-terminus of the turn of β3-β4 sheet. As the vast majority of HsfA1 proteins, HsfA1a at this position comprises an Arg residue (R107), while HsfA1c a Leu and HsfA1e a Cys. An HsfA1a-R107L mutant has reduced DNA binding capacity and consequently activity. Therefore, the results presented here point to the essential function of this amino acid residue for DNA binding function. Interestingly, the mutation did not affect the activity of the protein on Hsp70-1, suggesting that the functionality of the DBD and consequently the transcription factor on different promoters with variable heat stress element number and architecture is dependent on structural peculiarities of the DBD.
In conclusion, the unique properties including expression pattern, transcriptional activities, stability, DBD-peculiarities are likely responsible for the dominant function of HsfA1a as a master regulator of HSR in tomato. Instead, other HsfA1-members are only participating in HSR or developmental regulations by regulating a specific set of genes. Furthermore, HsfA1b and HsfA1e are likely function as stress primers in specific tissues while HsfA1c as a co-regulator in mild HSR. Thereby, tomato subclass A1 presents another example of function diversity not only within the Hsf family but also within the Hsf-subfamily of closely related members. The diversification based on DBD peculiarities is likely to occur in potato as well. Therefore this might have eliminated the functional redundancy observed in other species such as Arabidopsis thaliana but has probably allowed the more refined regulation of Hsf networks possibly under different stress regimes, tissues and cell types.
Smut fungi (Ustilaginomycotina) were previously defined as plant parasites that produced blackish or brownish masses of teliospores in or on various organs of plants. Each teliospore germinates to form a single basidium with usually four basidiospores that subsequently grow as a saprobic, yeast-like, haploid stage. The Ustilaginomycotina are a highly diverse group with about 1,700 species in 115 different genera. All of the species were united in a single order, the Ustilaginales, in late 19th century. These teliospore producing fungi are now considered the classic smut fungi. Towards the end of the 20th century, new ideas were brought into this classification system. Most notable was the comparative work regarding the ultrastructure of septal pores and the anatomy of the interaction zones between host and parasite. This work changed the whole concept of smut fungi and their evolutionary relationships. These results were subsequently supported by molecular phylogenetic studies. Both lines of investigation led to the classification of the smut fungi into four different classes, Ustilaginomycetes, Exobasidiomycetes, Malasseziomycetes and Moniliellomycetes (see chapter 1.3).
A reliable taxonomy that reflects phylogenies needed in order to estimate the diversity and the relationships between the diverse groups of smut fungi. In the last 20 years, molecular investigations based mostly on rDNA loci, e.g. ITS (internal transcribed spacer) or LSU (large subunit), have revealed the evolutionary relationships between many taxa of smut fungi. However, there are few phylogenetic studies available for smut fungi (see chapter 1.5.1), and much work is needed to develop backbone phylogenetic trees and to resolve species complexes of many smut fungi.
This thesis reports the results of six different studies that aimed to develop new and improved tools for the phylogenetic analyses of smut fungi, and then apply these methods to selected groups of smut fungi. The first study (Kruse et al. 2017a, Chapter 3) developed a method to improve the amplification of ITS sequences of some smut fungi. Due to its high discrimination value, the ITS gene region is widely used as a barcoding locus for species delimitation of fungi. For this purpose, the general ITS primers ITS1 and ITS4 or more specific modifications, e.g. ITS1F for Ascomycota, ITS4B for Basidiomycota or M-ITS1 for smut fungi, were used. As these primer combinations often yielded unsatisfactory results, due to coamplification of other (contaminant) fungi or the host plant DNA, improvement of the amplification of the ITS region was needed. In order to design new smut specific primers for the ITS region, a representative set of several sequences of the flanking regions of the ITS region (LSU and SSU) of smut fungi, plants and other fungi were downloaded from GenBank. A set of primers was designed on this dataset. These primers were tested on a representative set of about 70 different smut genera under different PCR conditions. Finally, three different primers, one forward primer, smITS-F, and two reverse primers, smITS-R1 and -R2, were selected as the best ones. The following tests with different combinations of these primers, and also under inclusion of the M-ITS1 primer, showed only slight differences in the number of different genera that successfully amplified. But there were some differences regarding the genera that amplified. A broader test on 205 samples in 39 genera showed that the PCR efficiency of the newly designed primers was much better than the primer set ITS4/M-ITS1. With the primers designed in this study almost no non-target ITS was amplified, giving new opportunities especially for amplifying ancient DNA or DNA from older herbarium samples. However, many species groups remain unresolved by only one gene region.
The second study (Kruse et al. 2017c, Chapter 4) found new loci and suitable primers that better resolved multi-locus trees. To date, the most frequently used loci for making multi-locus trees are SSU (small subunit), LSU (large subunit) and ITS (internal transcribed spacer). While the LSU is not always sufficient to distinguish between closely related species, it is highly discriminative above the species level. In an effort to increase the phylogenetic resolution of smut phylogenies, some protein-coding genes were used, including rpb1, rpb2, and atp6 with varying success (see Chapter 2.1.2). As most of these loci are seldom used or sometimes only work on pure cultures because of their low specifity, new protein-coding loci were identified that produced reliable phylogenetic trees. Based on five available genomes, potential gene loci were filtered for possible primers. Initially, 40 different primer combinations for 14 gene loci were tested on a set of twelve different genera of smut fungi. The best candidates were selected and optimized during further tests. Finally, 22 different forward primers and 17 different reverse primers for nine different gene regions were developed, with each differentiating at least one genus of smut fungi (preferably for Ustilaginomycetes). The different primers showed varying discriminative power for different smut genera. They worked best for the Ustilaginaceae, based on the primer designed from Ustilaginomycetes genomes. These new primer sets and loci have the potential to resolve different species groups within the smut fungi and furthermore to produce reliable phylogenetic trees with high resolution. To prove their applicability, three species complexes were investigated in-depth, two from the Ustilaginomycetes and one from the Exobasidiomycetes.
...
The objectives of this thesis were to understand how distinct classes of cell types interact to shape oscillatory activity in cortical circuits of the turtle. We chose the turtle cortex as a model system for cortical computations for two reasons. One is that the phylogenetic position of turtles makes their cortex functionally and anatomically particularly interesting. The second is that reptilian brains present several unique experimental advantages. Turtles have a three-layered cortex that forms the dorsalmost part of their pallium and receives direct input from visual thalamus. Thus turtle cortex, while sharing several features with mammalian cortices, constitutes a simpler system for studying cortical computations and dynamics. Freshwater turtles are semiaquatic species, that dive for hours and hibernate for months without breathing. Their brains are adapted to these behaviors so that they can operate under severe anoxia. This property allows for ex vivo wholebrain and whole-cortex (”cortical slab”) preparations in vitro, enabling the use of many sophisticated techniques for monitoring activity in parallel.
I thus set out to utilize the advantages of our model system, by using optogenetic methods to reliably evoke oscillations in an ex vivo whole-cortex preparation while observing activity in parallel with planar multi-electrode arrays (MEA), linear silicon depth-electrodes and patch-clamp recording techniques. This required several technical aspects to be solved. Prior work in turtle cortex (Prechtl, 1994; Prechtl et al., 1997; Senseman and Robbins, 2002) indicated that visual stimuli evoke complex activity patterns (e. g. wave patterns) in dorsal cortex. The goal was to examine these dynamics in detail and to provide mechanistic explanations for them whenever possible. The recent advent of optogenetics, the development of microelectrode arrays, and the possibility to combine these techniques with classical electrophysiological approaches on a resistant, accessible and stable preparation led me to explore a number of technical avenues.
First I had to establish gene delivery methods in reptiles. I settled on recombinant viruses, and show results from several serotypes of adeno-associated virus (AAV), i lentivirus and rabies virus. I report successful gene expression of genes of interest with several subtypes of AAV, including the commonly used AAV2/1 and AAV2/5 serotypes. Second I had to find promoters enabling global and cell-type specific gene expression in reptiles. Ubiquitous high-yield promoters such as CAG/CB7 or CMV drive high levels of expression in turtles; cell-type specific promoters such as hSyn (expression limited to neurons) and CaMKIIa (expression limited exclusively o mostly to excitatory neurons) appear similarly biased in turtles. Other cell-type specific promoters reported in the literature (fNPY, fPV, fSST) failed to express in turtles.
A second major aspect of my work focused on electrophysiological recordings using microelectrode arrays and the interpretation of extracellular signals recorded from cortex in ex vivo preparations. We observed that spike signals produced by pyramidal and inhibitory neurons were very often followed by a slower potential. We identified these slower potentials as reflections of synaptic currents, and thus of the axonal projections of the neurons, at least within the deep layers of cortex. This also resulted in a means to classify neurons as excitatory or inhibitory with much higher reliability than classical methods (e. g. spike width). The final aspect of my work concerns the use of optogenetics to dissect the mechanisms of cortical oscillations and wave propagation. I show that oscillations can be induced by light in turtle cortex after transfection with AAV2/1 carrying the gene for channelrhodopsin 2 (ChR2). By using the CaMKIIa promoter, ChR2 induced currents are limited to LII/III excitatory cells; we can therefore control excitatory drive to cortical networks. If this drive is strong enough, layer III inhibitory interneurons are recruited and fire in a concerted fashion, silencing the excitatory population. The visually evoked 20 Hz oscillations observed in chronically recorded animals (Schneider, 2015) or in anaesthetized animals (Fournier et al., in press) thus appear to result from a feedback loop between E and I cells within layers II & III. Details of these interactions are being investigated but - layer I interneurons, by contrast, do not seem to be involved. By pulsing light I could control the frequency of the oscillations within a range of several Hz around the natural oscillation frequency. Above this range, cortex could only follow the stimulus at a fraction (1/2, 1/3,...) of the light pulse frequency. Using a digital micromirror device, I limited activation of the cortical networks spatially, enabling the study of wave propagation in this system.
Reptilian cortex offers a relatively simple model system for a reductionist and comparative strategy on understanding cortical computations and dynamics. Turtle dorsal cortex could thus give fundamental insights to the primordial organization tional, computational and functional principles of cortical networks. These insights are relevant to our understanding of mammalian brains and may prove valuable to decipher fundamental questions of modern neuroscience.
To date, chemicals are used ubiquitous in everyday life and an increasing consumption of pharmaceuticals and personal care products and industrial chemicals results in an increased water pollution. Conventional wastewater treatment plants are not able to completely remove the variety of (polar) organic compounds from today’s wastewater and thus serve as constant key point sources for the unintentional release of (micro-)pollutants into the aquatic environment. Anthropogenic micropollutants are detectable in very low concentrations in almost every aquatic compartment and may cause adverse effects on aquatic organisms. Considering the current situation of water pollution and to enhance water quality with regard to environmental and human health, the implementation of advanced wastewater treatment technologies, such as ozonation and activated carbon filtration was extensively discussed and investigated in recent years. Yet, besides their advantages regarding the efficient removal of a variety of recalcitrant, organic compounds as well as pathogens from the wastewater, it is known that especially the treatment with ozone may lead to the formation of largely unknown ozonation by-products with often unknown toxicity and unknown threats to human and the environment. To address these topics the joint research project TransRisk aimed at the “characterization, communication and minimization of risks originating from emerging contaminants and pathogens in the water cycle”. Within this research project the present thesis focuses on the ecotoxicological investigation of emerging waterborne contaminants, including their potential transformation products (TPs). Additionally, focus was laid on the investigation of combined effects of anthropogenic contaminants and pathogens with effects especially on aquatic invertebrate organisms.
The potential ecotoxicological effects of the antiviral drug acyclovir and two of its structurally identified TPs, were investigated on three aquatic organisms (Raphidocelis subcapitata, Daphnia magna and embryos of Danio rerio). While the parent compound acyclovir caused no acute toxicity up to a tested concentration of 100 mg/l on any of the investigated organisms, both TPs were shown to exhibit an increased aquatic toxicity. Carboxy-acyclovir, the biodegradation product of acyclovir, significantly reduced reproduction of D. magna by 40% at 102 mg/l, and the ozonation product COFA significantly inhibited growth of green algae R. subcapitata (EC10 = 14.1 mg/l). In the present case, advanced wastewater treatment was shown to lead to the formation of TPs, that reveal a higher toxicity towards investigated organisms, than the parent compound. Results highlight the necessity of further research related to the topic of identification and characterization of TPs, formed during advanced wastewater treatment processes.
To investigate the potential reduction or enhancement of toxic effects of nine differently treated wastewater effluents, selected bioassays with Daphnia magna, Lumbriculus variegatus and Lemna minor were conducted in flow-through test systems on a pilot treatment plant. The different treatment processes included ozonation of conventional biological treatment, with subsequent filtration processes as well as membrane bioreactor treatment in combination with ozonation. While exposure to the conventionally treated wastewater did not result in significant impairing effects on D. magna and L. minor, a reduced abundance of L. variegatus (by up to 46%) was observed compared to the medium control. Subsequent ozonation and additional filtration of the wastewater enhanced water quality, visible in an improved performance of L. variegatus. In general, direct evidence for the formation of toxic TPs due to the advanced wastewater treatments was not found, at least not in concentrations high enough to cause measurable effects in the investigated test systems. Additionally, no evidence for immunotoxic effects of the investigated wastewater effluents were observed. Yet, study-site- and species-specific effects hindered the definite interpretation of results. That underline the importance of a suitable test battery consisting of representatives of different taxonomic groups and trophic levels, to ensure a comprehensive evaluation of the complex matrix of wastewater and to avoid false-negative or false-positive results.
With aim to improve knowledge regarding immunotoxicity in invertebrates, the potential immunotoxic effects of the immunosuppressive pharmaceutical cyclosporine A (CsA) were investigated by applying the host-parasite model system Daphnia magna – Pasteuria ramosa in an adapted host resistance assay. Co-exposure to CsA and Pasteuria synergistically affected long-term survival of D. magna. Additionally, the enhanced virulence of the pathogen upon chemical co-exposure was expressed in synergistically increased infection rates and an increased speed of Pasteuria-induced host sterilization. In conclusion, results provide evidence for a suppressed disease resistance in a chemically stressed invertebrate host, highlighting the importance of investigating the conjunction of environmental pollutants and pathogens in the environmental risk assessment of anthropogenic pollutants.
Die Analyse früher Entwicklungsstadien von Säugetierembryonen und daraus gewonnener Stammzelllinien kann entscheidende Erkenntnisse im Bereich der Reproduktionsbiologie und der regenerativen Medizin hervorbringen. Dabei spielt die Maus, als geeignetes Modellsystem für die Übertragbarkeit auf den Menschen eine wichtige Rolle, in erster Linie weil die Blastozysten der Maus verglichen mit menschliche Blastozysten eine morphologische Ähnlichkeit aufweisen. Humane embryonale Stammzelllinien haben großes Potential für die Anwendung in der regenerativen Medizin und vergleichend dazu wurde Gen-Targeting in embryonalen Stammzellen verwendet, um tausende neuer Mausstämme zu generieren. Die Gewinnung embryonaler Stammzellen erfolgt im Blastozystenstadium, diese können dann nach Injektion in eine andere Blastozyste zur Entwicklung aller Gewebearten, einschließlich der Keimbahngewebe, beitragen (Martin, 1981; Evans and Kaufman 1981).
Ursache einer Fehlgeburt können vor allem Defekte in der Entwicklung des Trophoblasten und des primitive Entoderms (PrE) sein, dabei sind ca. 5 % der Paare betroffen die versuchen ein Kind zu bekommen (Stephenson and Kutteh, 2007). Eine Untersuchung dieser Zelllinien im Mausmodell könnte weitere Erkenntnisse für die Gründe einer Fehlentwicklung liefern. Trophoblasten Stammzelllinien können aus den Blastozysten der Maus und dem extraembryonalen Ektoderm von bereits implantieren Embryonen gewonnen werden (Tanaka et al., 1998). Diese Zelllinien geben Aufschluss über die Entwicklung des Trophoblasten, fördern die Entwicklung der Plazenta und sind gleichzeitig ein gutes Modellsystem um die Implantation des Embryos im Uterus näher zu untersuchen. Zellen des primitive Entoderms (PrE) beeinflussen das im Dottersack vorhandene extraembryonale Entoderm, welches dort als “frühe Plazenta” fungiert und für die Versorgung des Embryos mit Nährstoffen zuständig ist (Cross et al., 1994). Des Weiteren besitzt das Entoderm einen induktiven Einfluss auf die Bildung von anterioren Strukturen und die Bildung von Endothelzellen sowie Blutinseln (Byrd et al., 2002).
Extraembryonale Endodermstammzellen (XEN Zellen) können aus Blastozysten gewonnen und in embryonale Stammzellen (ES-Zellen) umgewandelt werden (Fujikura et al., 2002; Kunath et al., 2005). Es war jedoch nicht bekannt, ob XEN-Zellen auch aus Postimplantations-Embryonen gewonnen werden können. XEN-Zellen tragen in vivo zur Entwicklung des Darmendoderms bei (Kwon et al., 2008; Viotti et al., 2014) und könnten als alternative, selbsterneuernde Quelle für extraembryonale Endoderm-abgeleitete Zellen dienen, die zur Herstellung von Geweben für die regenerative Medizin verwendet werden könnten (Niakan et al., 2013).
In der Embryogenese der Maus zeigt sich an Tag E3.0 eine kompakte Morula die sich allmählich in das Trophektoderm (TE) differenziert, welches wiederum den Embryonalknoten (“innere Zellmasse”) umschließt (Johnson and Ziomek, 1981). Ein wichtiger Schritt im Rahmen der Entwicklung findet an Tag E3.5 statt, in diesem Zeitraum gehen aus dem Embryonalknoten der pluripotente Epiblast und das primitive Entoderm hervor. Im späten Blastozystenstadium an Tag E4.5 liegt das PrE als Zellschicht entlang der Oberfläche der Blastocoel-Höhle. Aus dem Epiblast entwickeln sich im weiteren Verlauf der Embryo, das Amnion und das extraembryonale Mesoderm des Dottersacks. Die Zellen des Trophektoderm führen zur Entwicklung der Plazenta. Das PrE differenziert sich im Zuge der Weiterentwicklung in das viszerale Entoderm (VE) und das parietale Entoderm (PE) des Dottersacks (Chazaud et al., 2006; Gardner and Rossant, 1979; Plusa et al., 2008). VE umgibt den Epiblast und extraembryonisches Ektoderm (ExE). PE-Zellen wandern entlang der inneren Oberfläche von TE und sezernieren zusammen mit Trophoblasten-Riesenzellen Basalmembranproteine, um die Reichert-Membran zu bilden (Hogan et al., 1980). Die Reichert-Membran besteht aus Basalmembranproteinen, einschließlich Kollagenen und Lamininen, die zwischen den parietalen Endoderm- und Trophoblastzellen liegen. Diese Membran wirkt als ein Filter, der dem Embryo den Zugang zu Nährstoffen ermöglicht, während er eine Barriere zu den Zellen der Mutter bildet (Gardner, 1983).
...
Angesichts heutiger Umweltprobleme ist die Stärkung positiver Mensch-Natur-Beziehungen wichtiger denn je. Zeitgenössische Umweltbildung zielt darauf ab, Motivation und Einstellungen zu fördern sowie eine grundlegende Wissensbasis zu schaffen (IUCN, UNEP, & WWF, 1991; Potter, 2010), um einen selbstbestimmten, verantwortungsvollen Umgang mit der Natur zu ermöglichen. Positiver Naturbezug und Umwelteinstellungen gelten als Basis für aktiven Umweltschutz. Direkte Naturerfahrungen gelten dabei als didaktische Möglichkeit, die Motivation für Umweltschutz zu festigen (Kaiser, Roczen, & Bogner, 2008). Einstellungen verändern sich im Laufe des Lebens und so kann das Alter eine wichtige Rolle bezüglich der Effektivität von Umweltbildungsprogrammen spielen (Ernst & Theimer, 2011). Auch Umweltwissen gilt als Grundlage von Umwelthandeln. Denn sinnliche Erfahrungen allein führen nicht zum Verständnis ökologischer Zusammenhänge (Frick, Kaiser, & Wilson, 2004; Liefländer, Bogner, Kibbe, & Kaiser, 2015). Die biologiedidaktische Forschung sieht Fakten-, Handlungs- und Effektivitäts-wissen als zentral für die Genese von Umwelthandeln (Frick, Kaiser, & Wilson, 2004). Isoliertes Fachwissen wiederum führt nach aktueller Erkenntnis auch nicht zur Entwicklung von Haltungen und Wertvorstellungen, welche unser Handeln beeinflussen (Barr, 2003; Finger, 2010; Leiserowitz, Kates, & Parris, 2005).
Bis heute sind altersbasierte Unterschiede bei Schülerinnen und Schülern bezüglich ihrer Naturverbundenheit und Umwelteinstellungen nicht hinreichend untersucht. Auch ist die nötige Dauer der Naturerfahrungen noch nicht nachgewiesen. Es gibt bislang keine Studie, die Umwelteinstellungen, -wissen und –handeln von Kindern verschiedener Regionen der Erde untersucht und Daten auf internationaler Ebene erhoben und ausgewertet hat. Die gezielte Integration der drei Umweltwissensarten in ein solch globales Umweltbildungsprojekt stellt eine zusätzliche bislang nicht angegangene Aufgabe dar. Die vorliegende Arbeit schließt diese Forschungslücken, indem sie auf internationaler Ebene jene Variablen mit einbezieht, die einen nahezu vollständigen Eindruck der Effektivität von Umweltbildung in verschiedenen Regionen, Sozialisationen und Altersklassen zulässt. So wird der Einfluss eines umfassenden Umweltbildungsprogramms auf Naturverbundenheit, Umwelteinstellungen und -wissen der verschiedenen Typen untersucht und ein Bezug zur eventuellen Veränderung des Umwelthandelns hergestellt. Dabei stehen sowohl traditionelle als noch unerforschte mögliche Einflussfaktoren im Fokus. Die Studie umfasst insgesamt 1454 Schülerinnen und Schüler aus Bangladesch, Malaysia, Deutschland und Singapur, die alle an dem Umweltbildungsprojekt „Global denken, lokal handeln – wir schützen unsere Umwelt!“ bzw. “Think global, act local – we protect our environment!“ teilgenommen haben.
Zur Messung der Naturverbundenheit diente Schulz’ INS-Skala (Inclusion of Nature in Self) (2002). Umwelteinstellungen wurden mit dem 2-MEV-Modell (Two Major Environmental Values) gemessen (Johnson & Manoli, 2011). Eine Skala zur Erhebung von Umweltwissen wurde eigens erstellt und hinsichtlich der drei Wissenstypen nochmals modelliert. Eine Skala zur Ermittlung von Umwelthandeln wurde auf Grundlage von Bögeholz (1999) erstellt. Alle Skalen waren Teil eines Fragebogens, welcher in Form eines Pre-, Post- und Follow-up-Test eingesetzt wurde. Kinder aus Parallelklassen, die nicht am Projekt teilnahmen, aber Klassenunterricht zu den jeweiligen Themen erhielten, dienten als Kontrollgruppen.
Die Ergebnisse bestätigen einen positiven Effekt außerschulischer Umweltbildung bezüglich der Entwicklung der untersuchten Variablen. So wurde nach der Teilnahme am eintägigen und auch nach dem fünftägigen Umweltbildungsprogramm eine signifikante Verstärkung des Naturbezugs gemessen, wohingegen die Kontrollgruppen keine messbare Veränderung zeigten. Jedoch nur die fünftägige Intervention führte auch zu nachhaltigen Veränderungen. Hierbei am stärksten beeinflusst wurden Kinder zwischen sieben und neun Jahren.
Bei der Untersuchung demographischer Einflussfaktoren auf Umwelteinstellung, -wissen und –handeln stellten sich das Wohnsitzland sowie die städtische bzw. ländliche Prägung der Wohngegend als entscheidend heraus. So waren dies die einflussreichsten Determinanten zur Vorhersage des Grundvorhandenseins sowie Veränderungen der untersuchten Variablen in Folge der Bildungsmaßnahme. Einzig bei der Entwicklung des Umwelthandelns schien die direkte Naturerfahrung unwesentlich, zeigten die Kontrollgruppen ähnlichen Wandel in ihrem aktiven Einsatz für die Umwelt. Im internationalen Vergleich scheint die komplexe Verkettung diverser einflussnehmender Faktoren, wie der Wohlstand des jeweiligen Staates, das generelle politische System sowie spezifische bildungspolitische Begebenheiten, den Erfolg von Umweltbildungsprogrammen mit zu bestimmen.
Die Daten zeigen, dass Faktenwissen Grundlage für Handlungs- und Effektivitätswissen ist. Alle Dimensionen wurden durch die Intervention signifikant gesteigert. Effektivitätswissen wuchs am stärksten. Auch das Umweltverhalten wurde positiv verstärkt. Jedoch ließen sich nur schwache Korrelationen zwischen den einzelnen Wissenstypen und Handeln feststellen. Zusammenfassend war das durchgeführte Bildungsprojekt erfolgreich in der Förderung von Naturverbundenheit sowie Umwelteinstellungen, -wissen und- handeln. Die Ergebnisse werden im Rahmen dieser Arbeit im Hinblick auf ihre Bedeutung für die schulische Umweltbildung sowie die didaktische Forschung erörtert.
Colorectal cancer (CRC) has the third highest incidence and the fourth highest mortality rate worldwide and represents a substantial health care burden and affects the life of millions of people. CRC is a genetic disease caused by the stepwise accumulation of genetic alterations. The initiating event in colorectal carcinogenesis is the aberrant activation of the WNT pathway, but other pathways are also commonly deregulated, including the PI3K/AKT pathway. A number of previous studies using genetically engineered mouse models aimed at dissecting the exact role of PI3K/AKT pathway in CRC, but have yielded in rather conflicting results. Despite the inconsistent results, these studies already put forward the idea that PI3K/AKT signaling in combination with other genetic events might substantially contribute to tumor progression. Since the PI3K/AKT pathway is frequently activated in CRC, it represents an ideal candidate for therapeutic intervention. Although extensive efforts had led to the development of numerous inhibitors targeting the PI3K/AKT pathway, the diversity of genetic alterations can challenge the identification of the most effective therapeutic targets. Therefore, the discovery of shared tumor-promoting mechanisms downstream of these genetic alterations might unravel new biomarkers and druggable targets. The aim of this study was to elucidate the precise role of PI3K/AKT pathway during the course of colorectal carcinogenesis and to decipher novel protumorigenic molecular mechanisms downstream of PI3K/AKT activation that can be used for therapeutic intervention.
To obtain a better insight into the role of the PI3K/AKT pathway during colorectal carcinogenesis, mice expressing an oncogenic variant of AKT1 (AktE17K) specifically in the intestinal epithelial cells (IEC) were used. At the age of 6 months untreated AktE17K mice showed clearly perturbed intestinal homeostasis, but no tumor formation. To induce colonic tumorigenesis, AktE17K mice were subjected to treatment with the colonic carcinogen azoxymethane (AOM). In response to AOM, AktE17K mice developed invasive but non-metastatic tumors, which showed strong nuclear accumulation of TP53. To investigate the role of PI3K/AKT signaling specifically in CRC progression, AktE17K mice were crossed to TP53-deficient mice (Tp53ΔIEC). Unlike AktE17K mice, untreated Tp53ΔIEC; AktE17K, developed highly invasive small
intestinal tumors by the age of 6 months. To investigate the role of AKT hyperactivation in colonic tumor progression, Tp53ΔIEC; AktE17K mice were subjected to AOM treatment. AKT hyperactivation significantly enhanced tumor progression and induced metastatic dissemination.
To get a better insight how AKT signaling can promote tumor progression, whole tumor tissues from AOM-treated Tp53ΔIEC and Tp53ΔIEC; AktE17K mice were subjected to next generation mRNA sequencing and phospho-proteomic analysis by mass spectrometry. Both analyses indicated that AKT hyperactivation expands the inflammatory tumor microenvironment and upregulates pathways associated with invasion and metastasis. Importantly, Gene Set Enrichment Analysis revealed that AOM-induced colon tumors of Tp53ΔIEC; AktE17K animals, are highly similar in their gene expression profile to the CMS4 subtype of human CRC, which is associated with worse overall- and relapse-free survival. Gene expression analysis also suggested elevated NOTCH signaling in the Tp53ΔIEC; AktE17K tumors. Interestingly, while the expression of Notch3 mRNA was increased in the tumors of Tp53ΔIEC; AktE17K mice, the expression of the other NOTCH receptors was unaffected by AKT hyperactivation. In vitro experiments using TP53-deficient mouse tumor organoids with hyperactive AKT signaling confirmed the direct, tumor cell-intrinsic link between AKT activation and increased Notch3 expression. Moreover, inhibition of EZH2 mimicked the effect of AKT hyperactivation on Notch3 expression, suggesting that AKT regulates Notch3 via an epigenetic mechanism.
Knock-down of Notch3 in TP53-deficient mouse tumor organoids with hyperactive AKT signaling resulted in differential regulation of several pathways with potential role in invasion and metastasis and in cell death and survival. Subsequent in vivo experiments confirmed the role of NOTCH3 signaling in CRC progression. Treatment of AOM-induced Tp53ΔIEC; AktE17K mice with a NOTCH3 antagonistic antibody or the γ-secretase inhibitor DAPT significantly reduced invasion and metastasis. Importantly, NOTCH3 expression was also found to be associated with human CRC progression, suggesting that NOTCH3 represent a valid target for the treatment of CRC. This work, using genetically engineered mouse models and advanced in vitro techniques, has demonstrated a strong tumor promoting role for PI3K/AKT signaling in CRC progression and has identified NOTCH3 signaling as a potential therapeutic target downstream of the PI3K/AKT pathway.
Microsporidia are a group of parasites that infect a wide range of species, many of which play important roles in agriculture and human disease. At least 14 microsporidian species have been confirmed to cause potentially lifethreatening infectious diseases in both immunocompromised and immunocompetent humans. Approximately 1,400 species of microsporidia have been described. Depending on their host and habitat they are classified into three groups, the aquasporidia, the terresporidia and the marinosporidia.
Microsporidia were originally classified as fungi by Naegeli (1857). However, their lack of typical eukaryotic components – such as mitochondria, Golgi bodies or peroxisomes – suggested to place the microsporidia together with other amitochondriate protists within the Archezoa kingdom. This "microsporidia-early" hypothesis was further supported by molecular phylogenies inferred from individual genes. Despite this evidence, the placement of microsporidia as an early branching eukaryote remained a topic for debate. The phylogeny of microsporidia is prone to suffer from biases in their reconstruction. The high evolutionary rate of microsporidian proteins tends to place these proteins together with other fast evolving lineages, a phenomenon known as long-branch attraction. In 1996, the first molecular phylogenetic studies placed the microsporidia inside the fungi.
Subsequently, several further studies located the microsporidia at different positions inside the fungal clade. Since then, microsporidia have been considered as members of the Ascomycota, Zygomycota, Cryptomycota, or as a sister group to the Ascomycota and Basidiomycota, or even as the sister group of all fungi.
The difficulties in determining the evolutionary origin of microsporidia are not only caused by their lack of several cellular components but also by their reduced genomes and metabolism. Being obligate intracellular parasites, microsporidia successfully reduced their genome sizes, down to the range of bacteria. As the smallest eukaryotic genome described so far, the genome of Encephalitozoon intestinalis is just 2.3 Mbp, about half the size of the one of Escherichia coli. Due to their low number of protein coding genes (less than 4,000), microsporidia are thought to retain only genes essential for their survival and development. Furthermore, several key metabolic pathways are missing in the microsporidia, such as the citric acid cycle, oxidative phosphorylation, or the de novo biosynthesis of nucleotides. As a result they are in an obligatory dependence on many primary metabolites from the hosts. However, the presence of hsp70 protein suggests a more complex genome of the microsporidian ancestor. Consequently, the small microsporidian genomes and the reduced metabolism would be consequences of a secondary loss process that molded the contemporary microsporidia from a functionally more complex ancestral species. However, it remains unclear whether the last common ancestor (LCA) of the microsporidia was already reduced, or whether the genome compaction was lineage-specific and started from a more complex LCA.
We investigated the evolutionary history of the contemporary microsporidia through the reconstruction and analysis of their LCA. As a first step in our analysis, we have developed and implemented a software facilitating an intuitive data analysis of the large presence absence-patterns resulting from the tracing of microsporidian proteins in gene sets of many different species. These so called phylogenetic profiles can now be dynamically visualized and explored with PhyloProfile. The software allows the integration of other additional information layers into the phylogenetic profile, such as the similarity of feature architecture (FAS) between the protein under study and its orthologs. The FAS score can be displayed along the presence-absence pattern, which can help to identify orthologs that have likely diverged in function. PhyloProfile closes the methodological gap that existed between tools to generate large phylogenetic profiles to delineate the evolutionary history and the contemporary distribution of large – and ultimately complete – gene sets, and the more function-oriented analysis of individual protein. In the next step we tackled the problem of how to transfer functional annotation from one protein to another. We have developed HamFAS that integrates a targeted ortholog search based on the HaMStR algorithm with a weighted assessment of feature architecture similarities (FAS) between orthologs. In brief, for a seed protein we identify orthologs in reference species in which proteins have been functionally annotated based on manually curated assignments to KEGG Ortholog (KO) groups. The FAS scores between the orthologs and seed proteins are calculated. Subsequently, we compute pairwise FAS scores for all reference proteins within a KO group. A group's mean FAS score serves then as cutoff that must be exceeded to warrant transfer of its KO identifier to the seed. A benchmark using a manually curated yeast protein set showed that HamFAS yields the best precision (98.5%) when compared with two state-of-the-art annotation tools, KAAS and BlastKOALA. Furthermore, HamFAS achieves a higher sensitivity. On average HamFAS annotates almost 50% more proteins than KAAS or BlastKOALA.
With this extended bioinformatics toolbox at hand, we aimed at reconstructing the evolutionary history of the microsporidia. We generated a robust phylogeny of microsporidia using a phylogenomics approach. As a data basis, we identified a set of microsporidian proteins encoded by 80 core genes with one-to-one orthologs. A maximum likelihood analysis of this data
with 48 fungi and additionally in 13 species from more distantly related such as animals and plants combined in a supermatrix strongly supported the hypothesis that microsporidia form the sister group of the fungi. We confirmed that the data explains this microsporidia-fungi relationship significantly better than any other of the previously proposed phylogenetic hypotheses.
On the basis of this phylogeny, and of the phylogenetic profiles of microsporidian proteins, we then focused on reconstructing the dynamics microsporidian genome evolution. Between 2% of the proteins in the compact microsporidia Encephalitozoon intestinalis and up to 49% of the proteins of Edhazardia aedis are private for individual microsporidian species. A comparison of the sequence characteristics of these proteins to that of proteins with orthologs in other microsporidian species revealed individual differences. Yet, without further evidences it remains unclear whether these private genes are indeed lineage-specific innovations contributing to the adaptation of each microsporidium to its host, or whether these are artifacts introduced in the process of gene annotation. A total of 14,410 microsporidian proteins could then be grouped into 1605 orthologous groups that can be traced back to the last common ancestor of the microsporidia (LCA set). We found that 94% of the microsporidian LCA proteins could be tracked back to the last eukaryotic common ancestor. The high evolutionary age of these proteins, together with the resistance against gene loss in the microsporidia suggests that the corresponding functions are essential for eukaryotic life. Further 3% of the LCA proteins could be dated to the common ancestor microsporidia share with the fungi. Only 3% of the LCA proteins appear as microsporidia specific inventions. These proteins are potentially of importance for the evolutionary of the obligate parasitic lifestyle nowadays shared by all microsporidia.
The functional annotation and metabolic pathway analysis of the microsporidian LCA protein set gave us more insight into the adaptation of the microsporidia to their parasitic lifestyle and the origin of the microsporidian genome reduction. The presence of E1 and E3 components of the pyruvate dehydrogenase complex and the mitochondrial hsp70 protein support an ancestral presence of mitochondria in the ancestral microsporidia. In addition, several ancient proteins that complement gapped metabolic pathways were found in the microsporidian LCA. They suggested a more complex genome and metabolism in the LCA. However, our reconstruction of the metabolic network of the microsporidian LCA still lacks many main pathways. For example, the TCA cycle for effective energy production, and key enzymes that are required for in vivo synthesis of critical metabolites like purines and pyrimidines appear absent. We therefore find that the parasitic lifestyle and the genome reduction already occurred in the microsporidian LCA. This ancestral state was followed by further losses and gains during the evolution of each individual microsporidian lineage.
In conclusion, I described for the first time the in vivo functions of PAK2 during cardiac development and its requirement for heart contractility
AIM1 – Characterization of Pak2a and Pak2b functions during cardiovascular system development: description of the phenotype triggered by the loss of expression of pak2b in the pak2a mutant Firstly, in addition to the confirmation of the published data regarding the pak2a mutant and morphant phenotype, I showed that pak2bbns159 mutant does not exhibit morphological defects, neither in the ISV formation nor in the brain vascular patterning. More importantly, I analyzed in more details the phenotypic consequences of pak2a and pak2b loss of expression in the trunk and brain vasculatures. Indeed, the lack of blood flow in the embryos, was associated with central arteries migration defects and reduced lumen in these central arteries and the ISVs. Moreover, pak2a and pak2b loss of expression resulted in cardiac failure.
AIM2 – Role of Pak2 on cardiac contractility From 40 -46 hpf, I found a weaker heart contractility in the pak2ami149/mi149;pak2bbns159/bns159. Although, the PAK proteins have been shown to impact the actin cytoskeleton organization, the heart morphological defects associated with the altered contractility, were not associated with acto-myosin filament reorganization. However, by analyzing in more details the structure of the sarcomeres, I was able to demonstrate that the proteins constituting the sarcomeres were strongly affected and showed an altered spatial organization. Then, I also described the effects of the loss of expression of both paralogs on the junctional protein localization. I demonstrated the loss of Pak2 function resulted in junction protein rearrangement in the cardiomyocytes in the pak2ami149/mi149;pak2bbns159/bns159 mutants at 40 and 46 hpf.
Thus, I was able for the first time to demonstrate in vivo PAK2 functions during cardiac development and its requirement for proper cardiac contractility activity.
AIM3 – Decipher mechanism of Pak2 signaling cascade involved during cardiac development Both pak2a and pak2b WT mRNAs were able to rescue the pak2ami149/mi149;pak2bbns159/bns159 mutant heart defects and the results indicated that these paralogs share overlapping function during cardiac development. Moreover, although I was not able to examine the control transgenic lines, myocardial and endothelial specific pak2a overexpression did not ameliorate the mutant cardiac deficiency. Thus,the absence of rescue by reactivating pak2a in cardiomyocytes indicates a non-cell autonomous function of Pak2a on cardiomyocytes.
For the first time, this study allowed to follow PAK2 in vivo functions during cardiovascular development. More importantly, its role on heart contractility regulation would enable further investigations to generate new tools for the treatment of cardiomyopathies.
Polyploidie in Prokaryoten
(2018)
Diese Arbeit teilt sich in drei Teile auf, die sich mit der Regulation der Polyploidie sowie mit der Genkonversion als evolutionären Vorteil von Polyploidie in Haloferax volcanii beschäftigen.
Im ersten Teil dieser Arbeit, wurde der Einfluss der DNA-Replikationsinitiatorproteine Orc1/Cdc6 auf das Ploidielevel untersucht. Hierbei konnte anhand von Deletionsmutanten zunächst gezeigt werden, dass lediglich drei der 16 Orc1/Cdc6-Proteine in H. volcanii essentiell sind. Bestimmung des Ploidielevels mittels qPCR-Analyse ergab, dass jedes der 12 untersuchten Orc1/Cdc6-Proteine das Ploidielevel mindestens eines Replikons beeinflusst und dementsprechend sowohl die mit einem Replikationsursprung assoziierten als auch die „verwaisten“ Orc1/Cdc6-Proteine eine Funktion haben. Die mit einem Replikationsursprung assoziierten Orc1/Cdc6-Proteine hatten hierbei keinen größeren Einfluss auf das Ploidielevel als die „verwaisten“. Zusätzlich konnte durch Wachstumsanalysen in Mikrotiterplatten gezeigt werden, dass die meisten Deletionsmutanten unter allen getesteten Bedingungen ein mit dem Wildtyp vergleichbares oder besseres Wachstum zeigen. Eine Deletionsmutante eines Orc1/Cdc6-Proteins hingegen zeigte nur verbessertes Wachstum bei Glukose als Kohlenstoffquelle, was ein Hinweis auf die Verwendung verschiedener Orc1/Cdc6-Proteine unter verschiedenen Bedingungen sein könnte. Zusätzlich wurden zwei mit dem Replikationsursprung assoziierte Orc1/Cdc6-Proteine überexprimiert und via ihres N-terminalen His-Tag im Western-Blot nachgewiesen, sodass diese nun für Co-Affinitätsaufreinigungen zur weiteren Charakterisierung des komplexen Zusammenspiels der Orc1/Cdc6-Proteine zur Verfügung stehen.
Im Rahme des zweiten Teils der Arbeit wurde der Einfluss der in der 5‘-Region der der Replikationsursprünge ori1 und ori2 kodierten Proteine auf Wachstum und die Kopienzahl des Hauptchromosoms bestimmt. Zunächst wurde die Expression der drei in Haloarchaea hoch-konservierten oap-Gene upstream von ori1 mittels Nothern-Blot untersucht und es konnte gezeigt werden, dass das oap-Operon tatsächlich als Operon abgelesen wird. Um alle Gene in den 5‘-Regionen von ori1 und ori2 genauer zu charakterisieren, wurden induzierbare Überexpressionsmutanten im Wildtyp-Hintergrund angefertigt. Es konnte mittels Wachstumsversuchen in Mikrotiterplatten gezeigt werden, dass bei Induktion von Beginn an die Überexpression der Hef-Helikase und des oapB-Proteins zu einem starken Wachstumsdefekt führen, die von oapC und HVO_1724 zu einem moderaten Wachstumsdefekt, wohingegen für die Überexpressionsmutante von oapA vergleichbares Wachstum zum Wildtyp und für die Überexpression der Rad25d-Helikase verbessertes Wachstum beobachtet werden konnte. Es konnte darüber hinaus gezeigt werden, dass sowohl die Deletion als auch die Überexpression der Helikasen keinen Einfluss auf das Ploidielevel hat; die Deletion von oapC führt jedoch zu einer Reduktion der Genomkopienzahl in exponentieller und stationärer Phase, was ein erster Hinweis darauf ist, dass das oap-Operon eine Rolle bei der Regulation des Ploidielevels spielen könnte.
Im dritten Teil der Arbeit wurde eine Methode entwickelt, um Genkonversion farblich sichtbar zu machen. Hierbei wurde sich H. volcaniis Carotinoidbiosynthese zu Nutze gemacht. Es wurden zwei verschiedene, auxotrophe Elternstämme mittels Protoplastenfusion verschmolzen, um eine heterozygote Tochterzelle zu erzeugen. Ein Genkonversionsereignis wurde durch einen roten Keil angezeigt, der aus einer weißen Kolonie wuchs und durch die erfolgreiche Reparatur des Carotinoidbiosynthesegens entstand. Es wurden insgesamt 8525 Klone ausgestrichen und 0,14 % der Kolonien zeigten eine entsprechende rote Färbung. Das Proof-of-Principle dieser Methode ist in damit in dieser Arbeit gelungen. Um die Genkonversion in den weißen Kolonien auf genetischer Ebene genauer zu untersuchen, wurde PCR verwendet. Es konnte gezeigt werden, dass in den Zellen aller 135 untersuchten Kolonien Genkonversion stattgefunden hatte und zwar so effizient, dass nur in seltenen Fällen Heterozygotie vorlag. Unter Selektionsdruck stehende Loci hatten in beiden untersuchten Fällen eine starke Präferenz in Richtung Homozygotie und Erhalt der Prototrophie. Für nicht unter Selektionsdruck stehende Loci konnte gezeigt werden, dass die Hälfte der untersuchten Kolonien dem Elternstamm 1 glich, während die andere Hälfte dem Elternstamm 2 glich. Auch hier waren die Zellen nur in seltenen Fällen homozygot.
The fungal interaction with plants is a 400 million years old phenomenon, which presumably assisted in the plants’ establishment on land. In a natural ecosystem, all plant-ranging from large trees to sea-grasses-are colonized by fungal endophytes, which can be detected inter- and intracellularly within the tissues of apparently healthy plants, without causing obvious negative effects on their host. These ubiquitous and diverse microorganisms are likely playing important roles in plant fitness and development. However, the knowledge on the ecological functions of fungal root endophytes is scarce. Among possible functions of endophytes, they are implicated in mutualisms with plants, which may increase plant resistance to biotic stressors like herbivores and pathogens, and/or to abiotic factors like soil salinity and drought. Also, endophytes are fascinating microorganisms in regard to their high potential to produce a great spectrum of secondary metabolites with expected ecological functions. However, evidences suggest that the interactions between host plants and endophytes are not static and endophytes express different symbiotic lifestyles ranging from mutualism to parasitism, which makes difficult to predict the ecological roles of these cryptic microorganisms. To reveal the ecological function of fungal root endophytes, this doctoral thesis aims at assessing fungal root endophytes interactions with different plants and their effects on plant fitness, based on their phylogeny, traits, and competition potential in settings encompassing different abiotic contexts. To understand the cryptic implication of nonmycorrhizal endophytes in ecosystem processes, we isolated a diverse spectrum of fungal endophytes from roots of several plant species growing in different natural contexts and tested their effects on different model plants under axenic laboratory conditions. Additionally,we aimed at investigating the effect of abiotic and biotic variables on the outcome of interactions between fungal root endophytes and plants.
In summary, the morphological and physiological traits of 128 fungal endophyte strains within ten fungal orders were studied and artificial experimental systems were used to reproduce their interactions with three plant species under laboratory conditions. Under defined axenic conditions, most endophytes behaved as weak parasites, but their performance varied across plant species and fungal taxa. The variation in the interactions was partly explained by convergent fungal traits that separate groups of endophytes with potentially different niche preferences. According to my findings, I predict that the functional complementarity of strains is essential in structuring natural root endophytic communities. Additionally, the responses of plant-endophyte interactions to different abiotic factors, namely nutrient availability, light intensity, and substrate’s pH, indicate that the outcome of plant-fungus relationships may be robust to changes in the abiotic environment. The assessment of the responses of plant endophyte interactions to biotic context, as combinations of selected dominant root fungal endophytes with different degrees of trait similarity and shared evolutionary history, indicates that frequently coexisting root-colonizing fungi may avoid competition in inter-specific interactions by occupying specific niches, and that their interactions likely define the structure of root-associated fungal communities and influence the microbiome impacts on plant fitness.
In conclusion, my findings suggest that dominant fungal lineages display different ecological preferences and complementary sets of functional traits, with different niche preferences within root tissues to avoid competition. Also, their diverse effects on plant fitness is likely host-isolate dependent and robust to changes in the abiotic environment when these encompass the tolerance range of either symbiont.
Colorectal cancer (CRC) has the third highest incidence and the fourth highest mortality rate worldwide and represents a substantial health care burden and affects the life of millions of people. CRC is a genetic disease caused by the stepwise accumulation of genetic alterations. The initiating event in colorectal carcinogenesis is the aberrant activation of the WNT pathway, but other pathways are also commonly deregulated, including the PI3K/AKT pathway. A number of previous studies using genetically engineered mouse models aimed at dissecting the exact role of PI3K/AKT pathway in CRC, but have yielded in rather conflicting results. Despite the inconsistent results, these studies already put forward the idea that PI3K/AKT signaling in combination with other genetic events might substantially contribute to tumor progression.
Since the PI3K/AKT pathway is frequently activated in CRC, it represents an ideal candidate for therapeutic intervention. Although extensive efforts had led to the development of numerous inhibitors targeting the PI3K/AKT pathway, the diversity of genetic alterations can challenge the identification of the most effective therapeutic targets. Therefore, the discovery of shared tumor-promoting mechanisms downstream of these genetic alterations might unravel new biomarkers and druggable targets. The aim of this study was to elucidate the precise role of PI3K/AKT pathway during the course of colorectal carcinogenesis and to decipher novel pro-tumorigenic molecular mechanisms downstream of PI3K/AKT activation that can be used for therapeutic intervention.
To obtain a better insight into the role of the PI3K/AKT pathway during colorectal carcinogenesis, mice expressing an oncogenic variant of AKT1 (AktE17K) specifically in the intestinal epithelial cells (IEC) were used. At the age of 6 months untreated AktE17K mice showed clearly perturbed intestinal homeostasis, but no tumor formation. To induce colonic tumorigenesis, AktE17K mice were subjected to treatment with the colonic carcinogen azoxymethane (AOM). In response to AOM, AktE17K mice developed invasive but nonmetastatic tumors, which showed strong nuclear accumulation of TP53. To investigate the role of PI3K/AKT signaling specifically in CRC progression, AktE17K mice were crossed to TP53- deficient mice (Tp53ΔIEC). Unlike AktE17K mice, untreated Tp53ΔIECAktE17K, developed highly invasive small intestinal tumors by the age of 6 months. To investigate the role of AKT hyperactivation in colonic tumor progression, Tp53ΔIECAktE17K mice were subjected to AOM treatment. AKT hyperactivation significantly enhanced tumor progression and induced metastatic dissemination.
To get a better insight how AKT signaling can promote tumor progression, whole tumor tissues from AOM-treated Tp53ΔIEC and Tp53ΔIECAktE17K mice were subjected to next generation mRNA sequencing and phospho-proteomic analysis by mass spectrometry. Both analyses indicated that AKT hyperactivation expands the inflammatory tumor microenvironment and upregulates pathways associated with invasion and metastasis. Importantly, Gene Set Enrichment Analysis revealed that AOM-induced colon tumors of Tp53ΔIECAktE17K animals, are highly similar in their gene expression profile to the CMS4 subtype of human CRC, which is associated with worse overall- and relapse-free survival7 . Gene expression analysis also suggested elevated NOTCH signaling in the Tp53ΔIECAktE17K tumors. Interestingly, while the expression of Notch3 mRNA was increased in the tumors of Tp53ΔIECAktE17K mice, the expression of the other NOTCH receptors was unaffected by AKT hyperactivation. In vitro experiments using TP53-deficient mouse tumor organoids with hyperactive AKT signaling confirmed the direct, tumor cell-intrinsic link between AKT activation and increased Notch3 expression. Moreover, inhibition of EZH2 mimicked the effect of AKT hyperactivation on Notch3 expression, suggesting that AKT regulates Notch3 via an epigenetic mechanism.
Knock-down of Notch3 in TP53-deficient mouse tumor organoids with hyperactive AKT signaling resulted in differential regulation of several pathways with potential role in invasion and metastasis and in cell death and survival. Subsequent in vivo experiments confirmed the role of NOTCH3 signaling in CRC progression. Treatment of AOM-induced Tp53ΔIECAkt E17K mice with a NOTCH3 antagonistic antibody or the γ-secretase inhibitor DAPT significantly reduced invasion and metastasis. Importantly, NOTCH3 expression was also found to be associated with human CRC progression, suggesting that NOTCH3 represent a valid target for the treatment of CRC. This work, using genetically engineered mouse models and advanced in vitro techniques, has demonstrated a strong tumor promoting role for PI3K/AKT signaling in CRC progression and has identified NOTCH3 signaling as a potential therapeutic target downstream of the PI3K/AKT pathway.
Bei Autismus-Spektrum-Störungen (ASS) handelt es sich um genetisch komplexe Störungen mit hoher Erblichkeit. Als zugrundeliegender Pathomechanismus von ASS werden unter anderem Veränderungen der neuronalen Entwicklung diskutiert. Der Phänotyp von ASS ist definiert durch Einschränkungen in der sozialen Interaktion und Kommunikation sowie repetitives und stereotypes Verhalten. Genkopiepolymorphismen (englisch „copy number variations“/CNVs), also Deletionen oder Duplikationen einer chromosomalen Region, wurden wiederholt in Probanden mit ASS identifiziert. Hierbei ist in ASS die Region 16p11.2 mit am häufigsten von CNVs betroffen. Einige Gene aus diesem chromosomalen Abschnitt wurden bereits funktionell charakterisiert. Dennoch können die Befunde der bisherigen Einzelgenstudien nicht alle Aspekte erklären, die durch 16p11.2 CNVs hervorgerufen werden. Ziel dieser Studie war es daher, ein weiteres neuronal assoziiertes Kandidatengen dieser Region zu identifizieren und im Anschluss funktionell im Kontext der neuronalen Differenzierung zu charakterisieren.
Das SH-SY5Y Neuroblastom-Zellmodell wurde auf Transkriptom- und morphologischer Ebene auf seine Eignung als Modell für neuronale Differenzierung untersucht und bestätigt. Eine Analyse der Expressionen aller Gene der 16p11.2-Region zeigte, dass das Gen Quinolinat-Phosphoribosyltransferase (QPRT) eine vergleichsweise hohe Expression mit der stärksten und robustesten Regulierung über die Zeit aufwies. Eine de novo Deletion der 16p11.2-Region wurde in einem Patienten im Vergleich zu seinen Eltern validiert. In Patienten-spezifischen lymphoblastoiden Zelllinien derselben Familie konnten wir eine Gendosis-abhängige Expression von QPRT auf RNA-Ebene bestätigen. In SH-SY5Y-Zellen korrelierte die Expression von QPRT signifikant mit der Entwicklung von Neuriten während der Differenzierung. Um QPRT funktionell zu charakterisieren, benutzten wir drei verschiedene Methoden zur Reduktion der QPRT-Gendosis: (i) knock down (KD) durch siRNA, (ii) chemische Inhibition durch Phthalsäure und (iii) knock out (KO) über CRISPR/Cas9-Geneditierung. Eine Reduktion von QPRT durch siRNA führte zu einer schwachen Veränderung der neuronalen Morphologie differenzierter SH-SY5Y-Zellen. Die chemische Inhibition sowie der genetische KO von QPRT waren letal für differenzierende aber nicht für proliferierende Zellen. Eine Metabolitenanalyse zeigte keine Veränderungen des QPRT-assoziierten Tryptophanstoffwechsels. Gene, welche auf Transkriptomebene im Vergleich zwischen KO- und Kontrollzellen differenziell reguliert vorlagen, waren häufig an Prozessen der neuronalen Entwicklung sowie an der Bildung, Stabilität und Funktion synaptischer Strukturen beteiligt. Die Liste differenziell regulierter Gene enthielt außerdem überdurchschnittlich viele ASS-Risikogene und ko-regulierte Gengruppen waren assoziiert mit der Entwicklung des dorsolateralen präfrontalen Cortex, des Hippocampus sowie der Amygdala.
In dieser Studie zeigten wir einen kausalen Zusammenhang zwischen QPRT und der neuronalen Differenzierung in vitro sowie einen Einfluss von QPRT auf die Regulation von ASS-assoziierten Genen und Gen-Netzwerken. Funktionell standen diese Gene im Kontext mit synaptischen Vorgängen, welche durch Veränderungen zu einem Exzitations-Inhibitions-Ungleichgewicht und letztendlich zum Zelltod von Neuronen führen können. Unsere Ergebnisse heben in Summe die wichtige Rolle von QPRT in der Krankheitsentstehung von ASS, insbesondere in Trägern einer 16p11.2 Deletion, hervor.
This dissertation aimed to shed light on changes of the epigenetic landscape in heart and skeletal muscle tissue of the turquoise Killifish N. furzeri, a novel, short-lived animal model for aging research. The following results could be obtained:
1. A global trend towards closed chromatin conformation could be observed; histone markers for H3K27me3, H3K9me3 and H4K20me3 accumulated in skeletal muscle tissue from old N. furzeri. Markers for open chromatin conformation such as H3K4me3, H3K9ac and H4K16ac decreased in old skeletal muscle tissue. In old hearts from N. furzeri an accumulation of H3K27me3 could be detected while H3K9ac was found to increase with age as well. mRNA expression levels of methylating enzymes were higher in skeletal muscle tissue from old N. furzeri when compared to expression levels in skeletal muscle tissue from young N. furzeri.
2. The shift of epigenetic pattern was accompanied by a change of gene expression. Via mRNA sequencing in collaboration with the MPI, Bad Nauheim it could be shown that genes associated with cell cycle and DNA repair were lower expressed in skeletal muscle tissue from old N. furzeri than in tissue from young N. furzeri. Genes, associated with inflammatory signaling and glycolysis, displayed increased mRNA levels in skeletal muscle tissue from old N. furzeri. These results could be confirmed by Western blot and qRT-PCR analyses.
3. Markers for DNA damage and senescence increased in skeletal muscle tissue from old N. furzeri.
4. Cells derived from young and old N. furzeri skeletal muscle could be isolated and cultured for many passages. These cells were a mix of different cell types with properties and features of the native tissue. They could be used for treatment with drugs and/small compounds modulating the epigenetic landscape via specific interference with methylating enzymes.
5. DNA methylation and hydroxy-methylation were found to go in different directions in skeletal muscle and heart tissue from N. furzeri: while increasing in skeletal muscle tissue, a both DNA modifications declined in heart tissue with age.
6. In the heart of N. furzeri microRNA expression changes with age were assed with sequencing in collaboration with the FLI, Jena. It could be demonstrated that miRNA expression is age-dependent. Particular focus was on miR-29 and its target genes: miR-29 was highly upregulated in heart and skeletal muscle tissue, while target genes such as collagens and dnmts were reduced with age in the heart of N. furzeri.
7. Cardiac function remained stable with age and no accumulation of collagens could be found when comparing hearts of young and old N. furzeri despite the increase of markers for oxidative stress.
8. Cell culture experiments with human cardiac fibroblasts revealed that miR-29 is upregulated with increasing age of the donor. In addition to that, it could be shown that miR-29 is positively regulated by oxidative stress.
9. A zebrafish mutant with modified expression of miR-29 that was created in collaboration with the SNS, Pisa, presented a severe hypoxic phenotype and an altered mRNA expression profile compared to wild type control zebrafish. Cardiac dysfunction and hypertrophy were observed as well as an increase in DNA methylation and collagens.
Taken together, it could be shown that the aging process in skeletal muscle and heart tissue from N. furzeri leads to a series of changes on epigenetic levels. It remains to be elucidated whether these changes are result or cause for further changes of mRNA expression, protein levels and pathophysiology, yet the N. furzeri represents a promising research model for further aging studies.
Lizards of Paraguay: an integrative approach to solve taxonomic problems in central South America
(2018)
Paraguay is located in the center of South America with drier and warmer climatic conditions in the western part of the country, and more temperate and humid in the eastern region. Biogeographically, Paraguay is a key spot in South America, where several ecoregions converge. In my study, I sampled most of the ecoregions of Paraguay. The main objective of my work is to solve taxonomic problems, identified through genetic barcoding analyses, in the central region of South America. To achieve this objective, I used selected taxa of the Paraguayan Squamata as models taking into consideration the crucial geographic position of the country, plus the scarce available genetic data of Paraguayan reptiles.
The collecting activities were performed in the framework of a barcoding inventory project of the Paraguayan herpetofauna and carried out mostly in rural areas searching for animals in different types of habitats using active search as the sampling technique.
For genetics, the extraction of DNA was performed with DNeasy® Blood & Tissue Kit of Qiagen® for sets of few samples, and the fiber glass plate protocol for sets of 96 samples. I assessed the quality of sequences after amplification in agarose gel electrophoresis. The first marker sequenced was 16S mtDNA, used for barcoding analysis. A DNA barcode is a genetic identifier for a species. Once a taxonomic problem was detected, I generate more gene sequences to target the issue.
All the analyses to test phylogenetic hypotheses (based on single genes or concatenated datasets) were performed under Maximum Likelihood and Bayesian approaches. To root the phylogenetic trees, I chose the available taxon (or taxa) most closely related to the respective studied group as outgroups. For the general tree of Paraguayan Squamata, based on barcodes of 16S, I chose Sphenodon punctatus.
I generated a total of 142 sequences of 64 species of Squamata from Paraguay (Appendix I). The final alignment of 615 bp comprised 249 samples. The best substitution model for the Barcoding dataset based on the gene 16S was GTR+G, according to the BIC.
To complement molecular evidence generated with the ML grouping of 16S barcodes, I took a morphological approach based on voucher specimens collected during fieldwork (usually the same specimens that I used for genetic analysis), supplemented by the revision of museum collections.
Summarizing my results, samples of Colobosaura exhibit large genetic distances, and accordingly I revalidated Colobosaura kraepelini (Appendix II). Tropidurus of the spinulosus group show two clades and among them there is little genetic and morphological variation, I synonymized T. tarara and T. teyumirim with T. lagunablanca, and T. guarani with T. spinulosus (Appendix III). I detected the presence of candidate species of Homonota, and I restricted the name H. horrida for Argentina, and described two new species of Homonota (Appendices IV and V), and a new species of Phyllopezus also in the Family Phyllodactylidae (Appendix VI).
In this work I present the most comprehensive analysis of genetic samples of Squamata from Paraguay. The results obtained here will be useful to help to clarify further taxonomic issues regarding the squamate fauna from the central region of South America. Moreover, the data generated for this study will have a positive impact in a larger geographic context, beyond Paraguayan borders.
Regarding the conservation of the Paraguayan reptiles, and considering the taxonomic changes accomplished here, it is important to note that many species lack legal protection. In Paraguay, the major problem for conservation is habitat loss due to extensive crop farming. Thus, currently, the protected areas are the best strategy for conservation of biodiversity in the country. However, many such areas face legal problems (e.g., lack of official measurements, management plans, forest guards, infrastructure, etc.) so that the maintenance of their biodiversity over time is not guaranteed.
In conclusion, in this study I present contributions on the taxonomy of mostly lizards from Paraguay. Due to lack of samples, I was not able to deal with a deep taxonomic revision of the country's snakes. Based on my results, I can argue that analyses of Xenodontini and Pseudoboini are currently a pressing research issue. This barcoding project may continue since some colleagues in Paraguay are interested in collaboration. Given that the sequenced specimens are yet a small portion of the actual diversity of Paraguay, it will be of utmost importance to continue and expand these studies that will further improve our taxonomic knowledge. Furthermore, it is desirable to have Paraguayan scientists not only involved, but to see them taking the lead of high quality taxonomic research.
Hämophilie A ist eine X-chromosomal rezessiv vererbte Krankheit, die aufgrund von Mutationen innerhalb des Gens von Gerinnungsfaktor VIII (FVIII) zum funktionellen Defekt oder zum Fehlen des körpereigenen FVIII führt. FVIII zirkuliert als Heterodimer und besteht aus einer schweren Kette mit der Domänenstruktur A1-A2-B und einer leichten Kette mit der Domänenstruktur A3-C1-C2. Bei Patienten unter Prophylaxe wird durch regelmäßige Substitution mit rekombinanten oder aus Plasma gewonnenen FVIII-Präparaten die Hämostase wiederhergestellt. Allerdings entwickeln hierbei etwa 30% der Patienten mit einer schweren Hämophilie eine FVIII-spezifische Immunantwort in Form von neutralisierenden Antikörpern (Inhibitoren). Die sogenannte Immuntoleranz-Therapie (engl. immune tolerance induction therapy, ITI) ist bisher die einzige etablierte Therapie, die zu einer dauerhaften Eradikation der FVIII-Inhibitoren und Induktion von Toleranz gegenüber FVIII führen kann. Die Therapie beruht auf einer meist täglichen Gabe hoher FVIII-Dosen, welche sich, je nach Behandlungsdauer, über Wochen bis hin zu Jahren erstrecken kann. Bei etwa 30% der Patienten ist diese Therapie nicht erfolgreich. Für solche Patienten besteht die Gefahr lebensbedrohlicher, unkontrollierbarer Blutungen und erheblicher Gelenkschäden.
Die spezifische Ansteuerung des Membran-gebundenen Immunglobulin G (mIg) des B-Zellrezeptors (BZR) mithilfe von Immuntoxinen ist eine mögliche Option zur selektiven Eliminierung FVIII-spezifischer B-Zellen und somit zur Eradikation von FVIII-Inhibitoren. Solche Immuntoxine bestehen aus einer zellbindenden und einer zytotoxischen Domäne, welche nach Internalisierung zur Apoptose der Zielzelle führen soll. Da FVIII aufgrund der Größe als zellbindende Domäne ungeeignet ist, beschäftigt sich die vorliegende Arbeit mit der Entwicklung und Evaluierung alternativer Immuntoxine zur selektiven Eliminierung FVIII-spezifischer B-Zellen. Die FVIII-spezifische Immunantwort ist zwar polyklonal, jedoch vor allem gegen A2- und die C2-Domäne gerichtet. Aus diesem Grund wurden die humane A2- und C2-Domäne (hA2, hC2) als zellbindende Domäne verwendet und jeweils genetisch an eine verkürzte Version des Exotoxin A (ETA) aus Pseudomonas aeruginosa fusioniert, bei welcher die natürliche zellbindende Domäne entfernt wurde. Die rekombinanten Proteine wurden bakteriell produziert und im Anschluss an die Aufreinigung biochemisch charakterisiert. Während das bakterielle Expressionssystem für hA2-ETA nicht geeignet war, konnte hC2-ETA neben weiteren Kontrollproteinen mit korrekter Konformation der hC2-Domäne hergestellt und aufgereinigt werden.
Die Fähigkeit zur selektiven Eliminierung hC2-spezifischer B-Zellen wurde im weiteren Verlauf sowohl in vitro mithilfe einer hC2-spezifischen Hybridomazelllinie als auch ex vivo und in vivo mithilfe von Splenozyten aus FVIII-immunisierten FVIII-knockout Mäusen untersucht.
Durch Inkubation der hC2-spezifischen Hybridomazelllinie mit hC2-ETA konnten ca. 38 % der Zellen eliminiert werden. Weitere Untersuchungen der Zelllinie ergaben, dass diese keinen vollständigen funktionalen B-Zellrezeptor auf der Oberfläche exprimierte, welcher für die Bindung und die korrekte Internalisierung des Immuntoxins notwendig ist. Aufgrund dessen eignet sich diese Zelllinie nicht als Modell für eine genauere Analyse der in vitro Eliminierungseffizienz von hC2-ETA.
Weitere Analysen mithilfe von Splenozyten aus FVIII-immunisierten FVIII-knockout Mäusen haben jedoch gezeigt, dass durch ex vivo Inkubation der Splenozyten mit hC2-ETA, alle hC2-spezifischen B-Zellen vollständig, selektiv und konzentrations-abhängig eliminiert werden konnten. Auch die mehrfache Applikation von hC2-ETA in FVIII-immunisierten FVIII-knockout Mäusen führte bei der Hälfte der Tiere zur vollständigen Eliminierung aller hC2-spezifischen B-Zellen. Eine Reduktion des hC2-spezifischen Antikörpersignals konnte nach Gabe von hC2-ETA in allen behandelten Tieren beobachtet werden. Die unvollständige Eliminierung in der Hälfte der Tiere ist vermutlich auf die Präsenz hC2-spezifischer Antikörper zurückzuführen, die einen Teil des applizierten Immuntoxins neutralisiert haben, sodass nicht alle hC2-spezifischen Gedächtnis-B-Zellen erreicht und eliminiert werden konnten. Um die Eliminierungseffizienz von hC2-ETA weiter zu erhöhen, müsste das Behandlungsprotokoll geändert werden. Sowohl eine Verlängerung des Behandlungszeitraums als auch eine kombinierte Therapie aus FVIII und hC2-ETA sollte zu einer erhöhten Bioverfügbarkeit des Toxins und dadurch zu einer gesteigerten Eliminierungseffizienz führen.
Die Ausweitung des hier vorgestellten Ansatzes auf weitere FVIII-Domänen ist generell möglich, jedoch muss hierzu ein alternatives Expressionssystem aufgrund des eukaryotischen Ursprungs von FVIII in Betracht gezogen werden. Die hier vorgestellten Ergebnisse zeigen dennoch, dass FVIII-Domänen-Immuntoxine ein wirkungsvolles Mittel sind, um FVIII-spezifische B-Zellen selektiv zu eliminieren. Die Anpassung der Gabe von FVIII-Domänen-Immuntoxinen an die individuelle Immunantwort des Patienten könnte das Auftreten von Nebenwirkungen minimieren. Außerdem könnte eine kombinierte Therapie aus ITI und FVIII-Domänen-Immuntoxinen die Zeit bis zur Induktion von Toleranz verkürzen und die Chancen für den generellen Therapieerfolg erhöhen.
The metabolome of any live cell consists of several hundred, if not thousands of different molecules at any given moment, be it a relatively small bacterial cell or a whole multicellular organism. Although there are continuous attempts to differentiate between primary and secondary metabolites, the borders often blur in the eye of almost perfect interconvertability of all such matter. With chemistry and physics dominating this domain of biology it is an interdisciplinary endeavor to tackle the questions surrounding the workings of the metabolic pathways involved, searching for answers that ultimately help us to better understand life and find solutions to problems that affect us humans. One area of biochemistry that serves as a formidable example of the intertwined primary and secondary metabolic pathways are fatty acids, essential components of bacterial membranes, sources of energy and carbon but also important building blocks of several natural products. The second area to be mentioned is the metabolism of amino acids, the basic components of proteins and enzymes, which also serve as precursors to a diverse set of metabolites with many biological purposes.
This work focuses on these two areas of biochemistry, as several intermediates of their metabolism serve as building blocks for complex secondary metabolites whence many interesting and bioactive natural products are derived. The powerful and relatively novel tool of click-chemistry is employed to track azide-labeled precursors of primary and secondary metabolism in various bacterial strains to observe biochemistry at work and adds to the knowledge gained through other methods. The methods presented in this work serve the observation of fatty acid biosynthesis, degradation, modification and transport through direct ligation of azido fatty acids with cyclooctynes on one hand, leading to a revision of fatty acid transport in general. On the other hand a cleavable azide-reactive resin is devised to generally track the fate of azidated compounds through the myriads of metabolic pathways offered by entomopathogenic bacteria possessing a rich secondary metabolism. The resulting findings led to the identification of several antimicrobial peptides, amides and other compounds of which many had remained so far undetected in the strains that underwent investigation, underlining the worth of this method for future metabolomic research and beyond.
The role of the homeobox transcription factor Meis2b in zebrafish heart development and asymmetry
(2018)
Zebrafish heart development: The heart of the zebrafish is the first organ to form and function during embryonic development, and is composed by one atrium and one ventricle. Between 5-17 somites stage, the cardiomyocyte precursors form the bilateral cardiac fields in the anterior lateral plate mesoderm (ALMP); where the endocardial precursors are located anterior to the cardiac fields (Zeng, Wilm et al. 2007). Then, the pools of endocardial andmyocardial precursors fuse at the midline and form the heart disc; where atrial cardiomyocytes are located around, the ventricular cardiomyocytes are located in the centerof the heart disc, and the future endocardium is located in a ventral position relative to the cardiomyocytes (Bakkers 2011). After the heart disc is formed, the cardiomyocyte progenitors start to migrate and rotate asymmetrically to form the heart tube (de Campos-Baptista, Holtzman et al. 2008, Rohr, Otten et al. 2008, Smith, Chocron et al. 2008). This process is followed by a rightward bending of the heart tube, and the arterial and venous poles rotate at different speed and directions (a process known as heart looping) (Smith, Chocron et al. 2008). The heart looping process results in a ventricle located on the right side and a more posterior atrium located on the left side with respect to the midline; at this point the atrium and ventricle are separated by a fine segment called the atrioventricular canal, where the valves will be formed (Staudt and Stainier 2012). The second heart field (SHF) is a pool of cardiac progenitors that are specified later during the formation of the heart disc and until the heart looping stages. The SHF contributes withcells to the distal side of the ventricle, the outflow and inflow tracts, and is important for the specification of the cardiac conduction system (de Pater, Clijsters et al. 2009, Hami, Grimes et al. 2011, Zhou, Cashman et al. 2011, Witzel, Jungblut et al. 2012, Guner-Ataman, Paffett-Lugassy et al. 2013)....
In den letzten Jahren findet die Wirkung von Polyphenolen auf den Alterungsprozess oder zur Behandlung von Krankheiten immer mehr Beachtung. Das Ziel dieser Arbeit war die Aufklärung der Wirkmechanismen der Polyphenole Gossypol, Curcumin und Quercetin, um Hinweise für neue oder verbesserte Therapieansätze zu erhalten. Die dazu durchgeführten Untersuchungen lieferten folgende Ergebnisse:
1. Der Ascomycet "P. anserina" eignet sich als Modellorganismus zur Untersuchung der Wirkmechanismen verschiedener Polyphenole, da die bereits aus der Literatur bekannten Effekte auf das Überleben höherer Organismen auch in "P. anserina" beobachtet wurden.
2. Die Mitochondrienfunktion spielt auf unterschiedliche Art eine Rolle in der Kompensation von Dysfunktionen oder Stressbedingungen in der Zelle und wirkt somit positiv auf die Regulation der Lebensspanne von "P. anserina". In der "PaSod3"-Deletionsmutante wurde eine Verschiebung der mitochondrialen Atmung von einer Komplex I-abhängigen hin zu einer vermehrt Komplex II-abhängigen Atmung festgestellt. Die damit verbundene Abnahme des mitochondrialen Membranpotentials dient neben der bereits bekannten hohen Superoxid-Menge als Signal zur Mitophagie-Induktion. Auch die Anpassung der Mitochondrienfunktion durch die erhöhte Bildung von mtRSCs, wie im Falle von Gossypol oder Quercetin, kann zur Kompensation von Dysfunktionen beitragen bzw. sie abschwächen.
3. Es gibt keinen grundlegenden gemeinsamen Wirkmechanimus der drei untersuchten Polyphenole. Zwar spielt Wasserstoffperoxid bei verschiedenen Stoffen eine Rolle, aber nicht bei allen. Zusätzlich wurde gezeigt, dass Wasserstoffperoxid abhängig von der vorherrschenden Konzentration wirkt und daher auch keine Allgemeingültigkeit des Effektes vorherzusagen ist. In niedrigen Konzentrationen sorgt Wasserstoffperoxid z. B. für eine Induktion der Autophagie und damit einhergehende eine Lebensverlängerung. Im Gegensatz dazu wirken hohe Wasserstoffperoxid-Konzentrationen lebensverkürzend und lösen verschiedene Formen von Zelltod aus.
4. Die Curcumin-vermittelte Langlebigkeit wurde das erste Mal in Verbindung mit einer funktionellen Autophagie gebracht. Im Detail führt die Behandlung mit Curcumin durch eine PaSOD1-abhängige leichte Erhöhung der Wasserstoffperoxid-Menge zu einer Induktion von nicht-selektiver Autophagie. Die induzierte Autophagie ist Ursache der Lebensverlängerung durch Curcumin.
5. Gossypol wirkt in Abhängigkeit der mitochondrialen Permeabilitäts-Transitionspore bzw. von ihrem Regulator Cyclophilin D. Hierbei verstärkt die deutlich erhöhte Wasserstoffperoxid-Menge wahrscheinlich die Induktion von programmiertem Zelltod. Gleichzeitig wird eine cytoprotektive Form von Autophagie und ein scheinbar ATG-unabhängiger Abbau von Mitochondrien induziert.
6. Quercetin wirkt in "P. anserina" abhängig vom Methylierungs-Status. Untersuchungen mit Mutanten der "O"-Methyltransferase PaMTH1 ergaben die Notwendigkeit der Anwesenheit von PaMTH1 für den lebensverlängernden Effekt von Quercetin. Analysen mit dem methylierten Derivat Isorhamnetin verdeutlichten diese Abhängigkeit und zeigten zudem, dass Quercetin sowohl in der methylierten als auch unmethylierten Form Effekte hervorruft. Jedoch sind nur die Effekte des unmethylierten Quercetin unabhängig von der Lebensverlängerung und eher schädlich für die Zelle.
Die forensische Entomologie nutzt nekrophage Insekten, hauptsächlich Dipteren und ihre juvenilen Stadien, zur Schätzung der minimalen Leichenliegezeit. Dem liegt zugrunde, dass nekrophage Dipteren binnen Minuten nach dem Todeseintritt potentiell in der Lage sind, einen Leichnam zu detektieren und zu besiedeln. Das anschließende Wachstum und die Entwicklung der juvenilen Stadien erfolgt als Funktion von der Art und der Umgebungstemperatur.
Mit Hilfe von Laborstudien konnten bislang für einige forensisch relevante Fliegenarten Entwicklungsdaten erhoben werden, die eine Altersbestimmung der sich an einem Leichnam entwickelnden Larven und Puppen erlauben und so eine Schätzung der minimalen Leichenliegezeit ermöglichen. Als Nährsubstrat für Laborstudien werden tierische Gewebe verwendet. Eine Übertragbarkeit der Daten auf humanes Gewebe wurde aber bislang nicht verifiziert. In der vorliegenden Arbeit wurde das larvale Wachstum und die juvenile Entwicklungsgeschwindigkeit der forensisch relevanten Schmeißfliege Calliphora vicina (Diptera: Calliphoridae) auf humanem Muskelgewebe untersucht und mit dem Wachstum auf Schweineleber, magerem Schweinemuskelfleisch und Schweinehackfleisch verglichen. Die auf humanem Gewebe heranwachsenden Individuen waren mit bis zu 3,5 mm signifikant länger als die Individuen, die sich auf Leber und dem mageren Schweinemuskelfleisch entwickelten. Bei der Verwendung von Hackfleisch vom Schwein zeigte sich kein Unterschied. Darauf basierend wird die Empfehlung ausgesprochen, für zukünftige Entwicklungsstudien Schweinehackfleisch als Ersatz für humanes Gewebe zu verwenden.
Zahlreiche Anleitungen zur Asservierung forensisch-entomologischer Spuren empfehlen das Sammeln getrennt nach Körperregionen eines Leichnams. Dies soll eine mögliche gewebespezifische Entwicklungsrate berücksichtigen. Das für die vorliegende Arbeit durchgeführte systematische Absammeln von Fliegenlarven von 51 Leichnamen getrennt nach Körperregionen zeigte keine artspezifischen Präferenzen für bestimmte Gewebe oder Körperregionen. Das Artenspektrum entsprach größtenteils dem aufgrund von Studien an Schweinekadavern zu erwartendem Artenspektrum für Deutschland und Mitteleuropa. Insgesamt konnten 15 Schmeißfliegenarten nachgewiesen werden, von denen in der Regel mehrere gleichzeitig an einem Leichnam zu finden waren. Dies zeigt, dass ein Faktor wie interspezifische Konkurrenz in Zukunft mehr Beachtung in der Forschung erhalten sollte.
Bislang wurde in der forensischen Entomologie die minimale Leichenliegezeit durch die Untersuchung juveniler Stadien von Fliegen eingegrenzt. Eine eventuell mögliche Ausweitung dieses Zeitfensters könnte durch eine Altersbestimmung der adulten Fliegen oder der leeren Puparien gelingen. Der Nachweis, dass die dafür untersuchten Fliegen bzw. Puparien tatsächlich von dem fraglichen Leichnam stammen, war bislang nicht möglich. Die forensische relevante Schmeißfliege Lucilia sericata wurde in der vorliegenden Arbeit auf humanem Gewebe und Gewebe von elf weiteren Tierarten großgezogen. Durch die Analyse stabiler Kohlen- und Stickstoffisotope konnte ein von diesen elf Tierarten abgrenzbares humanes Isotopenprofil sowohl für die adulten Fliegen von L. sericata, als auch für ihre leeren Puparien detektiert werden. Dieses Profil spiegelte die Nahrungszusammensetzung der Wirte wider.
Die vorliegende Arbeit erhebt Daten zur Entwicklung einer forensisch relevanten Schmeißfliegenart auf humanem Gewebe, belegt das bislang lediglich am tierischen Modell erhobene Schmeißfliegeninventar als für menschliche Leichen relevant und hinterfragt die gewebespezifische Asservierungsempfehlung als ein akademisches Artefakt. Auf dieser Basis konnten Empfehlungen für die Weiterzucht fallrelevanter entomologischer Spuren ausgesprochen werden, die gerichtsverwertbar sind und die Verwendung von tierischem Gewebe oder Tierkadaver in der forensisch-entomologischen Forschung legitimieren. Die Analyse stabiler Isotope legt darüber hinaus einen neuen, innovativen Grundstein für die routinemäßige Spurenzuordnung älterer Entwicklungsstadien und ist damit Vorreiter auf dem Gebiet der forensischen Entomologie.